elf32-ppc.c revision 1.9 1 1.1 christos /* PowerPC-specific support for 32-bit ELF
2 1.9 christos Copyright (C) 1994-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 1.1 christos Written by Ian Lance Taylor, Cygnus Support.
4 1.1 christos
5 1.1 christos This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
6 1.1 christos
7 1.1 christos This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 1.1 christos it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 1.1 christos the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 1.1 christos (at your option) any later version.
11 1.1 christos
12 1.1 christos This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 1.1 christos but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 1.1 christos MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 1.1 christos GNU General Public License for more details.
16 1.1 christos
17 1.1 christos You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 1.1 christos along with this program; if not, write to the
19 1.1 christos Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor,
20 1.1 christos Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
21 1.1 christos
22 1.1 christos
23 1.1 christos /* This file is based on a preliminary PowerPC ELF ABI. The
24 1.1 christos information may not match the final PowerPC ELF ABI. It includes
25 1.1 christos suggestions from the in-progress Embedded PowerPC ABI, and that
26 1.1 christos information may also not match. */
27 1.1 christos
28 1.1 christos #include "sysdep.h"
29 1.1 christos #include <stdarg.h>
30 1.1 christos #include "bfd.h"
31 1.1 christos #include "bfdlink.h"
32 1.1 christos #include "libbfd.h"
33 1.1 christos #include "elf-bfd.h"
34 1.1 christos #include "elf/ppc.h"
35 1.1 christos #include "elf32-ppc.h"
36 1.1 christos #include "elf-vxworks.h"
37 1.1 christos #include "dwarf2.h"
38 1.7 christos #include "opcode/ppc.h"
39 1.1 christos
40 1.9 christos /* All users of this file have bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, sec) == 1. */
41 1.9 christos #define OCTETS_PER_BYTE(ABFD, SEC) 1
42 1.9 christos
43 1.1 christos typedef enum split16_format_type
44 1.1 christos {
45 1.1 christos split16a_type = 0,
46 1.1 christos split16d_type
47 1.1 christos }
48 1.1 christos split16_format_type;
49 1.1 christos
50 1.1 christos /* RELA relocations are used here. */
51 1.1 christos
52 1.1 christos static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc
53 1.1 christos (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
54 1.1 christos static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc
55 1.1 christos (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
56 1.1 christos
57 1.1 christos /* Branch prediction bit for branch taken relocs. */
58 1.1 christos #define BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT 0x200000
59 1.1 christos /* Mask to set RA in memory instructions. */
60 1.1 christos #define RA_REGISTER_MASK 0x001f0000
61 1.1 christos /* Value to shift register by to insert RA. */
62 1.1 christos #define RA_REGISTER_SHIFT 16
63 1.1 christos
64 1.1 christos /* The name of the dynamic interpreter. This is put in the .interp
65 1.1 christos section. */
66 1.1 christos #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER "/usr/lib/ld.so.1"
67 1.1 christos
68 1.1 christos /* For old-style PLT. */
69 1.1 christos /* The number of single-slot PLT entries (the rest use two slots). */
70 1.1 christos #define PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES 8192
71 1.1 christos
72 1.1 christos /* For new-style .glink and .plt. */
73 1.1 christos #define GLINK_PLTRESOLVE 16*4
74 1.8 christos #define GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE(htab, h) \
75 1.8 christos ((4*4 \
76 1.8 christos + (h != NULL \
77 1.8 christos && h == htab->tls_get_addr \
78 1.8 christos && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt ? 8*4 : 0) \
79 1.8 christos + (1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align) - 1) \
80 1.8 christos & -(1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align))
81 1.1 christos
82 1.1 christos /* VxWorks uses its own plt layout, filled in by the static linker. */
83 1.1 christos
84 1.1 christos /* The standard VxWorks PLT entry. */
85 1.1 christos #define VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE 32
86 1.1 christos static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry
87 1.1 christos [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
88 1.1 christos {
89 1.8 christos 0x3d800000, /* lis r12,0 */
90 1.8 christos 0x818c0000, /* lwz r12,0(r12) */
91 1.8 christos 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
92 1.8 christos 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
93 1.8 christos 0x39600000, /* li r11,0 */
94 1.8 christos 0x48000000, /* b 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> */
95 1.8 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
96 1.8 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
97 1.1 christos };
98 1.1 christos static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
99 1.1 christos [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
100 1.1 christos {
101 1.1 christos 0x3d9e0000, /* addis r12,r30,0 */
102 1.1 christos 0x818c0000, /* lwz r12,0(r12) */
103 1.1 christos 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
104 1.1 christos 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
105 1.1 christos 0x39600000, /* li r11,0 */
106 1.1 christos 0x48000000, /* b 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> 14: R_PPC_REL24 .PLTresolve */
107 1.1 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
108 1.1 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
109 1.1 christos };
110 1.1 christos
111 1.1 christos /* The initial VxWorks PLT entry. */
112 1.1 christos #define VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE 32
113 1.1 christos static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry
114 1.1 christos [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
115 1.1 christos {
116 1.8 christos 0x3d800000, /* lis r12,0 */
117 1.8 christos 0x398c0000, /* addi r12,r12,0 */
118 1.8 christos 0x800c0008, /* lwz r0,8(r12) */
119 1.8 christos 0x7c0903a6, /* mtctr r0 */
120 1.8 christos 0x818c0004, /* lwz r12,4(r12) */
121 1.8 christos 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
122 1.8 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
123 1.8 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
124 1.1 christos };
125 1.1 christos static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
126 1.1 christos [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
127 1.1 christos {
128 1.1 christos 0x819e0008, /* lwz r12,8(r30) */
129 1.8 christos 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
130 1.1 christos 0x819e0004, /* lwz r12,4(r30) */
131 1.8 christos 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
132 1.8 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
133 1.8 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
134 1.8 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
135 1.8 christos 0x60000000, /* nop */
136 1.1 christos };
137 1.1 christos
138 1.1 christos /* For executables, we have some additional relocations in
139 1.1 christos .rela.plt.unloaded, for the kernel loader. */
140 1.1 christos
141 1.1 christos /* The number of non-JMP_SLOT relocations per PLT0 slot. */
142 1.1 christos #define VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS 3
143 1.1 christos /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot. */
144 1.1 christos #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS 2
145 1.8 christos /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot when creating
146 1.1 christos a shared library. */
147 1.1 christos #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS_SHLIB 0
148 1.1 christos
149 1.1 christos /* Some instructions. */
150 1.1 christos #define ADDIS_11_11 0x3d6b0000
151 1.1 christos #define ADDIS_11_30 0x3d7e0000
152 1.1 christos #define ADDIS_12_12 0x3d8c0000
153 1.1 christos #define ADDI_11_11 0x396b0000
154 1.1 christos #define ADD_0_11_11 0x7c0b5a14
155 1.1 christos #define ADD_3_12_2 0x7c6c1214
156 1.1 christos #define ADD_11_0_11 0x7d605a14
157 1.1 christos #define B 0x48000000
158 1.3 christos #define BA 0x48000002
159 1.1 christos #define BCL_20_31 0x429f0005
160 1.1 christos #define BCTR 0x4e800420
161 1.1 christos #define BEQLR 0x4d820020
162 1.1 christos #define CMPWI_11_0 0x2c0b0000
163 1.1 christos #define LIS_11 0x3d600000
164 1.1 christos #define LIS_12 0x3d800000
165 1.1 christos #define LWZU_0_12 0x840c0000
166 1.1 christos #define LWZ_0_12 0x800c0000
167 1.1 christos #define LWZ_11_3 0x81630000
168 1.1 christos #define LWZ_11_11 0x816b0000
169 1.1 christos #define LWZ_11_30 0x817e0000
170 1.1 christos #define LWZ_12_3 0x81830000
171 1.1 christos #define LWZ_12_12 0x818c0000
172 1.1 christos #define MR_0_3 0x7c601b78
173 1.1 christos #define MR_3_0 0x7c030378
174 1.1 christos #define MFLR_0 0x7c0802a6
175 1.1 christos #define MFLR_12 0x7d8802a6
176 1.1 christos #define MTCTR_0 0x7c0903a6
177 1.1 christos #define MTCTR_11 0x7d6903a6
178 1.1 christos #define MTLR_0 0x7c0803a6
179 1.1 christos #define NOP 0x60000000
180 1.1 christos #define SUB_11_11_12 0x7d6c5850
181 1.1 christos
182 1.1 christos /* Offset of tp and dtp pointers from start of TLS block. */
183 1.1 christos #define TP_OFFSET 0x7000
184 1.1 christos #define DTP_OFFSET 0x8000
185 1.1 christos
186 1.1 christos /* The value of a defined global symbol. */
187 1.1 christos #define SYM_VAL(SYM) \
188 1.1 christos ((SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma \
189 1.1 christos + (SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_offset \
190 1.1 christos + (SYM)->root.u.def.value)
191 1.1 christos
192 1.8 christos /* Relocation HOWTO's. */
194 1.8 christos /* Like other ELF RELA targets that don't apply multiple
195 1.8 christos field-altering relocations to the same localation, src_mask is
196 1.8 christos always zero and pcrel_offset is the same as pc_relative.
197 1.8 christos PowerPC can always use a zero bitpos, even when the field is not at
198 1.8 christos the LSB. For example, a REL24 could use rightshift=2, bisize=24
199 1.8 christos and bitpos=2 which matches the ABI description, or as we do here,
200 1.8 christos rightshift=0, bitsize=26 and bitpos=0. */
201 1.8 christos #define HOW(type, size, bitsize, mask, rightshift, pc_relative, \
202 1.8 christos complain, special_func) \
203 1.8 christos HOWTO (type, rightshift, size, bitsize, pc_relative, 0, \
204 1.8 christos complain_overflow_ ## complain, special_func, \
205 1.8 christos #type, FALSE, 0, mask, pc_relative)
206 1.1 christos
207 1.1 christos static reloc_howto_type *ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_max];
208 1.1 christos
209 1.1 christos static reloc_howto_type ppc_elf_howto_raw[] = {
210 1.8 christos /* This reloc does nothing. */
211 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_NONE, 3, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
212 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
213 1.1 christos
214 1.8 christos /* A standard 32 bit relocation. */
215 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
216 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
217 1.1 christos
218 1.1 christos /* An absolute 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
219 1.8 christos FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
220 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
221 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
222 1.1 christos
223 1.8 christos /* A standard 16 bit relocation. */
224 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
225 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
226 1.1 christos
227 1.8 christos /* A 16 bit relocation without overflow. */
228 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
229 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
230 1.1 christos
231 1.8 christos /* The high order 16 bits of an address. */
232 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
233 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
234 1.1 christos
235 1.1 christos /* The high order 16 bits of an address, plus 1 if the contents of
236 1.8 christos the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
237 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
238 1.1 christos ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
239 1.1 christos
240 1.1 christos /* An absolute 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
241 1.8 christos FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
242 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
243 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
244 1.1 christos
245 1.1 christos /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
246 1.1 christos indicate that the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two
247 1.8 christos bits must be zero. */
248 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
249 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
250 1.1 christos
251 1.1 christos /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
252 1.1 christos indicate that the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower
253 1.8 christos two bits must be zero. */
254 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
255 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
256 1.1 christos
257 1.8 christos /* A relative 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
258 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
259 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
260 1.1 christos
261 1.8 christos /* A relative 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
262 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL14, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
263 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
264 1.1 christos
265 1.1 christos /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
266 1.1 christos the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two bits must be
267 1.8 christos zero. */
268 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
269 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
270 1.1 christos
271 1.1 christos /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
272 1.1 christos the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower two bits must
273 1.8 christos be zero. */
274 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
275 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
276 1.1 christos
277 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but referring to the GOT table entry for the
278 1.8 christos symbol. */
279 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
280 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
281 1.1 christos
282 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the GOT table entry for
283 1.8 christos the symbol. */
284 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
285 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
286 1.1 christos
287 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the GOT table entry for
288 1.8 christos the symbol. */
289 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
290 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
291 1.1 christos
292 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the GOT table entry for
293 1.8 christos the symbol. */
294 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
295 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
296 1.1 christos
297 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but referring to the procedure linkage table
298 1.8 christos entry for the symbol. */
299 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
300 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
301 1.1 christos
302 1.1 christos /* This is used only by the dynamic linker. The symbol should exist
303 1.1 christos both in the object being run and in some shared library. The
304 1.1 christos dynamic linker copies the data addressed by the symbol from the
305 1.1 christos shared library into the object, because the object being
306 1.8 christos run has to have the data at some particular address. */
307 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_COPY, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
308 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
309 1.1 christos
310 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but used when setting global offset table
311 1.8 christos entries. */
312 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GLOB_DAT, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
313 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
314 1.1 christos
315 1.8 christos /* Marks a procedure linkage table entry for a symbol. */
316 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_JMP_SLOT, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
317 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
318 1.1 christos
319 1.1 christos /* Used only by the dynamic linker. When the object is run, this
320 1.1 christos longword is set to the load address of the object, plus the
321 1.8 christos addend. */
322 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_RELATIVE, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
323 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
324 1.1 christos
325 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but uses the value of the symbol within the
326 1.1 christos object rather than the final value. Normally used for
327 1.8 christos _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
328 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_LOCAL24PC, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
329 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
330 1.1 christos
331 1.8 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but may be unaligned. */
332 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_UADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
333 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
334 1.1 christos
335 1.8 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but may be unaligned. */
336 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_UADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
337 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
338 1.1 christos
339 1.8 christos /* 32-bit PC relative */
340 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, TRUE, dont,
341 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
342 1.1 christos
343 1.1 christos /* 32-bit relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
344 1.8 christos FIXME: not supported. */
345 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLT32, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
346 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
347 1.1 christos
348 1.1 christos /* 32-bit PC relative relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
349 1.8 christos FIXME: not supported. */
350 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL32, 2, 32, 0, 0, TRUE, dont,
351 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
352 1.1 christos
353 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the PLT table entry for
354 1.8 christos the symbol. */
355 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
356 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
357 1.1 christos
358 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the PLT table entry for
359 1.8 christos the symbol. */
360 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
361 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
362 1.1 christos
363 1.1 christos /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the PLT table entry for
364 1.8 christos the symbol. */
365 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
366 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
367 1.1 christos
368 1.1 christos /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA_BASE_, for use with
369 1.8 christos small data items. */
370 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_SDAREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
371 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
372 1.1 christos
373 1.8 christos /* 16-bit section relative relocation. */
374 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
375 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
376 1.1 christos
377 1.8 christos /* 16-bit lower half section relative relocation. */
378 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
379 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
380 1.1 christos
381 1.8 christos /* 16-bit upper half section relative relocation. */
382 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
383 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
384 1.1 christos
385 1.8 christos /* 16-bit upper half adjusted section relative relocation. */
386 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
387 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
388 1.1 christos
389 1.8 christos /* Marker relocs for TLS. */
390 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_TLS, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
391 1.8 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
392 1.8 christos
393 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_TLSGD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
394 1.8 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
395 1.8 christos
396 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_TLSLD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
397 1.8 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
398 1.8 christos
399 1.8 christos /* Marker relocs on inline plt call instructions. */
400 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLTSEQ, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
401 1.8 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
402 1.8 christos
403 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_PLTCALL, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
404 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
405 1.1 christos
406 1.1 christos /* Computes the load module index of the load module that contains the
407 1.8 christos definition of its TLS sym. */
408 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_DTPMOD32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
409 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
410 1.1 christos
411 1.1 christos /* Computes a dtv-relative displacement, the difference between the value
412 1.1 christos of sym+add and the base address of the thread-local storage block that
413 1.8 christos contains the definition of sym, minus 0x8000. */
414 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
415 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
416 1.1 christos
417 1.8 christos /* A 16 bit dtprel reloc. */
418 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
419 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
420 1.1 christos
421 1.8 christos /* Like DTPREL16, but no overflow. */
422 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
423 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
424 1.1 christos
425 1.8 christos /* Like DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
426 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
427 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
428 1.1 christos
429 1.8 christos /* Like DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
430 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
431 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
432 1.1 christos
433 1.1 christos /* Computes a tp-relative displacement, the difference between the value of
434 1.8 christos sym+add and the value of the thread pointer (r13). */
435 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_TPREL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
436 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
437 1.1 christos
438 1.8 christos /* A 16 bit tprel reloc. */
439 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
440 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
441 1.1 christos
442 1.8 christos /* Like TPREL16, but no overflow. */
443 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
444 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
445 1.1 christos
446 1.8 christos /* Like TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
447 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
448 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
449 1.1 christos
450 1.8 christos /* Like TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
451 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
452 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
453 1.1 christos
454 1.1 christos /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
455 1.1 christos with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes the offset
456 1.8 christos to the first entry. */
457 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
458 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
459 1.1 christos
460 1.8 christos /* Like GOT_TLSGD16, but no overflow. */
461 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
462 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
463 1.1 christos
464 1.8 christos /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
465 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
466 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
467 1.1 christos
468 1.8 christos /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
469 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
470 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
471 1.1 christos
472 1.1 christos /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
473 1.1 christos with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and zero, and computes the offset to the
474 1.8 christos first entry. */
475 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
476 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
477 1.1 christos
478 1.8 christos /* Like GOT_TLSLD16, but no overflow. */
479 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
480 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
481 1.1 christos
482 1.8 christos /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
483 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
484 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
485 1.1 christos
486 1.8 christos /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
487 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
488 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
489 1.1 christos
490 1.1 christos /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes
491 1.8 christos the offset to the entry. */
492 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
493 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
494 1.1 christos
495 1.8 christos /* Like GOT_DTPREL16, but no overflow. */
496 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
497 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
498 1.1 christos
499 1.8 christos /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
500 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
501 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
502 1.1 christos
503 1.8 christos /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
504 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
505 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
506 1.1 christos
507 1.1 christos /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@tprel, and computes the
508 1.8 christos offset to the entry. */
509 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
510 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
511 1.1 christos
512 1.8 christos /* Like GOT_TPREL16, but no overflow. */
513 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
514 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
515 1.1 christos
516 1.8 christos /* Like GOT_TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
517 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
518 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
519 1.1 christos
520 1.8 christos /* Like GOT_TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
521 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
522 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
523 1.1 christos
524 1.1 christos /* The remaining relocs are from the Embedded ELF ABI, and are not
525 1.1 christos in the SVR4 ELF ABI. */
526 1.1 christos
527 1.8 christos /* 32 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
528 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
529 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
530 1.1 christos
531 1.8 christos /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
532 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
533 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
534 1.1 christos
535 1.8 christos /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
536 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
537 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
538 1.1 christos
539 1.8 christos /* The high order 16 bits of the addend minus the symbol. */
540 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
541 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
542 1.1 christos
543 1.1 christos /* The high order 16 bits of the result of the addend minus the address,
544 1.1 christos plus 1 if the contents of the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number,
545 1.8 christos is negative. */
546 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
547 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
548 1.1 christos
549 1.1 christos /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
550 1.1 christos address in the .sdata section, and returning the offset from
551 1.8 christos _SDA_BASE_ for that relocation. */
552 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
553 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
554 1.1 christos
555 1.1 christos /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
556 1.1 christos address in the .sdata2 section, and returning the offset from
557 1.8 christos _SDA2_BASE_ for that relocation. */
558 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
559 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
560 1.1 christos
561 1.1 christos /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA2_BASE_, for use with
562 1.8 christos small data items. */
563 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
564 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
565 1.1 christos
566 1.1 christos /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling in the 16 bit
567 1.1 christos signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the register
568 1.8 christos field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13). */
569 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA21, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
570 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
571 1.1 christos
572 1.1 christos /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF */
573 1.1 christos /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16 */
574 1.1 christos /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO */
575 1.1 christos /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI */
576 1.1 christos /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA */
577 1.1 christos /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD */
578 1.1 christos
579 1.1 christos /* PC relative relocation against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling
580 1.1 christos in the 16 bit signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the
581 1.8 christos register field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13). */
582 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
583 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
584 1.1 christos
585 1.8 christos /* A relative 8 bit branch. */
586 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL8, 1, 8, 0xff, 1, TRUE, signed,
587 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
588 1.1 christos
589 1.8 christos /* A relative 15 bit branch. */
590 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL15, 2, 16, 0xfffe, 0, TRUE, signed,
591 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
592 1.1 christos
593 1.8 christos /* A relative 24 bit branch. */
594 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL24, 2, 25, 0x1fffffe, 0, TRUE, signed,
595 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
596 1.1 christos
597 1.8 christos /* The 16 LSBS in split16a format. */
598 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
599 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
600 1.1 christos
601 1.8 christos /* The 16 LSBS in split16d format. */
602 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
603 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
604 1.1 christos
605 1.8 christos /* Bits 16-31 split16a format. */
606 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
607 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
608 1.1 christos
609 1.8 christos /* Bits 16-31 split16d format. */
610 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
611 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
612 1.1 christos
613 1.8 christos /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16a format. */
614 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
615 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
616 1.1 christos
617 1.8 christos /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16d format. */
618 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
619 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
620 1.3 christos
621 1.3 christos /* This reloc is like R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 but only applies to e_add16i
622 1.3 christos instructions. If the register base is 0 then the linker changes
623 1.8 christos the e_add16i to an e_li instruction. */
624 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
625 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
626 1.3 christos
627 1.8 christos /* Like R_PPC_VLE_SDA21 but ignore overflow. */
628 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
629 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
630 1.1 christos
631 1.8 christos /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format. */
632 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
633 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
634 1.1 christos
635 1.8 christos /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format. */
636 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
637 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
638 1.1 christos
639 1.8 christos /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format. */
640 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
641 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
642 1.1 christos
643 1.8 christos /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format. */
644 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
645 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
646 1.1 christos
647 1.8 christos /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16a format. */
648 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
649 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
650 1.1 christos
651 1.8 christos /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16d format. */
652 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
653 1.8 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
654 1.8 christos
655 1.8 christos /* e_li split20 format. */
656 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20, 2, 20, 0x1f7fff, 0, FALSE, dont,
657 1.8 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
658 1.8 christos
659 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_IRELATIVE, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
660 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
661 1.1 christos
662 1.8 christos /* A 16 bit relative relocation. */
663 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, signed,
664 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
665 1.1 christos
666 1.8 christos /* A 16 bit relative relocation without overflow. */
667 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, dont,
668 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
669 1.1 christos
670 1.8 christos /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address. */
671 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
672 1.1 christos bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
673 1.1 christos
674 1.1 christos /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address, plus 1 if the contents of
675 1.8 christos the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
676 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
677 1.1 christos ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
678 1.6 christos
679 1.8 christos /* Like R_PPC_REL16_HA but for split field in addpcis. */
680 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_REL16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, TRUE, signed,
681 1.6 christos ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
682 1.7 christos
683 1.8 christos /* A split-field reloc for addpcis, non-relative (gas internal use only). */
684 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, FALSE, signed,
685 1.7 christos ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
686 1.1 christos
687 1.8 christos /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable hierarchy. */
688 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
689 1.1 christos NULL),
690 1.1 christos
691 1.8 christos /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable member usage. */
692 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
693 1.1 christos NULL),
694 1.1 christos
695 1.8 christos /* Phony reloc to handle AIX style TOC entries. */
696 1.8 christos HOW (R_PPC_TOC16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
697 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
698 1.1 christos };
699 1.1 christos
700 1.1 christos /* Initialize the ppc_elf_howto_table, so that linear accesses can be done. */
702 1.1 christos
703 1.1 christos static void
704 1.1 christos ppc_elf_howto_init (void)
705 1.1 christos {
706 1.1 christos unsigned int i, type;
707 1.1 christos
708 1.1 christos for (i = 0;
709 1.1 christos i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
710 1.1 christos i++)
711 1.1 christos {
712 1.1 christos type = ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].type;
713 1.1 christos if (type >= (sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table)
714 1.1 christos / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table[0])))
715 1.1 christos abort ();
716 1.1 christos ppc_elf_howto_table[type] = &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
717 1.1 christos }
718 1.1 christos }
719 1.1 christos
720 1.1 christos static reloc_howto_type *
721 1.1 christos ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
722 1.1 christos bfd_reloc_code_real_type code)
723 1.1 christos {
724 1.1 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r;
725 1.1 christos
726 1.1 christos /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
727 1.1 christos if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
728 1.1 christos ppc_elf_howto_init ();
729 1.1 christos
730 1.1 christos switch (code)
731 1.1 christos {
732 1.1 christos default:
733 1.1 christos return NULL;
734 1.1 christos
735 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_NONE: r = R_PPC_NONE; break;
736 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_32: r = R_PPC_ADDR32; break;
737 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA26: r = R_PPC_ADDR24; break;
738 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
739 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16; break;
740 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
741 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_LO16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_LO; break;
742 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HI; break;
743 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HA; break;
744 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16: r = R_PPC_ADDR14; break;
745 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN; break;
746 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN; break;
747 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B26: r = R_PPC_REL24; break;
748 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16: r = R_PPC_REL14; break;
749 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN; break;
750 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN; break;
751 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
752 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16; break;
753 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
754 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_LO16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_LO; break;
755 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_HI; break;
756 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_HA; break;
757 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_24_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC_PLTREL24; break;
758 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_COPY: r = R_PPC_COPY; break;
759 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GLOB_DAT: r = R_PPC_GLOB_DAT; break;
760 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_LOCAL24PC: r = R_PPC_LOCAL24PC; break;
761 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL32; break;
762 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_32_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT32; break;
763 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_32_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC_PLTREL32; break;
764 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
765 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_LO; break;
766 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_HI; break;
767 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_HA; break;
768 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_GPREL16: r = R_PPC_SDAREL16; break;
769 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:
770 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF; break;
771 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:
772 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_LO16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO; break;
773 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI; break;
774 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA; break;
775 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_CTOR: r = R_PPC_ADDR32; break;
776 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
777 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TOC16: r = R_PPC_TOC16; break;
778 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLS: r = R_PPC_TLS; break;
779 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSGD: r = R_PPC_TLSGD; break;
780 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSLD: r = R_PPC_TLSLD; break;
781 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPMOD: r = R_PPC_DTPMOD32; break;
782 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
783 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16: r = R_PPC_TPREL16; break;
784 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
785 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO; break;
786 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HI; break;
787 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA; break;
788 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL: r = R_PPC_TPREL32; break;
789 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:
790 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16; break;
791 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
792 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO; break;
793 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI; break;
794 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA; break;
795 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL: r = R_PPC_DTPREL32; break;
796 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16; break;
797 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO; break;
798 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI; break;
799 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA; break;
800 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16; break;
801 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO; break;
802 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI; break;
803 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA; break;
804 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16; break;
805 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO; break;
806 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI; break;
807 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA; break;
808 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16; break;
809 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO; break;
810 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI; break;
811 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA; break;
812 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR32: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32; break;
813 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16; break;
814 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO; break;
815 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI; break;
816 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA; break;
817 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDAI16: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16; break;
818 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16; break;
819 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL; break;
820 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA21: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA21; break;
821 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_MRKREF: r = R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF; break;
822 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16; break;
823 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO; break;
824 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI; break;
825 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA; break;
826 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD: r = R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD; break;
827 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSDA: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA; break;
828 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL8: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL8; break;
829 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL15: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL15; break;
830 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL24: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL24; break;
831 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16A; break;
832 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16D; break;
833 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16A; break;
834 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16D; break;
835 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16A; break;
836 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16D; break;
837 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21: r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21; break;
838 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO: r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO; break;
839 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
840 1.1 christos r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A;
841 1.1 christos break;
842 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
843 1.1 christos r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D;
844 1.1 christos break;
845 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
846 1.1 christos r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A;
847 1.1 christos break;
848 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
849 1.1 christos r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D;
850 1.1 christos break;
851 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
852 1.1 christos r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A;
853 1.1 christos break;
854 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
855 1.1 christos r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D;
856 1.1 christos break;
857 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16; break;
858 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_LO; break;
859 1.7 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_HI; break;
860 1.6 christos case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_HA; break;
861 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_16DX_HA: r = R_PPC_16DX_HA; break;
862 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_PPC_REL16DX_HA: r = R_PPC_REL16DX_HA; break;
863 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_INHERIT: r = R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT; break;
864 1.1 christos case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY: r = R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY; break;
865 1.1 christos }
866 1.1 christos
867 1.1 christos return ppc_elf_howto_table[r];
868 1.1 christos };
869 1.1 christos
870 1.1 christos static reloc_howto_type *
871 1.1 christos ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
872 1.1 christos const char *r_name)
873 1.1 christos {
874 1.1 christos unsigned int i;
875 1.1 christos
876 1.1 christos for (i = 0;
877 1.1 christos i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
878 1.1 christos i++)
879 1.1 christos if (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name != NULL
880 1.1 christos && strcasecmp (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name, r_name) == 0)
881 1.1 christos return &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
882 1.1 christos
883 1.1 christos return NULL;
884 1.1 christos }
885 1.1 christos
886 1.8 christos /* Set the howto pointer for a PowerPC ELF reloc. */
887 1.7 christos
888 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
889 1.1 christos ppc_elf_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd,
890 1.1 christos arelent *cache_ptr,
891 1.5 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *dst)
892 1.5 christos {
893 1.1 christos unsigned int r_type;
894 1.1 christos
895 1.1 christos /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
896 1.1 christos if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
897 1.5 christos ppc_elf_howto_init ();
898 1.5 christos
899 1.5 christos r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info);
900 1.7 christos if (r_type >= R_PPC_max)
901 1.8 christos {
902 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
903 1.5 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
904 1.8 christos abfd, r_type);
905 1.5 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
906 1.8 christos return FALSE;
907 1.5 christos }
908 1.1 christos
909 1.1 christos cache_ptr->howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
910 1.1 christos
911 1.8 christos /* Just because the above assert didn't trigger doesn't mean that
912 1.1 christos ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info) is necessarily a valid relocation. */
913 1.7 christos if (cache_ptr->howto == NULL)
914 1.8 christos {
915 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
916 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
917 1.1 christos abfd, r_type);
918 1.8 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
919 1.1 christos
920 1.8 christos return FALSE;
921 1.8 christos }
922 1.1 christos
923 1.1 christos return TRUE;
924 1.1 christos }
925 1.1 christos
926 1.1 christos /* Handle the R_PPC_ADDR16_HA and R_PPC_REL16_HA relocs. */
927 1.7 christos
928 1.1 christos static bfd_reloc_status_type
929 1.1 christos ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd,
930 1.7 christos arelent *reloc_entry,
931 1.1 christos asymbol *symbol,
932 1.1 christos void *data,
933 1.1 christos asection *input_section,
934 1.1 christos bfd *output_bfd,
935 1.6 christos char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
936 1.6 christos {
937 1.6 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
938 1.6 christos long insn;
939 1.1 christos bfd_size_type octets;
940 1.1 christos bfd_vma value;
941 1.1 christos
942 1.1 christos if (output_bfd != NULL)
943 1.1 christos {
944 1.1 christos reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
945 1.1 christos return bfd_reloc_ok;
946 1.6 christos }
947 1.6 christos
948 1.6 christos reloc_entry->addend += 0x8000;
949 1.6 christos r_type = reloc_entry->howto->type;
950 1.6 christos if (r_type != R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
951 1.6 christos return bfd_reloc_continue;
952 1.6 christos
953 1.6 christos value = 0;
954 1.6 christos if (!bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
955 1.6 christos value = symbol->value;
956 1.6 christos value += (reloc_entry->addend
957 1.6 christos + symbol->section->output_offset
958 1.6 christos + symbol->section->output_section->vma);
959 1.6 christos value -= (reloc_entry->address
960 1.6 christos + input_section->output_offset
961 1.6 christos + input_section->output_section->vma);
962 1.9 christos value >>= 16;
963 1.6 christos
964 1.6 christos octets = reloc_entry->address * OCTETS_PER_BYTE (abfd, input_section);
965 1.6 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
966 1.6 christos insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
967 1.6 christos insn |= (value & 0xffc1) | ((value & 0x3e) << 15);
968 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
969 1.1 christos return bfd_reloc_ok;
970 1.1 christos }
971 1.1 christos
972 1.1 christos static bfd_reloc_status_type
973 1.1 christos ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc (bfd *abfd,
974 1.1 christos arelent *reloc_entry,
975 1.1 christos asymbol *symbol,
976 1.1 christos void *data,
977 1.1 christos asection *input_section,
978 1.1 christos bfd *output_bfd,
979 1.1 christos char **error_message)
980 1.1 christos {
981 1.1 christos /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
982 1.1 christos call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
983 1.1 christos link time. */
984 1.1 christos if (output_bfd != NULL)
985 1.1 christos return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
986 1.1 christos input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
987 1.1 christos
988 1.1 christos if (error_message != NULL)
989 1.1 christos {
990 1.1 christos static char buf[60];
991 1.1 christos sprintf (buf, _("generic linker can't handle %s"),
992 1.1 christos reloc_entry->howto->name);
993 1.1 christos *error_message = buf;
994 1.1 christos }
995 1.1 christos return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
996 1.1 christos }
997 1.1 christos
998 1.1 christos /* Sections created by the linker. */
1000 1.1 christos
1001 1.1 christos typedef struct elf_linker_section
1002 1.1 christos {
1003 1.1 christos /* Pointer to the bfd section. */
1004 1.1 christos asection *section;
1005 1.1 christos /* Section name. */
1006 1.1 christos const char *name;
1007 1.1 christos /* Associated bss section name. */
1008 1.1 christos const char *bss_name;
1009 1.1 christos /* Associated symbol name. */
1010 1.1 christos const char *sym_name;
1011 1.1 christos /* Associated symbol. */
1012 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sym;
1013 1.1 christos } elf_linker_section_t;
1014 1.1 christos
1015 1.1 christos /* Linked list of allocated pointer entries. This hangs off of the
1016 1.1 christos symbol lists, and provides allows us to return different pointers,
1017 1.1 christos based on different addend's. */
1018 1.1 christos
1019 1.1 christos typedef struct elf_linker_section_pointers
1020 1.1 christos {
1021 1.1 christos /* next allocated pointer for this symbol */
1022 1.1 christos struct elf_linker_section_pointers *next;
1023 1.1 christos /* offset of pointer from beginning of section */
1024 1.1 christos bfd_vma offset;
1025 1.1 christos /* addend used */
1026 1.1 christos bfd_vma addend;
1027 1.1 christos /* which linker section this is */
1028 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_t *lsect;
1029 1.1 christos } elf_linker_section_pointers_t;
1030 1.1 christos
1031 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata
1032 1.1 christos {
1033 1.1 christos struct elf_obj_tdata elf;
1034 1.1 christos
1035 1.1 christos /* A mapping from local symbols to offsets into the various linker
1036 1.1 christos sections added. This is index by the symbol index. */
1037 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_pointers_t **linker_section_pointers;
1038 1.1 christos
1039 1.1 christos /* Flags used to auto-detect plt type. */
1040 1.1 christos unsigned int makes_plt_call : 1;
1041 1.1 christos unsigned int has_rel16 : 1;
1042 1.1 christos };
1043 1.1 christos
1044 1.1 christos #define ppc_elf_tdata(bfd) \
1045 1.1 christos ((struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata *) (bfd)->tdata.any)
1046 1.1 christos
1047 1.1 christos #define elf_local_ptr_offsets(bfd) \
1048 1.1 christos (ppc_elf_tdata (bfd)->linker_section_pointers)
1049 1.1 christos
1050 1.1 christos #define is_ppc_elf(bfd) \
1051 1.1 christos (bfd_get_flavour (bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour \
1052 1.1 christos && elf_object_id (bfd) == PPC32_ELF_DATA)
1053 1.1 christos
1054 1.1 christos /* Override the generic function because we store some extras. */
1055 1.1 christos
1056 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
1057 1.1 christos ppc_elf_mkobject (bfd *abfd)
1058 1.1 christos {
1059 1.1 christos return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata),
1060 1.6 christos PPC32_ELF_DATA);
1061 1.6 christos }
1062 1.6 christos
1063 1.6 christos /* When defaulting arch/mach, decode apuinfo to find a better match. */
1064 1.6 christos
1065 1.6 christos bfd_boolean
1066 1.6 christos _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (bfd *abfd)
1067 1.6 christos {
1068 1.6 christos unsigned long mach = 0;
1069 1.6 christos asection *s;
1070 1.6 christos unsigned char *contents;
1071 1.6 christos
1072 1.6 christos if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32
1073 1.6 christos && bfd_big_endian (abfd))
1074 1.6 christos {
1075 1.6 christos
1076 1.6 christos for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
1077 1.6 christos if ((elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1078 1.6 christos break;
1079 1.6 christos if (s != NULL)
1080 1.6 christos mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
1081 1.6 christos }
1082 1.6 christos
1083 1.9 christos if (mach == 0)
1084 1.9 christos {
1085 1.9 christos s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1086 1.6 christos if (s != NULL
1087 1.6 christos && s->size >= 24
1088 1.6 christos && bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &contents))
1089 1.6 christos {
1090 1.6 christos unsigned int apuinfo_size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + 4);
1091 1.6 christos unsigned int i;
1092 1.6 christos
1093 1.6 christos for (i = 20; i < apuinfo_size + 20 && i + 4 <= s->size; i += 4)
1094 1.6 christos {
1095 1.6 christos unsigned int val = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + i);
1096 1.6 christos switch (val >> 16)
1097 1.6 christos {
1098 1.6 christos case PPC_APUINFO_PMR:
1099 1.6 christos case PPC_APUINFO_RFMCI:
1100 1.6 christos if (mach == 0)
1101 1.6 christos mach = bfd_mach_ppc_titan;
1102 1.6 christos break;
1103 1.6 christos
1104 1.6 christos case PPC_APUINFO_ISEL:
1105 1.6 christos case PPC_APUINFO_CACHELCK:
1106 1.6 christos if (mach == bfd_mach_ppc_titan)
1107 1.6 christos mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500mc;
1108 1.6 christos break;
1109 1.6 christos
1110 1.6 christos case PPC_APUINFO_SPE:
1111 1.6 christos case PPC_APUINFO_EFS:
1112 1.7 christos case PPC_APUINFO_BRLOCK:
1113 1.6 christos if (mach != bfd_mach_ppc_vle)
1114 1.6 christos mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500;
1115 1.6 christos break;
1116 1.6 christos
1117 1.6 christos case PPC_APUINFO_VLE:
1118 1.6 christos mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
1119 1.6 christos break;
1120 1.6 christos
1121 1.6 christos default:
1122 1.6 christos mach = -1ul;
1123 1.6 christos }
1124 1.6 christos }
1125 1.6 christos free (contents);
1126 1.6 christos }
1127 1.6 christos }
1128 1.6 christos
1129 1.6 christos if (mach != 0 && mach != -1ul)
1130 1.6 christos {
1131 1.6 christos const bfd_arch_info_type *arch;
1132 1.6 christos
1133 1.6 christos for (arch = abfd->arch_info->next; arch; arch = arch->next)
1134 1.6 christos if (arch->mach == mach)
1135 1.6 christos {
1136 1.6 christos abfd->arch_info = arch;
1137 1.6 christos break;
1138 1.6 christos }
1139 1.6 christos }
1140 1.1 christos return TRUE;
1141 1.6 christos }
1142 1.1 christos
1143 1.1 christos /* Fix bad default arch selected for a 32 bit input bfd when the
1144 1.1 christos default is 64 bit. Also select arch based on apuinfo. */
1145 1.1 christos
1146 1.6 christos static bfd_boolean
1147 1.6 christos ppc_elf_object_p (bfd *abfd)
1148 1.6 christos {
1149 1.6 christos if (!abfd->arch_info->the_default)
1150 1.1 christos return TRUE;
1151 1.1 christos
1152 1.1 christos if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 64)
1153 1.1 christos {
1154 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
1155 1.1 christos
1156 1.1 christos if (i_ehdr->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
1157 1.1 christos {
1158 1.1 christos /* Relies on arch after 64 bit default being 32 bit default. */
1159 1.1 christos abfd->arch_info = abfd->arch_info->next;
1160 1.6 christos BFD_ASSERT (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32);
1161 1.1 christos }
1162 1.1 christos }
1163 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (abfd);
1164 1.1 christos }
1165 1.1 christos
1166 1.1 christos /* Function to set whether a module needs the -mrelocatable bit set. */
1167 1.1 christos
1168 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
1169 1.1 christos ppc_elf_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
1170 1.1 christos {
1171 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
1172 1.1 christos || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
1173 1.1 christos
1174 1.1 christos elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags;
1175 1.1 christos elf_flags_init (abfd) = TRUE;
1176 1.1 christos return TRUE;
1177 1.1 christos }
1178 1.1 christos
1179 1.1 christos /* Support for core dump NOTE sections. */
1180 1.1 christos
1181 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
1182 1.1 christos ppc_elf_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1183 1.1 christos {
1184 1.1 christos int offset;
1185 1.1 christos unsigned int size;
1186 1.1 christos
1187 1.1 christos switch (note->descsz)
1188 1.1 christos {
1189 1.1 christos default:
1190 1.1 christos return FALSE;
1191 1.1 christos
1192 1.1 christos case 268: /* Linux/PPC. */
1193 1.1 christos /* pr_cursig */
1194 1.1 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_16 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
1195 1.1 christos
1196 1.1 christos /* pr_pid */
1197 1.1 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 24);
1198 1.1 christos
1199 1.1 christos /* pr_reg */
1200 1.1 christos offset = 72;
1201 1.1 christos size = 192;
1202 1.1 christos
1203 1.1 christos break;
1204 1.1 christos }
1205 1.1 christos
1206 1.1 christos /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
1207 1.1 christos return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
1208 1.1 christos size, note->descpos + offset);
1209 1.1 christos }
1210 1.1 christos
1211 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
1212 1.1 christos ppc_elf_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1213 1.1 christos {
1214 1.1 christos switch (note->descsz)
1215 1.1 christos {
1216 1.1 christos default:
1217 1.1 christos return FALSE;
1218 1.1 christos
1219 1.1 christos case 128: /* Linux/PPC elf_prpsinfo. */
1220 1.1 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
1221 1.1 christos = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 16);
1222 1.1 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
1223 1.1 christos = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 32, 16);
1224 1.1 christos elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
1225 1.1 christos = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 48, 80);
1226 1.1 christos }
1227 1.1 christos
1228 1.1 christos /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
1229 1.1 christos onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
1230 1.1 christos implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */
1231 1.1 christos
1232 1.1 christos {
1233 1.1 christos char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
1234 1.1 christos int n = strlen (command);
1235 1.1 christos
1236 1.1 christos if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
1237 1.1 christos command[n - 1] = '\0';
1238 1.1 christos }
1239 1.1 christos
1240 1.1 christos return TRUE;
1241 1.1 christos }
1242 1.1 christos
1243 1.1 christos static char *
1244 1.1 christos ppc_elf_write_core_note (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz, int note_type, ...)
1245 1.1 christos {
1246 1.1 christos switch (note_type)
1247 1.1 christos {
1248 1.1 christos default:
1249 1.1 christos return NULL;
1250 1.8 christos
1251 1.1 christos case NT_PRPSINFO:
1252 1.1 christos {
1253 1.1 christos char data[128] ATTRIBUTE_NONSTRING;
1254 1.1 christos va_list ap;
1255 1.1 christos
1256 1.8 christos va_start (ap, note_type);
1257 1.8 christos memset (data, 0, sizeof (data));
1258 1.8 christos strncpy (data + 32, va_arg (ap, const char *), 16);
1259 1.8 christos #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1260 1.8 christos DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH;
1261 1.8 christos /* GCC 8.0 and 8.1 warn about 80 equals destination size with
1262 1.8 christos -Wstringop-truncation:
1263 1.8 christos https://gcc.gnu.org/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=85643
1264 1.1 christos */
1265 1.8 christos DIAGNOSTIC_IGNORE_STRINGOP_TRUNCATION;
1266 1.8 christos #endif
1267 1.8 christos strncpy (data + 48, va_arg (ap, const char *), 80);
1268 1.1 christos #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1269 1.1 christos DIAGNOSTIC_POP;
1270 1.1 christos #endif
1271 1.1 christos va_end (ap);
1272 1.1 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1273 1.1 christos "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1274 1.1 christos }
1275 1.1 christos
1276 1.1 christos case NT_PRSTATUS:
1277 1.1 christos {
1278 1.1 christos char data[268];
1279 1.1 christos va_list ap;
1280 1.1 christos long pid;
1281 1.1 christos int cursig;
1282 1.1 christos const void *greg;
1283 1.1 christos
1284 1.1 christos va_start (ap, note_type);
1285 1.1 christos memset (data, 0, 72);
1286 1.1 christos pid = va_arg (ap, long);
1287 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, pid, data + 24);
1288 1.1 christos cursig = va_arg (ap, int);
1289 1.1 christos bfd_put_16 (abfd, cursig, data + 12);
1290 1.1 christos greg = va_arg (ap, const void *);
1291 1.1 christos memcpy (data + 72, greg, 192);
1292 1.1 christos memset (data + 264, 0, 4);
1293 1.1 christos va_end (ap);
1294 1.1 christos return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1295 1.1 christos "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1296 1.1 christos }
1297 1.1 christos }
1298 1.1 christos }
1299 1.1 christos
1300 1.1 christos static flagword
1301 1.1 christos ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags (char *flag_name)
1302 1.1 christos {
1303 1.1 christos
1304 1.1 christos if (!strcmp (flag_name, "SHF_PPC_VLE"))
1305 1.1 christos return SHF_PPC_VLE;
1306 1.1 christos
1307 1.1 christos return 0;
1308 1.1 christos }
1309 1.1 christos
1310 1.1 christos /* Return address for Ith PLT stub in section PLT, for relocation REL
1311 1.1 christos or (bfd_vma) -1 if it should not be included. */
1312 1.1 christos
1313 1.1 christos static bfd_vma
1314 1.1 christos ppc_elf_plt_sym_val (bfd_vma i ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1315 1.1 christos const asection *plt ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1316 1.1 christos const arelent *rel)
1317 1.1 christos {
1318 1.1 christos return rel->address;
1319 1.1 christos }
1320 1.1 christos
1321 1.1 christos /* Handle a PowerPC specific section when reading an object file. This
1322 1.1 christos is called when bfd_section_from_shdr finds a section with an unknown
1323 1.1 christos type. */
1324 1.1 christos
1325 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
1326 1.1 christos ppc_elf_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
1327 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
1328 1.1 christos const char *name,
1329 1.1 christos int shindex)
1330 1.1 christos {
1331 1.1 christos asection *newsect;
1332 1.1 christos flagword flags;
1333 1.1 christos
1334 1.1 christos if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
1335 1.9 christos return FALSE;
1336 1.1 christos
1337 1.1 christos newsect = hdr->bfd_section;
1338 1.1 christos flags = 0;
1339 1.1 christos if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE)
1340 1.1 christos flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1341 1.1 christos
1342 1.9 christos if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_ORDERED)
1343 1.9 christos flags |= SEC_SORT_ENTRIES;
1344 1.9 christos
1345 1.9 christos if (strncmp (name, ".PPC.EMB", 8) == 0)
1346 1.9 christos name += 8;
1347 1.9 christos if (strncmp (name, ".sbss", 5) == 0
1348 1.9 christos || strncmp (name, ".sdata", 6) == 0)
1349 1.9 christos flags |= SEC_SMALL_DATA;
1350 1.1 christos
1351 1.1 christos return (flags == 0
1352 1.1 christos || bfd_set_section_flags (newsect, newsect->flags | flags));
1353 1.1 christos }
1354 1.1 christos
1355 1.1 christos /* Set up any other section flags and such that may be necessary. */
1356 1.1 christos
1357 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
1358 1.1 christos ppc_elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1359 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr,
1360 1.1 christos asection *asect)
1361 1.1 christos {
1362 1.1 christos if ((asect->flags & SEC_SORT_ENTRIES) != 0)
1363 1.1 christos shdr->sh_type = SHT_ORDERED;
1364 1.1 christos
1365 1.1 christos return TRUE;
1366 1.1 christos }
1367 1.1 christos
1368 1.1 christos /* If we have .sbss2 or .PPC.EMB.sbss0 output sections, we
1369 1.1 christos need to bump up the number of section headers. */
1370 1.1 christos
1371 1.1 christos static int
1372 1.1 christos ppc_elf_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd,
1373 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1374 1.1 christos {
1375 1.1 christos asection *s;
1376 1.1 christos int ret = 0;
1377 1.1 christos
1378 1.1 christos s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".sbss2");
1379 1.1 christos if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1380 1.1 christos ++ret;
1381 1.1 christos
1382 1.1 christos s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0");
1383 1.1 christos if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1384 1.1 christos ++ret;
1385 1.1 christos
1386 1.1 christos return ret;
1387 1.1 christos }
1388 1.1 christos
1389 1.1 christos /* Modify the segment map for VLE executables. */
1390 1.1 christos
1391 1.1 christos bfd_boolean
1392 1.7 christos ppc_elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
1393 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1394 1.1 christos {
1395 1.1 christos struct elf_segment_map *m;
1396 1.1 christos
1397 1.1 christos /* At this point in the link, output sections have already been sorted by
1398 1.1 christos LMA and assigned to segments. All that is left to do is to ensure
1399 1.1 christos there is no mixing of VLE & non-VLE sections in a text segment.
1400 1.1 christos If we find that case, we split the segment.
1401 1.1 christos We maintain the original output section order. */
1402 1.7 christos
1403 1.9 christos for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
1404 1.7 christos {
1405 1.7 christos struct elf_segment_map *n;
1406 1.7 christos size_t amt;
1407 1.7 christos unsigned int j, k;
1408 1.1 christos unsigned int p_flags;
1409 1.1 christos
1410 1.7 christos if (m->p_type != PT_LOAD || m->count == 0)
1411 1.1 christos continue;
1412 1.7 christos
1413 1.7 christos for (p_flags = PF_R, j = 0; j != m->count; ++j)
1414 1.7 christos {
1415 1.7 christos if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
1416 1.7 christos p_flags |= PF_W;
1417 1.7 christos if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
1418 1.7 christos {
1419 1.7 christos p_flags |= PF_X;
1420 1.7 christos if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1421 1.7 christos p_flags |= PF_PPC_VLE;
1422 1.7 christos break;
1423 1.7 christos }
1424 1.7 christos }
1425 1.7 christos if (j != m->count)
1426 1.1 christos while (++j != m->count)
1427 1.7 christos {
1428 1.7 christos unsigned int p_flags1 = PF_R;
1429 1.7 christos
1430 1.7 christos if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
1431 1.7 christos p_flags1 |= PF_W;
1432 1.7 christos if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
1433 1.7 christos {
1434 1.7 christos p_flags1 |= PF_X;
1435 1.7 christos if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1436 1.7 christos p_flags1 |= PF_PPC_VLE;
1437 1.7 christos if (((p_flags1 ^ p_flags) & PF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1438 1.7 christos break;
1439 1.7 christos }
1440 1.7 christos p_flags |= p_flags1;
1441 1.7 christos }
1442 1.7 christos /* If we're splitting a segment which originally contained rw
1443 1.7 christos sections then those sections might now only be in one of the
1444 1.7 christos two parts. So always set p_flags if splitting, even if we
1445 1.7 christos are being called for objcopy with p_flags_valid set. */
1446 1.7 christos if (j != m->count || !m->p_flags_valid)
1447 1.7 christos {
1448 1.7 christos m->p_flags_valid = 1;
1449 1.1 christos m->p_flags = p_flags;
1450 1.1 christos }
1451 1.7 christos if (j == m->count)
1452 1.1 christos continue;
1453 1.1 christos
1454 1.1 christos /* Sections 0..j-1 stay in this (current) segment,
1455 1.1 christos the remainder are put in a new segment.
1456 1.1 christos The scan resumes with the new segment. */
1457 1.1 christos
1458 1.1 christos amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
1459 1.8 christos amt += (m->count - j - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
1460 1.1 christos n = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
1461 1.1 christos if (n == NULL)
1462 1.1 christos return FALSE;
1463 1.1 christos
1464 1.7 christos n->p_type = PT_LOAD;
1465 1.7 christos n->count = m->count - j;
1466 1.7 christos for (k = 0; k < n->count; ++k)
1467 1.1 christos n->sections[k] = m->sections[j + k];
1468 1.1 christos m->count = j;
1469 1.1 christos m->p_size_valid = 0;
1470 1.1 christos n->next = m->next;
1471 1.1 christos m->next = n;
1472 1.1 christos }
1473 1.1 christos
1474 1.1 christos return TRUE;
1475 1.1 christos }
1476 1.1 christos
1477 1.1 christos /* Add extra PPC sections -- Note, for now, make .sbss2 and
1478 1.1 christos .PPC.EMB.sbss0 a normal section, and not a bss section so
1479 1.1 christos that the linker doesn't crater when trying to make more than
1480 1.1 christos 2 sections. */
1481 1.6 christos
1482 1.6 christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_elf_special_sections[] =
1483 1.6 christos {
1484 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
1485 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1486 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1487 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1488 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1489 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tags"), 0, SHT_ORDERED, SHF_ALLOC },
1490 1.6 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (APUINFO_SECTION_NAME), 0, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
1491 1.1 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sbss0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1492 1.1 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sdata0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1493 1.1 christos { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
1494 1.1 christos };
1495 1.8 christos
1496 1.1 christos /* This is what we want for new plt/got. */
1497 1.1 christos static struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_alt_plt =
1498 1.7 christos { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC };
1499 1.1 christos
1500 1.1 christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
1501 1.1 christos ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
1502 1.1 christos {
1503 1.1 christos const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
1504 1.1 christos
1505 1.1 christos /* See if this is one of the special sections. */
1506 1.1 christos if (sec->name == NULL)
1507 1.1 christos return NULL;
1508 1.1 christos
1509 1.1 christos ssect = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, ppc_elf_special_sections,
1510 1.1 christos sec->use_rela_p);
1511 1.1 christos if (ssect != NULL)
1512 1.1 christos {
1513 1.1 christos if (ssect == ppc_elf_special_sections && (sec->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
1514 1.1 christos ssect = &ppc_alt_plt;
1515 1.1 christos return ssect;
1516 1.1 christos }
1517 1.1 christos
1518 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
1519 1.1 christos }
1520 1.1 christos
1521 1.1 christos /* Very simple linked list structure for recording apuinfo values. */
1523 1.1 christos typedef struct apuinfo_list
1524 1.1 christos {
1525 1.1 christos struct apuinfo_list *next;
1526 1.1 christos unsigned long value;
1527 1.1 christos }
1528 1.1 christos apuinfo_list;
1529 1.1 christos
1530 1.1 christos static apuinfo_list *head;
1531 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean apuinfo_set;
1532 1.1 christos
1533 1.1 christos static void
1534 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_init (void)
1535 1.1 christos {
1536 1.1 christos head = NULL;
1537 1.1 christos apuinfo_set = FALSE;
1538 1.1 christos }
1539 1.1 christos
1540 1.1 christos static void
1541 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_add (unsigned long value)
1542 1.1 christos {
1543 1.1 christos apuinfo_list *entry = head;
1544 1.1 christos
1545 1.1 christos while (entry != NULL)
1546 1.1 christos {
1547 1.1 christos if (entry->value == value)
1548 1.1 christos return;
1549 1.1 christos entry = entry->next;
1550 1.1 christos }
1551 1.1 christos
1552 1.1 christos entry = bfd_malloc (sizeof (* entry));
1553 1.1 christos if (entry == NULL)
1554 1.1 christos return;
1555 1.1 christos
1556 1.1 christos entry->value = value;
1557 1.1 christos entry->next = head;
1558 1.1 christos head = entry;
1559 1.1 christos }
1560 1.1 christos
1561 1.1 christos static unsigned
1562 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_length (void)
1563 1.1 christos {
1564 1.1 christos apuinfo_list *entry;
1565 1.1 christos unsigned long count;
1566 1.1 christos
1567 1.1 christos for (entry = head, count = 0;
1568 1.1 christos entry;
1569 1.1 christos entry = entry->next)
1570 1.1 christos ++ count;
1571 1.1 christos
1572 1.1 christos return count;
1573 1.1 christos }
1574 1.1 christos
1575 1.1 christos static inline unsigned long
1576 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_element (unsigned long number)
1577 1.1 christos {
1578 1.1 christos apuinfo_list * entry;
1579 1.1 christos
1580 1.1 christos for (entry = head;
1581 1.1 christos entry && number --;
1582 1.1 christos entry = entry->next)
1583 1.1 christos ;
1584 1.1 christos
1585 1.1 christos return entry ? entry->value : 0;
1586 1.1 christos }
1587 1.1 christos
1588 1.1 christos static void
1589 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_finish (void)
1590 1.1 christos {
1591 1.1 christos apuinfo_list *entry;
1592 1.1 christos
1593 1.1 christos for (entry = head; entry;)
1594 1.1 christos {
1595 1.1 christos apuinfo_list *next = entry->next;
1596 1.1 christos free (entry);
1597 1.1 christos entry = next;
1598 1.1 christos }
1599 1.1 christos
1600 1.1 christos head = NULL;
1601 1.1 christos }
1602 1.1 christos
1603 1.1 christos /* Scan the input BFDs and create a linked list of
1604 1.1 christos the APUinfo values that will need to be emitted. */
1605 1.1 christos
1606 1.1 christos static void
1607 1.1 christos ppc_elf_begin_write_processing (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
1608 1.1 christos {
1609 1.1 christos bfd *ibfd;
1610 1.1 christos asection *asec;
1611 1.1 christos char *buffer = NULL;
1612 1.1 christos bfd_size_type largest_input_size = 0;
1613 1.1 christos unsigned i;
1614 1.1 christos unsigned long length;
1615 1.1 christos const char *error_message = NULL;
1616 1.1 christos
1617 1.1 christos if (link_info == NULL)
1618 1.1 christos return;
1619 1.3 christos
1620 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_init ();
1621 1.1 christos
1622 1.1 christos /* Read in the input sections contents. */
1623 1.1 christos for (ibfd = link_info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
1624 1.1 christos {
1625 1.1 christos unsigned long datum;
1626 1.1 christos
1627 1.7 christos asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1628 1.8 christos if (asec == NULL)
1629 1.1 christos continue;
1630 1.1 christos
1631 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
1632 1.1 christos error_message = _("corrupt %s section in %pB");
1633 1.1 christos length = asec->size;
1634 1.1 christos if (length < 20)
1635 1.1 christos goto fail;
1636 1.9 christos
1637 1.1 christos apuinfo_set = TRUE;
1638 1.1 christos if (largest_input_size < asec->size)
1639 1.1 christos {
1640 1.1 christos free (buffer);
1641 1.1 christos largest_input_size = asec->size;
1642 1.1 christos buffer = bfd_malloc (largest_input_size);
1643 1.1 christos if (!buffer)
1644 1.1 christos return;
1645 1.1 christos }
1646 1.7 christos
1647 1.8 christos if (bfd_seek (ibfd, asec->filepos, SEEK_SET) != 0
1648 1.1 christos || (bfd_bread (buffer, length, ibfd) != length))
1649 1.1 christos {
1650 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
1651 1.1 christos error_message = _("unable to read in %s section from %pB");
1652 1.1 christos goto fail;
1653 1.1 christos }
1654 1.1 christos
1655 1.1 christos /* Verify the contents of the header. Note - we have to
1656 1.1 christos extract the values this way in order to allow for a
1657 1.1 christos host whose endian-ness is different from the target. */
1658 1.1 christos datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer);
1659 1.1 christos if (datum != sizeof APUINFO_LABEL)
1660 1.1 christos goto fail;
1661 1.1 christos
1662 1.1 christos datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 8);
1663 1.1 christos if (datum != 0x2)
1664 1.1 christos goto fail;
1665 1.1 christos
1666 1.1 christos if (strcmp (buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL) != 0)
1667 1.1 christos goto fail;
1668 1.1 christos
1669 1.1 christos /* Get the number of bytes used for apuinfo entries. */
1670 1.1 christos datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 4);
1671 1.1 christos if (datum + 20 != length)
1672 1.1 christos goto fail;
1673 1.1 christos
1674 1.1 christos /* Scan the apuinfo section, building a list of apuinfo numbers. */
1675 1.1 christos for (i = 0; i < datum; i += 4)
1676 1.1 christos apuinfo_list_add (bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 20 + i));
1677 1.1 christos }
1678 1.1 christos
1679 1.1 christos error_message = NULL;
1680 1.1 christos
1681 1.1 christos if (apuinfo_set)
1682 1.1 christos {
1683 1.1 christos /* Compute the size of the output section. */
1684 1.1 christos unsigned num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
1685 1.9 christos
1686 1.1 christos /* Set the output section size, if it exists. */
1687 1.1 christos asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1688 1.7 christos
1689 1.8 christos if (asec && !bfd_set_section_size (asec, 20 + num_entries * 4))
1690 1.1 christos {
1691 1.1 christos ibfd = abfd;
1692 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
1693 1.1 christos error_message = _("warning: unable to set size of %s section in %pB");
1694 1.9 christos }
1695 1.1 christos }
1696 1.1 christos
1697 1.8 christos fail:
1698 1.1 christos free (buffer);
1699 1.1 christos
1700 1.1 christos if (error_message)
1701 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (error_message, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME, ibfd);
1702 1.1 christos }
1703 1.1 christos
1704 1.1 christos /* Prevent the output section from accumulating the input sections'
1705 1.1 christos contents. We have already stored this in our linked list structure. */
1706 1.1 christos
1707 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
1708 1.1 christos ppc_elf_write_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1709 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1710 1.1 christos asection *asec,
1711 1.1 christos bfd_byte *contents ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1712 1.1 christos {
1713 1.1 christos return apuinfo_set && strcmp (asec->name, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME) == 0;
1714 1.1 christos }
1715 1.9 christos
1716 1.1 christos /* Finally we can generate the output section. */
1717 1.1 christos
1718 1.1 christos static void
1719 1.1 christos ppc_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
1720 1.1 christos {
1721 1.1 christos bfd_byte *buffer;
1722 1.1 christos asection *asec;
1723 1.1 christos unsigned i;
1724 1.1 christos unsigned num_entries;
1725 1.1 christos bfd_size_type length;
1726 1.1 christos
1727 1.1 christos asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1728 1.1 christos if (asec == NULL)
1729 1.1 christos return;
1730 1.1 christos
1731 1.1 christos if (!apuinfo_set)
1732 1.1 christos return;
1733 1.1 christos
1734 1.1 christos length = asec->size;
1735 1.1 christos if (length < 20)
1736 1.1 christos return;
1737 1.7 christos
1738 1.8 christos buffer = bfd_malloc (length);
1739 1.1 christos if (buffer == NULL)
1740 1.1 christos {
1741 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler
1742 1.1 christos (_("failed to allocate space for new APUinfo section"));
1743 1.1 christos return;
1744 1.1 christos }
1745 1.1 christos
1746 1.1 christos /* Create the apuinfo header. */
1747 1.1 christos num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
1748 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, sizeof APUINFO_LABEL, buffer);
1749 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, num_entries * 4, buffer + 4);
1750 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, 0x2, buffer + 8);
1751 1.1 christos strcpy ((char *) buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL);
1752 1.1 christos
1753 1.1 christos length = 20;
1754 1.1 christos for (i = 0; i < num_entries; i++)
1755 1.1 christos {
1756 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, apuinfo_list_element (i), buffer + length);
1757 1.8 christos length += 4;
1758 1.1 christos }
1759 1.1 christos
1760 1.8 christos if (length != asec->size)
1761 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to compute new APUinfo section"));
1762 1.1 christos
1763 1.1 christos if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, asec, buffer, (file_ptr) 0, length))
1764 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to install new APUinfo section"));
1765 1.1 christos
1766 1.9 christos free (buffer);
1767 1.9 christos
1768 1.9 christos apuinfo_list_finish ();
1769 1.9 christos }
1770 1.9 christos
1771 1.9 christos static bfd_boolean
1772 1.9 christos ppc_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
1773 1.1 christos {
1774 1.1 christos ppc_final_write_processing (abfd);
1775 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_final_write_processing (abfd);
1776 1.1 christos }
1777 1.8 christos
1778 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
1780 1.1 christos is_nonpic_glink_stub (bfd *abfd, asection *glink, bfd_vma off)
1781 1.1 christos {
1782 1.1 christos bfd_byte buf[4 * 4];
1783 1.1 christos
1784 1.1 christos if (!bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf, off, sizeof buf))
1785 1.1 christos return FALSE;
1786 1.1 christos
1787 1.1 christos return ((bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 0) & 0xffff0000) == LIS_11
1788 1.1 christos && (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 4) & 0xffff0000) == LWZ_11_11
1789 1.1 christos && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 8) == MTCTR_11
1790 1.1 christos && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 12) == BCTR);
1791 1.1 christos }
1792 1.1 christos
1793 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
1794 1.1 christos section_covers_vma (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section, void *ptr)
1795 1.1 christos {
1796 1.1 christos bfd_vma vma = *(bfd_vma *) ptr;
1797 1.1 christos return ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
1798 1.1 christos && section->vma <= vma
1799 1.1 christos && vma < section->vma + section->size);
1800 1.1 christos }
1801 1.1 christos
1802 1.1 christos static long
1803 1.1 christos ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd, long symcount, asymbol **syms,
1804 1.1 christos long dynsymcount, asymbol **dynsyms,
1805 1.1 christos asymbol **ret)
1806 1.8 christos {
1807 1.1 christos bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
1808 1.1 christos asection *plt, *relplt, *dynamic, *glink;
1809 1.9 christos bfd_vma glink_vma = 0;
1810 1.1 christos bfd_vma resolv_vma = 0;
1811 1.1 christos bfd_vma stub_off;
1812 1.1 christos asymbol *s;
1813 1.1 christos arelent *p;
1814 1.1 christos size_t count, i, stub_delta;
1815 1.1 christos size_t size;
1816 1.1 christos char *names;
1817 1.1 christos bfd_byte buf[4];
1818 1.1 christos
1819 1.1 christos *ret = NULL;
1820 1.1 christos
1821 1.1 christos if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
1822 1.1 christos return 0;
1823 1.1 christos
1824 1.1 christos if (dynsymcount <= 0)
1825 1.1 christos return 0;
1826 1.1 christos
1827 1.1 christos relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.plt");
1828 1.1 christos if (relplt == NULL)
1829 1.1 christos return 0;
1830 1.1 christos
1831 1.1 christos plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
1832 1.1 christos if (plt == NULL)
1833 1.1 christos return 0;
1834 1.1 christos
1835 1.1 christos /* Call common code to handle old-style executable PLTs. */
1836 1.1 christos if (elf_section_flags (plt) & SHF_EXECINSTR)
1837 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (abfd, symcount, syms,
1838 1.1 christos dynsymcount, dynsyms, ret);
1839 1.1 christos
1840 1.1 christos /* If this object was prelinked, the prelinker stored the address
1841 1.1 christos of .glink at got[1]. If it wasn't prelinked, got[1] will be zero. */
1842 1.1 christos dynamic = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
1843 1.1 christos if (dynamic != NULL)
1844 1.1 christos {
1845 1.1 christos bfd_byte *dynbuf, *extdyn, *extdynend;
1846 1.1 christos size_t extdynsize;
1847 1.1 christos void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
1848 1.1 christos
1849 1.1 christos if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, dynamic, &dynbuf))
1850 1.1 christos return -1;
1851 1.1 christos
1852 1.1 christos extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
1853 1.1 christos swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
1854 1.1 christos
1855 1.1 christos extdyn = dynbuf;
1856 1.1 christos extdynend = extdyn + dynamic->size;
1857 1.1 christos for (; extdyn < extdynend; extdyn += extdynsize)
1858 1.1 christos {
1859 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
1860 1.1 christos (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
1861 1.1 christos
1862 1.1 christos if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
1863 1.1 christos break;
1864 1.1 christos
1865 1.1 christos if (dyn.d_tag == DT_PPC_GOT)
1866 1.1 christos {
1867 1.1 christos unsigned int g_o_t = dyn.d_un.d_val;
1868 1.1 christos asection *got = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got");
1869 1.1 christos if (got != NULL
1870 1.1 christos && bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, got, buf,
1871 1.1 christos g_o_t - got->vma + 4, 4))
1872 1.1 christos glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1873 1.1 christos break;
1874 1.1 christos }
1875 1.1 christos }
1876 1.1 christos free (dynbuf);
1877 1.1 christos }
1878 1.1 christos
1879 1.1 christos /* Otherwise we read the first plt entry. */
1880 1.1 christos if (glink_vma == 0)
1881 1.1 christos {
1882 1.1 christos if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, plt, buf, 0, 4))
1883 1.1 christos glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1884 1.1 christos }
1885 1.1 christos
1886 1.1 christos if (glink_vma == 0)
1887 1.1 christos return 0;
1888 1.1 christos
1889 1.1 christos /* The .glink section usually does not survive the final
1890 1.1 christos link; search for the section (usually .text) where the
1891 1.1 christos glink stubs now reside. */
1892 1.1 christos glink = bfd_sections_find_if (abfd, section_covers_vma, &glink_vma);
1893 1.1 christos if (glink == NULL)
1894 1.1 christos return 0;
1895 1.1 christos
1896 1.1 christos /* Determine glink PLT resolver by reading the relative branch
1897 1.1 christos from the first glink stub. */
1898 1.1 christos if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
1899 1.1 christos glink_vma - glink->vma, 4))
1900 1.1 christos {
1901 1.1 christos unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1902 1.1 christos
1903 1.1 christos /* The first glink stub may either branch to the resolver ... */
1904 1.1 christos insn ^= B;
1905 1.1 christos if ((insn & ~0x3fffffc) == 0)
1906 1.1 christos resolv_vma = glink_vma + (insn ^ 0x2000000) - 0x2000000;
1907 1.1 christos
1908 1.1 christos /* ... or fall through a bunch of NOPs. */
1909 1.1 christos else if ((insn ^ B ^ NOP) == 0)
1910 1.1 christos for (i = 4;
1911 1.1 christos bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
1912 1.1 christos glink_vma - glink->vma + i, 4);
1913 1.1 christos i += 4)
1914 1.1 christos if (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf) != NOP)
1915 1.1 christos {
1916 1.1 christos resolv_vma = glink_vma + i;
1917 1.1 christos break;
1918 1.1 christos }
1919 1.1 christos }
1920 1.8 christos
1921 1.8 christos count = relplt->size / sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
1922 1.8 christos /* If the stubs are those for -shared/-pie then we might have
1923 1.8 christos multiple stubs for each plt entry. If that is the case then
1924 1.8 christos there is no way to associate stubs with their plt entries short
1925 1.8 christos of figuring out the GOT pointer value used in the stub.
1926 1.8 christos The offsets tested here need to cover all possible values of
1927 1.8 christos GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE for other than __tls_get_addr_opt. */
1928 1.1 christos stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1929 1.1 christos for (stub_delta = 16; stub_delta <= 32; stub_delta += 8)
1930 1.1 christos if (is_nonpic_glink_stub (abfd, glink, stub_off - stub_delta))
1931 1.1 christos break;
1932 1.1 christos if (stub_delta > 32)
1933 1.1 christos return 0;
1934 1.1 christos
1935 1.1 christos slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
1936 1.1 christos if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
1937 1.1 christos return -1;
1938 1.1 christos
1939 1.1 christos size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
1940 1.1 christos p = relplt->relocation;
1941 1.1 christos for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p++)
1942 1.1 christos {
1943 1.1 christos size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
1944 1.1 christos if (p->addend != 0)
1945 1.1 christos size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
1946 1.1 christos }
1947 1.1 christos
1948 1.1 christos size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink");
1949 1.1 christos
1950 1.1 christos if (resolv_vma)
1951 1.1 christos size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
1952 1.8 christos
1953 1.1 christos s = *ret = bfd_malloc (size);
1954 1.5 christos if (s == NULL)
1955 1.5 christos return -1;
1956 1.1 christos
1957 1.1 christos stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1958 1.1 christos names = (char *) (s + count + 1 + (resolv_vma != 0));
1959 1.8 christos p = relplt->relocation + count - 1;
1960 1.8 christos for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
1961 1.8 christos {
1962 1.1 christos size_t len;
1963 1.1 christos
1964 1.1 christos stub_off -= stub_delta;
1965 1.1 christos if (strcmp ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, "__tls_get_addr_opt") == 0)
1966 1.1 christos stub_off -= 32;
1967 1.1 christos *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
1968 1.1 christos /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
1969 1.8 christos we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
1970 1.1 christos if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
1971 1.1 christos s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
1972 1.1 christos s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1973 1.1 christos s->section = glink;
1974 1.1 christos s->value = stub_off;
1975 1.1 christos s->name = names;
1976 1.1 christos s->udata.p = NULL;
1977 1.1 christos len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
1978 1.1 christos memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
1979 1.1 christos names += len;
1980 1.1 christos if (p->addend != 0)
1981 1.1 christos {
1982 1.1 christos memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
1983 1.1 christos names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
1984 1.1 christos bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, names, p->addend);
1985 1.5 christos names += strlen (names);
1986 1.1 christos }
1987 1.1 christos memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
1988 1.1 christos names += sizeof ("@plt");
1989 1.1 christos ++s;
1990 1.1 christos --p;
1991 1.1 christos }
1992 1.1 christos
1993 1.1 christos /* Add a symbol at the start of the glink branch table. */
1994 1.1 christos memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
1995 1.1 christos s->the_bfd = abfd;
1996 1.1 christos s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1997 1.1 christos s->section = glink;
1998 1.1 christos s->value = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1999 1.1 christos s->name = names;
2000 1.1 christos memcpy (names, "__glink", sizeof ("__glink"));
2001 1.1 christos names += sizeof ("__glink");
2002 1.1 christos s++;
2003 1.1 christos count++;
2004 1.1 christos
2005 1.1 christos if (resolv_vma)
2006 1.1 christos {
2007 1.1 christos /* Add a symbol for the glink PLT resolver. */
2008 1.1 christos memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
2009 1.1 christos s->the_bfd = abfd;
2010 1.1 christos s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
2011 1.1 christos s->section = glink;
2012 1.1 christos s->value = resolv_vma - glink->vma;
2013 1.1 christos s->name = names;
2014 1.1 christos memcpy (names, "__glink_PLTresolve", sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve"));
2015 1.1 christos names += sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
2016 1.1 christos s++;
2017 1.1 christos count++;
2018 1.1 christos }
2019 1.1 christos
2020 1.1 christos return count;
2021 1.1 christos }
2022 1.1 christos
2023 1.1 christos /* The following functions are specific to the ELF linker, while
2025 1.1 christos functions above are used generally. They appear in this file more
2026 1.1 christos or less in the order in which they are called. eg.
2027 1.1 christos ppc_elf_check_relocs is called early in the link process,
2028 1.1 christos ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections is one of the last functions
2029 1.1 christos called. */
2030 1.1 christos
2031 1.1 christos /* Track PLT entries needed for a given symbol. We might need more
2032 1.1 christos than one glink entry per symbol when generating a pic binary. */
2033 1.1 christos struct plt_entry
2034 1.1 christos {
2035 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *next;
2036 1.1 christos
2037 1.1 christos /* -fPIC uses multiple GOT sections, one per file, called ".got2".
2038 1.1 christos This field stores the offset into .got2 used to initialise the
2039 1.1 christos GOT pointer reg. It will always be at least 32768. (Current
2040 1.1 christos gcc always uses an offset of 32768, but ld -r will pack .got2
2041 1.1 christos sections together resulting in larger offsets). */
2042 1.1 christos bfd_vma addend;
2043 1.1 christos
2044 1.1 christos /* The .got2 section. */
2045 1.1 christos asection *sec;
2046 1.1 christos
2047 1.1 christos /* PLT refcount or offset. */
2048 1.1 christos union
2049 1.1 christos {
2050 1.1 christos bfd_signed_vma refcount;
2051 1.1 christos bfd_vma offset;
2052 1.8 christos } plt;
2053 1.8 christos
2054 1.8 christos /* .glink stub offset. */
2055 1.1 christos bfd_vma glink_offset;
2056 1.1 christos };
2057 1.1 christos
2058 1.1 christos /* Of those relocs that might be copied as dynamic relocs, this
2059 1.1 christos function selects those that must be copied when linking a shared
2060 1.1 christos library or PIE, even when the symbol is local. */
2061 1.1 christos
2062 1.1 christos static int
2063 1.8 christos must_be_dyn_reloc (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2064 1.8 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2065 1.8 christos {
2066 1.8 christos switch (r_type)
2067 1.1 christos {
2068 1.1 christos default:
2069 1.1 christos /* Only relative relocs can be resolved when the object load
2070 1.1 christos address isn't fixed. DTPREL32 is excluded because the
2071 1.1 christos dynamic linker needs to differentiate global dynamic from
2072 1.1 christos local dynamic __tls_index pairs when PPC_OPT_TLS is set. */
2073 1.1 christos return 1;
2074 1.1 christos
2075 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL24:
2076 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14:
2077 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
2078 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
2079 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL32:
2080 1.1 christos return 0;
2081 1.8 christos
2082 1.8 christos case R_PPC_TPREL32:
2083 1.8 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16:
2084 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
2085 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
2086 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
2087 1.1 christos /* These relocations are relative but in a shared library the
2088 1.1 christos linker doesn't know the thread pointer base. */
2089 1.1 christos return bfd_link_dll (info);
2090 1.1 christos }
2091 1.1 christos }
2092 1.1 christos
2093 1.1 christos /* If ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS is non-zero, the linker will try to avoid
2094 1.1 christos copying dynamic variables from a shared lib into an app's dynbss
2095 1.1 christos section, and instead use a dynamic relocation to point into the
2096 1.1 christos shared lib. */
2097 1.1 christos #define ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS 1
2098 1.1 christos
2099 1.1 christos /* Used to track dynamic relocations for local symbols. */
2100 1.1 christos struct ppc_dyn_relocs
2101 1.1 christos {
2102 1.1 christos struct ppc_dyn_relocs *next;
2103 1.1 christos
2104 1.1 christos /* The input section of the reloc. */
2105 1.1 christos asection *sec;
2106 1.1 christos
2107 1.1 christos /* Total number of relocs copied for the input section. */
2108 1.1 christos unsigned int count : 31;
2109 1.1 christos
2110 1.1 christos /* Whether this entry is for STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols. */
2111 1.1 christos unsigned int ifunc : 1;
2112 1.1 christos };
2113 1.1 christos
2114 1.1 christos /* PPC ELF linker hash entry. */
2115 1.1 christos
2116 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry
2117 1.1 christos {
2118 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry elf;
2119 1.8 christos
2120 1.8 christos /* If this symbol is used in the linker created sections, the processor
2121 1.8 christos specific backend uses this field to map the field into the offset
2122 1.8 christos from the beginning of the section. */
2123 1.8 christos elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_pointer;
2124 1.8 christos
2125 1.9 christos /* Contexts in which symbol is used in the GOT.
2126 1.8 christos Bits are or'd into the mask as the corresponding relocs are
2127 1.8 christos encountered during check_relocs, with TLS_TLS being set when any
2128 1.8 christos of the other TLS bits are set. tls_optimize clears bits when
2129 1.8 christos optimizing to indicate the corresponding GOT entry type is not
2130 1.8 christos needed. If set, TLS_TLS is never cleared. tls_optimize may also
2131 1.8 christos set TLS_GDIE when a GD reloc turns into an IE one.
2132 1.8 christos These flags are also kept for local symbols. */
2133 1.9 christos #define TLS_TLS 1 /* Any TLS reloc. */
2134 1.8 christos #define TLS_GD 2 /* GD reloc. */
2135 1.8 christos #define TLS_LD 4 /* LD reloc. */
2136 1.8 christos #define TLS_TPREL 8 /* TPREL reloc, => IE. */
2137 1.8 christos #define TLS_DTPREL 16 /* DTPREL reloc, => LD. */
2138 1.8 christos #define TLS_MARK 32 /* __tls_get_addr call marked. */
2139 1.8 christos #define TLS_GDIE 64 /* GOT TPREL reloc resulting from GD->IE. */
2140 1.8 christos unsigned char tls_mask;
2141 1.1 christos
2142 1.1 christos /* The above field is also used to mark function symbols. In which
2143 1.1 christos case TLS_TLS will be 0. */
2144 1.5 christos #define PLT_IFUNC 2 /* STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
2145 1.5 christos #define PLT_KEEP 4 /* inline plt call requires plt entry. */
2146 1.5 christos #define NON_GOT 256 /* local symbol plt, not stored. */
2147 1.5 christos
2148 1.5 christos /* Nonzero if we have seen a small data relocation referring to this
2149 1.1 christos symbol. */
2150 1.1 christos unsigned char has_sda_refs : 1;
2151 1.1 christos
2152 1.1 christos /* Flag use of given relocations. */
2153 1.1 christos unsigned char has_addr16_ha : 1;
2154 1.1 christos unsigned char has_addr16_lo : 1;
2155 1.1 christos };
2156 1.1 christos
2157 1.1 christos #define ppc_elf_hash_entry(ent) ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) (ent))
2158 1.1 christos
2159 1.3 christos /* PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2160 1.3 christos
2161 1.3 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table
2162 1.1 christos {
2163 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_table elf;
2164 1.1 christos
2165 1.1 christos /* Various options passed from the linker. */
2166 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_params *params;
2167 1.1 christos
2168 1.1 christos /* Short-cuts to get to dynamic linker sections. */
2169 1.8 christos asection *glink;
2170 1.8 christos asection *dynsbss;
2171 1.1 christos asection *relsbss;
2172 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_t sdata[2];
2173 1.1 christos asection *sbss;
2174 1.1 christos asection *glink_eh_frame;
2175 1.1 christos asection *pltlocal;
2176 1.1 christos asection *relpltlocal;
2177 1.1 christos
2178 1.1 christos /* The (unloaded but important) .rela.plt.unloaded on VxWorks. */
2179 1.1 christos asection *srelplt2;
2180 1.1 christos
2181 1.1 christos /* Shortcut to __tls_get_addr. */
2182 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *tls_get_addr;
2183 1.1 christos
2184 1.1 christos /* The bfd that forced an old-style PLT. */
2185 1.1 christos bfd *old_bfd;
2186 1.1 christos
2187 1.1 christos /* TLS local dynamic got entry handling. */
2188 1.1 christos union {
2189 1.1 christos bfd_signed_vma refcount;
2190 1.1 christos bfd_vma offset;
2191 1.1 christos } tlsld_got;
2192 1.1 christos
2193 1.1 christos /* Offset of branch table to PltResolve function in glink. */
2194 1.1 christos bfd_vma glink_pltresolve;
2195 1.1 christos
2196 1.1 christos /* Size of reserved GOT entries. */
2197 1.1 christos unsigned int got_header_size;
2198 1.7 christos /* Non-zero if allocating the header left a gap. */
2199 1.7 christos unsigned int got_gap;
2200 1.7 christos
2201 1.7 christos /* The type of PLT we have chosen to use. */
2202 1.7 christos enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type;
2203 1.8 christos
2204 1.8 christos /* Whether there exist local gnu indirect function resolvers,
2205 1.8 christos referenced by dynamic relocations. */
2206 1.8 christos unsigned int local_ifunc_resolver:1;
2207 1.8 christos unsigned int maybe_local_ifunc_resolver:1;
2208 1.8 christos
2209 1.1 christos /* Set if tls optimization is enabled. */
2210 1.1 christos unsigned int do_tls_opt:1;
2211 1.1 christos
2212 1.1 christos /* Set if inline plt calls should be converted to direct calls. */
2213 1.1 christos unsigned int can_convert_all_inline_plt:1;
2214 1.1 christos
2215 1.1 christos /* The size of PLT entries. */
2216 1.1 christos int plt_entry_size;
2217 1.1 christos /* The distance between adjacent PLT slots. */
2218 1.1 christos int plt_slot_size;
2219 1.1 christos /* The size of the first PLT entry. */
2220 1.1 christos int plt_initial_entry_size;
2221 1.1 christos };
2222 1.1 christos
2223 1.9 christos /* Rename some of the generic section flags to better document how they
2224 1.9 christos are used for ppc32. The flags are only valid for ppc32 elf objects. */
2225 1.9 christos
2226 1.1 christos /* Nonzero if this section has TLS related relocations. */
2227 1.8 christos #define has_tls_reloc sec_flg0
2228 1.8 christos
2229 1.8 christos /* Nonzero if this section has a call to __tls_get_addr lacking marker
2230 1.1 christos relocs. */
2231 1.1 christos #define nomark_tls_get_addr sec_flg1
2232 1.1 christos
2233 1.9 christos /* Flag set when PLTCALL relocs are detected. */
2234 1.9 christos #define has_pltcall sec_flg2
2235 1.9 christos
2236 1.1 christos /* Get the PPC ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure. */
2237 1.1 christos
2238 1.1 christos #define ppc_elf_hash_table(p) \
2239 1.1 christos ((is_elf_hash_table ((p)->hash) \
2240 1.1 christos && elf_hash_table_id (elf_hash_table (p)) == PPC32_ELF_DATA) \
2241 1.1 christos ? (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *) (p)->hash : NULL)
2242 1.1 christos
2243 1.1 christos /* Create an entry in a PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2244 1.1 christos
2245 1.1 christos static struct bfd_hash_entry *
2246 1.1 christos ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
2247 1.1 christos struct bfd_hash_table *table,
2248 1.1 christos const char *string)
2249 1.1 christos {
2250 1.1 christos /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
2251 1.1 christos subclass. */
2252 1.1 christos if (entry == NULL)
2253 1.1 christos {
2254 1.1 christos entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table,
2255 1.1 christos sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry));
2256 1.1 christos if (entry == NULL)
2257 1.1 christos return entry;
2258 1.1 christos }
2259 1.1 christos
2260 1.1 christos /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
2261 1.1 christos entry = _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
2262 1.1 christos if (entry != NULL)
2263 1.1 christos {
2264 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->linker_section_pointer = NULL;
2265 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->tls_mask = 0;
2266 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->has_sda_refs = 0;
2267 1.1 christos }
2268 1.1 christos
2269 1.1 christos return entry;
2270 1.1 christos }
2271 1.1 christos
2272 1.6 christos /* Create a PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2273 1.8 christos
2274 1.1 christos static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
2275 1.1 christos ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
2276 1.1 christos {
2277 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *ret;
2278 1.1 christos static struct ppc_elf_params default_params
2279 1.1 christos = { PLT_OLD, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 12, 0, 0, 0 };
2280 1.1 christos
2281 1.1 christos ret = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table));
2282 1.1 christos if (ret == NULL)
2283 1.1 christos return NULL;
2284 1.1 christos
2285 1.1 christos if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->elf, abfd,
2286 1.1 christos ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc,
2287 1.1 christos sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry),
2288 1.1 christos PPC32_ELF_DATA))
2289 1.1 christos {
2290 1.1 christos free (ret);
2291 1.1 christos return NULL;
2292 1.1 christos }
2293 1.3 christos
2294 1.3 christos ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.refcount = 0;
2295 1.1 christos ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.glist = NULL;
2296 1.1 christos ret->elf.init_plt_offset.offset = 0;
2297 1.1 christos ret->elf.init_plt_offset.glist = NULL;
2298 1.1 christos
2299 1.1 christos ret->params = &default_params;
2300 1.1 christos
2301 1.1 christos ret->sdata[0].name = ".sdata";
2302 1.1 christos ret->sdata[0].sym_name = "_SDA_BASE_";
2303 1.1 christos ret->sdata[0].bss_name = ".sbss";
2304 1.1 christos
2305 1.1 christos ret->sdata[1].name = ".sdata2";
2306 1.1 christos ret->sdata[1].sym_name = "_SDA2_BASE_";
2307 1.1 christos ret->sdata[1].bss_name = ".sbss2";
2308 1.1 christos
2309 1.1 christos ret->plt_entry_size = 12;
2310 1.3 christos ret->plt_slot_size = 8;
2311 1.3 christos ret->plt_initial_entry_size = 72;
2312 1.3 christos
2313 1.3 christos return &ret->elf.root;
2314 1.3 christos }
2315 1.3 christos
2316 1.3 christos /* Hook linker params into hash table. */
2317 1.3 christos
2318 1.3 christos void
2319 1.6 christos ppc_elf_link_params (struct bfd_link_info *info, struct ppc_elf_params *params)
2320 1.3 christos {
2321 1.3 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2322 1.1 christos
2323 1.1 christos if (htab)
2324 1.1 christos htab->params = params;
2325 1.1 christos params->pagesize_p2 = bfd_log2 (params->pagesize);
2326 1.1 christos }
2327 1.1 christos
2328 1.1 christos /* Create .got and the related sections. */
2329 1.1 christos
2330 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
2331 1.1 christos ppc_elf_create_got (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2332 1.1 christos {
2333 1.9 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2334 1.1 christos
2335 1.1 christos if (!_bfd_elf_create_got_section (abfd, info))
2336 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2337 1.7 christos
2338 1.7 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2339 1.9 christos if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks)
2340 1.1 christos {
2341 1.1 christos /* The powerpc .got has a blrl instruction in it. Mark it
2342 1.1 christos executable. */
2343 1.1 christos flagword flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2344 1.1 christos | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2345 1.1 christos if (!bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.sgot, flags))
2346 1.3 christos return FALSE;
2347 1.3 christos }
2348 1.3 christos
2349 1.3 christos return TRUE;
2350 1.3 christos }
2351 1.3 christos
2352 1.3 christos /* Create a special linker section, used for R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16 and
2353 1.3 christos R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16 pointers. These sections become part of .sdata
2354 1.3 christos and .sdata2. Create _SDA_BASE_ and _SDA2_BASE too. */
2355 1.3 christos
2356 1.3 christos static bfd_boolean
2357 1.3 christos ppc_elf_create_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
2358 1.3 christos struct bfd_link_info *info,
2359 1.3 christos flagword flags,
2360 1.3 christos elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
2361 1.3 christos {
2362 1.3 christos asection *s;
2363 1.3 christos
2364 1.3 christos flags |= (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
2365 1.3 christos | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2366 1.3 christos
2367 1.3 christos s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, lsect->name, flags);
2368 1.3 christos if (s == NULL)
2369 1.3 christos return FALSE;
2370 1.3 christos lsect->section = s;
2371 1.3 christos
2372 1.3 christos /* Define the sym on the first section of this name. */
2373 1.3 christos s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, lsect->name);
2374 1.3 christos
2375 1.3 christos lsect->sym = _bfd_elf_define_linkage_sym (abfd, info, s, lsect->sym_name);
2376 1.1 christos if (lsect->sym == NULL)
2377 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2378 1.1 christos lsect->sym->root.u.def.value = 0x8000;
2379 1.1 christos return TRUE;
2380 1.1 christos }
2381 1.1 christos
2382 1.8 christos static bfd_boolean
2383 1.1 christos ppc_elf_create_glink (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2384 1.1 christos {
2385 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2386 1.1 christos asection *s;
2387 1.1 christos flagword flags;
2388 1.8 christos int p2align;
2389 1.8 christos
2390 1.8 christos flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2391 1.1 christos | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2392 1.9 christos s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".glink", flags);
2393 1.1 christos htab->glink = s;
2394 1.1 christos p2align = htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 6 : 4;
2395 1.1 christos if (p2align < htab->params->plt_stub_align)
2396 1.1 christos p2align = htab->params->plt_stub_align;
2397 1.1 christos if (s == NULL
2398 1.1 christos || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, p2align))
2399 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2400 1.1 christos
2401 1.1 christos if (!info->no_ld_generated_unwind_info)
2402 1.9 christos {
2403 1.1 christos flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2404 1.1 christos | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2405 1.1 christos s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".eh_frame", flags);
2406 1.1 christos htab->glink_eh_frame = s;
2407 1.1 christos if (s == NULL
2408 1.7 christos || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
2409 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2410 1.9 christos }
2411 1.1 christos
2412 1.1 christos flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2413 1.1 christos s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".iplt", flags);
2414 1.1 christos htab->elf.iplt = s;
2415 1.1 christos if (s == NULL
2416 1.7 christos || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 4))
2417 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2418 1.9 christos
2419 1.1 christos flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2420 1.3 christos | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2421 1.8 christos s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.iplt", flags);
2422 1.8 christos htab->elf.irelplt = s;
2423 1.8 christos if (s == NULL
2424 1.8 christos || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
2425 1.8 christos return FALSE;
2426 1.8 christos
2427 1.9 christos /* Local plt entries. */
2428 1.8 christos flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD
2429 1.8 christos | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2430 1.8 christos htab->pltlocal = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".branch_lt",
2431 1.8 christos flags);
2432 1.8 christos if (htab->pltlocal == NULL
2433 1.8 christos || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->pltlocal, 2))
2434 1.8 christos return FALSE;
2435 1.8 christos
2436 1.8 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
2437 1.9 christos {
2438 1.8 christos flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY
2439 1.8 christos | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2440 1.8 christos htab->relpltlocal
2441 1.3 christos = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.branch_lt", flags);
2442 1.3 christos if (htab->relpltlocal == NULL
2443 1.3 christos || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->relpltlocal, 2))
2444 1.3 christos return FALSE;
2445 1.3 christos }
2446 1.3 christos
2447 1.3 christos if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, 0,
2448 1.3 christos &htab->sdata[0]))
2449 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2450 1.1 christos
2451 1.1 christos if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, SEC_READONLY,
2452 1.1 christos &htab->sdata[1]))
2453 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2454 1.1 christos
2455 1.1 christos return TRUE;
2456 1.1 christos }
2457 1.1 christos
2458 1.1 christos /* We have to create .dynsbss and .rela.sbss here so that they get mapped
2459 1.1 christos to output sections (just like _bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections has
2460 1.1 christos to create .dynbss and .rela.bss). */
2461 1.1 christos
2462 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
2463 1.1 christos ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2464 1.1 christos {
2465 1.7 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2466 1.1 christos asection *s;
2467 1.1 christos flagword flags;
2468 1.1 christos
2469 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2470 1.1 christos
2471 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL
2472 1.1 christos && !ppc_elf_create_got (abfd, info))
2473 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2474 1.1 christos
2475 1.1 christos if (!_bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info))
2476 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2477 1.1 christos
2478 1.1 christos if (htab->glink == NULL
2479 1.1 christos && !ppc_elf_create_glink (abfd, info))
2480 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2481 1.1 christos
2482 1.6 christos s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".dynsbss",
2483 1.1 christos SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2484 1.1 christos htab->dynsbss = s;
2485 1.1 christos if (s == NULL)
2486 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2487 1.1 christos
2488 1.1 christos if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
2489 1.9 christos {
2490 1.1 christos flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2491 1.1 christos | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2492 1.1 christos s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.sbss", flags);
2493 1.9 christos htab->relsbss = s;
2494 1.1 christos if (s == NULL
2495 1.1 christos || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
2496 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2497 1.7 christos }
2498 1.1 christos
2499 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
2500 1.1 christos && !elf_vxworks_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info, &htab->srelplt2))
2501 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2502 1.9 christos
2503 1.1 christos s = htab->elf.splt;
2504 1.1 christos flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2505 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
2506 1.1 christos /* The VxWorks PLT is a loaded section with contents. */
2507 1.1 christos flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY;
2508 1.1 christos return bfd_set_section_flags (s, flags);
2509 1.1 christos }
2510 1.1 christos
2511 1.1 christos /* Copy the extra info we tack onto an elf_link_hash_entry. */
2512 1.1 christos
2513 1.1 christos static void
2514 1.1 christos ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2515 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
2516 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
2517 1.1 christos {
2518 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *edir, *eind;
2519 1.1 christos
2520 1.7 christos edir = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) dir;
2521 1.7 christos eind = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) ind;
2522 1.1 christos
2523 1.1 christos edir->tls_mask |= eind->tls_mask;
2524 1.8 christos edir->has_sda_refs |= eind->has_sda_refs;
2525 1.1 christos
2526 1.1 christos if (edir->elf.versioned != versioned_hidden)
2527 1.1 christos edir->elf.ref_dynamic |= eind->elf.ref_dynamic;
2528 1.8 christos edir->elf.ref_regular |= eind->elf.ref_regular;
2529 1.8 christos edir->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= eind->elf.ref_regular_nonweak;
2530 1.8 christos edir->elf.non_got_ref |= eind->elf.non_got_ref;
2531 1.8 christos edir->elf.needs_plt |= eind->elf.needs_plt;
2532 1.9 christos edir->elf.pointer_equality_needed |= eind->elf.pointer_equality_needed;
2533 1.1 christos
2534 1.9 christos /* If we were called to copy over info for a weak sym, that's all. */
2535 1.1 christos if (eind->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
2536 1.1 christos return;
2537 1.1 christos
2538 1.1 christos if (ind->dyn_relocs != NULL)
2539 1.1 christos {
2540 1.1 christos if (dir->dyn_relocs != NULL)
2541 1.9 christos {
2542 1.1 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
2543 1.1 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
2544 1.1 christos
2545 1.9 christos /* Add reloc counts against the indirect sym to the direct sym
2546 1.1 christos list. Merge any entries against the same section. */
2547 1.1 christos for (pp = &ind->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
2548 1.1 christos {
2549 1.1 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs *q;
2550 1.1 christos
2551 1.1 christos for (q = dir->dyn_relocs; q != NULL; q = q->next)
2552 1.1 christos if (q->sec == p->sec)
2553 1.1 christos {
2554 1.1 christos q->pc_count += p->pc_count;
2555 1.1 christos q->count += p->count;
2556 1.9 christos *pp = p->next;
2557 1.1 christos break;
2558 1.1 christos }
2559 1.9 christos if (q == NULL)
2560 1.9 christos pp = &p->next;
2561 1.1 christos }
2562 1.1 christos *pp = dir->dyn_relocs;
2563 1.1 christos }
2564 1.1 christos
2565 1.1 christos dir->dyn_relocs = ind->dyn_relocs;
2566 1.1 christos ind->dyn_relocs = NULL;
2567 1.1 christos }
2568 1.1 christos
2569 1.1 christos /* Copy over the GOT refcount entries that we may have already seen to
2570 1.1 christos the symbol which just became indirect. */
2571 1.1 christos edir->elf.got.refcount += eind->elf.got.refcount;
2572 1.1 christos eind->elf.got.refcount = 0;
2573 1.1 christos
2574 1.1 christos /* And plt entries. */
2575 1.1 christos if (eind->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
2576 1.1 christos {
2577 1.1 christos if (edir->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
2578 1.1 christos {
2579 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **entp;
2580 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
2581 1.1 christos
2582 1.1 christos for (entp = &eind->elf.plt.plist; (ent = *entp) != NULL; )
2583 1.1 christos {
2584 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *dent;
2585 1.1 christos
2586 1.1 christos for (dent = edir->elf.plt.plist; dent != NULL; dent = dent->next)
2587 1.1 christos if (dent->sec == ent->sec && dent->addend == ent->addend)
2588 1.1 christos {
2589 1.1 christos dent->plt.refcount += ent->plt.refcount;
2590 1.1 christos *entp = ent->next;
2591 1.1 christos break;
2592 1.1 christos }
2593 1.1 christos if (dent == NULL)
2594 1.1 christos entp = &ent->next;
2595 1.1 christos }
2596 1.1 christos *entp = edir->elf.plt.plist;
2597 1.1 christos }
2598 1.1 christos
2599 1.1 christos edir->elf.plt.plist = eind->elf.plt.plist;
2600 1.1 christos eind->elf.plt.plist = NULL;
2601 1.1 christos }
2602 1.1 christos
2603 1.1 christos if (eind->elf.dynindx != -1)
2604 1.1 christos {
2605 1.1 christos if (edir->elf.dynindx != -1)
2606 1.1 christos _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
2607 1.1 christos edir->elf.dynstr_index);
2608 1.1 christos edir->elf.dynindx = eind->elf.dynindx;
2609 1.1 christos edir->elf.dynstr_index = eind->elf.dynstr_index;
2610 1.1 christos eind->elf.dynindx = -1;
2611 1.1 christos eind->elf.dynstr_index = 0;
2612 1.1 christos }
2613 1.1 christos }
2614 1.1 christos
2615 1.1 christos /* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object
2616 1.1 christos file. We use it to put .comm items in .sbss, and not .bss. */
2617 1.1 christos
2618 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
2619 1.1 christos ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
2620 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info,
2621 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
2622 1.6 christos const char **namep ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2623 1.1 christos flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2624 1.1 christos asection **secp,
2625 1.1 christos bfd_vma *valp)
2626 1.1 christos {
2627 1.1 christos if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
2628 1.1 christos && !bfd_link_relocatable (info)
2629 1.1 christos && is_ppc_elf (info->output_bfd)
2630 1.1 christos && sym->st_size <= elf_gp_size (abfd))
2631 1.1 christos {
2632 1.1 christos /* Common symbols less than or equal to -G nn bytes are automatically
2633 1.9 christos put into .sbss. */
2634 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2635 1.1 christos
2636 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2637 1.1 christos if (htab->sbss == NULL)
2638 1.1 christos {
2639 1.1 christos flagword flags = SEC_IS_COMMON | SEC_SMALL_DATA | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2640 1.1 christos
2641 1.1 christos if (!htab->elf.dynobj)
2642 1.1 christos htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2643 1.1 christos
2644 1.1 christos htab->sbss = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (htab->elf.dynobj,
2645 1.1 christos ".sbss",
2646 1.1 christos flags);
2647 1.1 christos if (htab->sbss == NULL)
2648 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2649 1.1 christos }
2650 1.1 christos
2651 1.1 christos *secp = htab->sbss;
2652 1.1 christos *valp = sym->st_size;
2653 1.1 christos }
2654 1.1 christos
2655 1.1 christos return TRUE;
2656 1.1 christos }
2657 1.1 christos
2658 1.1 christos /* Find a linker generated pointer with a given addend and type. */
2660 1.1 christos
2661 1.1 christos static elf_linker_section_pointers_t *
2662 1.1 christos elf_find_pointer_linker_section
2663 1.1 christos (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_pointers,
2664 1.1 christos bfd_vma addend,
2665 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
2666 1.1 christos {
2667 1.1 christos for ( ; linker_pointers != NULL; linker_pointers = linker_pointers->next)
2668 1.1 christos if (lsect == linker_pointers->lsect && addend == linker_pointers->addend)
2669 1.1 christos return linker_pointers;
2670 1.3 christos
2671 1.3 christos return NULL;
2672 1.3 christos }
2673 1.3 christos
2674 1.1 christos /* Allocate a pointer to live in a linker created section. */
2675 1.1 christos
2676 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
2677 1.1 christos elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
2678 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
2679 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2680 1.1 christos const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
2681 1.1 christos {
2682 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr_linker_section_ptr = NULL;
2683 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
2684 1.1 christos unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
2685 1.1 christos bfd_size_type amt;
2686 1.1 christos
2687 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
2688 1.1 christos
2689 1.1 christos /* Is this a global symbol? */
2690 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
2691 1.1 christos {
2692 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
2693 1.1 christos
2694 1.1 christos /* Has this symbol already been allocated? If so, our work is done. */
2695 1.1 christos eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2696 1.1 christos if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (eh->linker_section_pointer,
2697 1.1 christos rel->r_addend,
2698 1.1 christos lsect))
2699 1.1 christos return TRUE;
2700 1.1 christos
2701 1.1 christos ptr_linker_section_ptr = &eh->linker_section_pointer;
2702 1.1 christos }
2703 1.1 christos else
2704 1.1 christos {
2705 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
2706 1.1 christos
2707 1.1 christos /* Allocation of a pointer to a local symbol. */
2708 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd);
2709 1.1 christos
2710 1.1 christos /* Allocate a table to hold the local symbols if first time. */
2711 1.1 christos if (!ptr)
2712 1.1 christos {
2713 1.1 christos unsigned int num_symbols = elf_symtab_hdr (abfd).sh_info;
2714 1.1 christos
2715 1.1 christos amt = num_symbols;
2716 1.1 christos amt *= sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *);
2717 1.1 christos ptr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
2718 1.1 christos
2719 1.1 christos if (!ptr)
2720 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2721 1.1 christos
2722 1.1 christos elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd) = ptr;
2723 1.1 christos }
2724 1.1 christos
2725 1.1 christos /* Has this symbol already been allocated? If so, our work is done. */
2726 1.1 christos if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (ptr[r_symndx],
2727 1.1 christos rel->r_addend,
2728 1.1 christos lsect))
2729 1.1 christos return TRUE;
2730 1.1 christos
2731 1.1 christos ptr_linker_section_ptr = &ptr[r_symndx];
2732 1.1 christos }
2733 1.1 christos
2734 1.1 christos /* Allocate space for a pointer in the linker section, and allocate
2735 1.1 christos a new pointer record from internal memory. */
2736 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (ptr_linker_section_ptr != NULL);
2737 1.1 christos amt = sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t);
2738 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2739 1.1 christos
2740 1.1 christos if (!linker_section_ptr)
2741 1.9 christos return FALSE;
2742 1.3 christos
2743 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr->next = *ptr_linker_section_ptr;
2744 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr->addend = rel->r_addend;
2745 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr->lsect = lsect;
2746 1.1 christos *ptr_linker_section_ptr = linker_section_ptr;
2747 1.1 christos
2748 1.1 christos if (!bfd_set_section_alignment (lsect->section, 2))
2749 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2750 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr->offset = lsect->section->size;
2751 1.1 christos lsect->section->size += 4;
2752 1.1 christos
2753 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
2754 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr,
2755 1.1 christos "Create pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld, section size = %ld\n",
2756 1.1 christos lsect->name, (long) linker_section_ptr->offset,
2757 1.1 christos (long) lsect->section->size);
2758 1.1 christos #endif
2759 1.1 christos
2760 1.1 christos return TRUE;
2761 1.1 christos }
2762 1.1 christos
2763 1.1 christos static struct plt_entry **
2764 1.8 christos update_local_sym_info (bfd *abfd,
2765 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
2766 1.1 christos unsigned long r_symndx,
2767 1.1 christos int tls_type)
2768 1.1 christos {
2769 1.1 christos bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd);
2770 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt;
2771 1.1 christos unsigned char *local_got_tls_masks;
2772 1.1 christos
2773 1.1 christos if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
2774 1.1 christos {
2775 1.1 christos bfd_size_type size = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
2776 1.1 christos
2777 1.1 christos size *= (sizeof (*local_got_refcounts)
2778 1.1 christos + sizeof (*local_plt)
2779 1.1 christos + sizeof (*local_got_tls_masks));
2780 1.8 christos local_got_refcounts = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size);
2781 1.8 christos if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
2782 1.8 christos return NULL;
2783 1.1 christos elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd) = local_got_refcounts;
2784 1.1 christos }
2785 1.1 christos
2786 1.1 christos local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_refcounts + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
2787 1.1 christos local_got_tls_masks = (unsigned char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
2788 1.1 christos local_got_tls_masks[r_symndx] |= tls_type & 0xff;
2789 1.1 christos if ((tls_type & NON_GOT) == 0)
2790 1.1 christos local_got_refcounts[r_symndx] += 1;
2791 1.1 christos return local_plt + r_symndx;
2792 1.1 christos }
2793 1.1 christos
2794 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
2795 1.1 christos update_plt_info (bfd *abfd, struct plt_entry **plist,
2796 1.1 christos asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
2797 1.1 christos {
2798 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
2799 1.1 christos
2800 1.9 christos if (addend < 32768)
2801 1.1 christos sec = NULL;
2802 1.1 christos for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
2803 1.1 christos if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
2804 1.1 christos break;
2805 1.1 christos if (ent == NULL)
2806 1.1 christos {
2807 1.1 christos size_t amt = sizeof (*ent);
2808 1.1 christos ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2809 1.1 christos if (ent == NULL)
2810 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2811 1.1 christos ent->next = *plist;
2812 1.1 christos ent->sec = sec;
2813 1.1 christos ent->addend = addend;
2814 1.1 christos ent->plt.refcount = 0;
2815 1.1 christos *plist = ent;
2816 1.1 christos }
2817 1.1 christos ent->plt.refcount += 1;
2818 1.1 christos return TRUE;
2819 1.1 christos }
2820 1.1 christos
2821 1.1 christos static struct plt_entry *
2822 1.1 christos find_plt_ent (struct plt_entry **plist, asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
2823 1.1 christos {
2824 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
2825 1.1 christos
2826 1.1 christos if (addend < 32768)
2827 1.1 christos sec = NULL;
2828 1.1 christos for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
2829 1.1 christos if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
2830 1.1 christos break;
2831 1.1 christos return ent;
2832 1.1 christos }
2833 1.1 christos
2834 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
2835 1.1 christos is_branch_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2836 1.1 christos {
2837 1.1 christos return (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
2838 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_LOCAL24PC
2839 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_REL24
2840 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_REL14
2841 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
2842 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN
2843 1.8 christos || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR24
2844 1.8 christos || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14
2845 1.8 christos || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN
2846 1.8 christos || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN
2847 1.8 christos || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_REL24);
2848 1.8 christos }
2849 1.8 christos
2850 1.8 christos /* Relocs on inline plt call sequence insns prior to the call. */
2851 1.8 christos
2852 1.8 christos static bfd_boolean
2853 1.8 christos is_plt_seq_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2854 1.1 christos {
2855 1.1 christos return (r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA
2856 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2857 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2858 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLTSEQ);
2859 1.8 christos }
2860 1.1 christos
2861 1.1 christos static void
2862 1.1 christos bad_shared_reloc (bfd *abfd, enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2863 1.1 christos {
2864 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler
2865 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
2866 1.1 christos (_("%pB: relocation %s cannot be used when making a shared object"),
2867 1.1 christos abfd,
2868 1.1 christos ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name);
2869 1.1 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
2870 1.1 christos }
2871 1.1 christos
2872 1.1 christos /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
2873 1.1 christos allocate space in the global offset table or procedure linkage
2874 1.1 christos table. */
2875 1.1 christos
2876 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
2877 1.1 christos ppc_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd,
2878 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info,
2879 1.1 christos asection *sec,
2880 1.1 christos const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
2881 1.1 christos {
2882 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2883 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2884 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
2885 1.1 christos const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
2886 1.1 christos const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
2887 1.8 christos asection *got2, *sreloc;
2888 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *tga;
2889 1.1 christos
2890 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
2891 1.1 christos return TRUE;
2892 1.1 christos
2893 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
2894 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_check_relocs called for section %pA in %pB",
2895 1.1 christos sec, abfd);
2896 1.1 christos #endif
2897 1.1 christos
2898 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
2899 1.1 christos
2900 1.1 christos /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
2901 1.1 christos if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
2902 1.1 christos ppc_elf_howto_init ();
2903 1.1 christos
2904 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2905 1.1 christos if (htab->glink == NULL)
2906 1.1 christos {
2907 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2908 1.1 christos htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2909 1.1 christos if (!ppc_elf_create_glink (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
2910 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2911 1.1 christos }
2912 1.1 christos tga = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
2913 1.1 christos FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
2914 1.1 christos symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
2915 1.1 christos sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
2916 1.1 christos got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
2917 1.1 christos sreloc = NULL;
2918 1.1 christos
2919 1.6 christos rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
2920 1.8 christos for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++)
2921 1.8 christos {
2922 1.1 christos unsigned long r_symndx;
2923 1.1 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
2924 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
2925 1.1 christos int tls_type;
2926 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **ifunc;
2927 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **pltent;
2928 1.1 christos bfd_vma addend;
2929 1.1 christos
2930 1.1 christos r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
2931 1.1 christos if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
2932 1.1 christos h = NULL;
2933 1.1 christos else
2934 1.1 christos {
2935 1.1 christos h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
2936 1.1 christos while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
2937 1.1 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
2938 1.7 christos h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
2939 1.1 christos }
2940 1.1 christos
2941 1.1 christos /* If a relocation refers to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_, create the .got.
2942 1.1 christos This shows up in particular in an R_PPC_ADDR32 in the eabi
2943 1.1 christos startup code. */
2944 1.1 christos if (h != NULL
2945 1.1 christos && htab->elf.sgot == NULL
2946 1.1 christos && strcmp (h->root.root.string, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_") == 0)
2947 1.1 christos {
2948 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2949 1.1 christos htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2950 1.6 christos if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
2951 1.9 christos return FALSE;
2952 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (h == htab->elf.hgot);
2953 1.9 christos }
2954 1.1 christos
2955 1.1 christos tls_type = 0;
2956 1.1 christos r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
2957 1.1 christos ifunc = NULL;
2958 1.1 christos if (h == NULL && htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks)
2959 1.1 christos {
2960 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->elf.sym_cache,
2961 1.1 christos abfd, r_symndx);
2962 1.8 christos if (isym == NULL)
2963 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2964 1.1 christos
2965 1.1 christos if (ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
2966 1.1 christos {
2967 1.1 christos /* Set PLT_IFUNC flag for this sym, no GOT entry yet. */
2968 1.1 christos ifunc = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
2969 1.6 christos NON_GOT | PLT_IFUNC);
2970 1.8 christos if (ifunc == NULL)
2971 1.8 christos return FALSE;
2972 1.8 christos
2973 1.8 christos /* STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols must have a PLT entry;
2974 1.1 christos In a non-pie executable even when there are
2975 1.8 christos no plt calls. */
2976 1.1 christos if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
2977 1.8 christos || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
2978 1.8 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2979 1.8 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2980 1.8 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA)
2981 1.8 christos {
2982 1.8 christos addend = 0;
2983 1.8 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
2984 1.1 christos ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
2985 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)
2986 1.1 christos && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
2987 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2988 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2989 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
2990 1.9 christos addend = rel->r_addend;
2991 1.1 christos if (!update_plt_info (abfd, ifunc, got2, addend))
2992 1.1 christos return FALSE;
2993 1.1 christos }
2994 1.1 christos }
2995 1.1 christos }
2996 1.1 christos
2997 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks
2998 1.1 christos && is_branch_reloc (r_type)
2999 1.1 christos && h != NULL
3000 1.1 christos && h == tga)
3001 1.1 christos {
3002 1.1 christos if (rel != relocs
3003 1.9 christos && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSGD
3004 1.1 christos || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSLD))
3005 1.1 christos /* We have a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a marker
3006 1.1 christos reloc. */
3007 1.1 christos ;
3008 1.1 christos else
3009 1.1 christos /* Mark this section as having an old-style call. */
3010 1.1 christos sec->nomark_tls_get_addr = 1;
3011 1.1 christos }
3012 1.8 christos
3013 1.8 christos switch (r_type)
3014 1.8 christos {
3015 1.8 christos case R_PPC_TLSGD:
3016 1.8 christos case R_PPC_TLSLD:
3017 1.8 christos /* These special tls relocs tie a call to __tls_get_addr with
3018 1.8 christos its parameter symbol. */
3019 1.8 christos if (h != NULL)
3020 1.8 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK;
3021 1.1 christos else
3022 1.1 christos if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
3023 1.1 christos NON_GOT | TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
3024 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3025 1.1 christos break;
3026 1.1 christos
3027 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
3028 1.1 christos break;
3029 1.1 christos
3030 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
3031 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
3032 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
3033 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
3034 1.1 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
3035 1.1 christos goto dogottls;
3036 1.1 christos
3037 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
3038 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
3039 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
3040 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
3041 1.8 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
3042 1.1 christos goto dogottls;
3043 1.1 christos
3044 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
3045 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
3046 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
3047 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
3048 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_dll (info))
3049 1.1 christos info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
3050 1.1 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
3051 1.1 christos goto dogottls;
3052 1.1 christos
3053 1.7 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
3054 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
3055 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
3056 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
3057 1.1 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
3058 1.1 christos dogottls:
3059 1.1 christos sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
3060 1.1 christos /* Fall through. */
3061 1.7 christos
3062 1.1 christos /* GOT16 relocations */
3063 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16:
3064 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
3065 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
3066 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
3067 1.1 christos /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry. */
3068 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
3069 1.1 christos {
3070 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
3071 1.1 christos htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
3072 1.1 christos if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
3073 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3074 1.1 christos }
3075 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
3076 1.1 christos {
3077 1.1 christos h->got.refcount += 1;
3078 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= tls_type;
3079 1.1 christos }
3080 1.6 christos else
3081 1.1 christos /* This is a global offset table entry for a local symbol. */
3082 1.1 christos if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx, tls_type))
3083 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3084 1.1 christos
3085 1.1 christos /* We may also need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3086 1.1 christos an ifunc. */
3087 1.1 christos if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3088 1.1 christos {
3089 1.3 christos if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3090 1.3 christos return FALSE;
3091 1.3 christos }
3092 1.1 christos break;
3093 1.1 christos
3094 1.1 christos /* Indirect .sdata relocation. */
3095 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
3096 1.1 christos htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3097 1.1 christos if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[0],
3098 1.1 christos h, rel))
3099 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3100 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
3101 1.1 christos {
3102 1.9 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3103 1.1 christos h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3104 1.1 christos }
3105 1.1 christos break;
3106 1.1 christos
3107 1.3 christos /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation. */
3108 1.3 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
3109 1.3 christos if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
3110 1.1 christos {
3111 1.1 christos bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3112 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3113 1.1 christos }
3114 1.1 christos htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3115 1.1 christos if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[1],
3116 1.1 christos h, rel))
3117 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3118 1.3 christos if (h != NULL)
3119 1.3 christos {
3120 1.7 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3121 1.3 christos h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3122 1.1 christos }
3123 1.1 christos break;
3124 1.1 christos
3125 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
3126 1.1 christos htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3127 1.1 christos /* Fall through. */
3128 1.1 christos
3129 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
3130 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
3131 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
3132 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
3133 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
3134 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
3135 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
3136 1.1 christos {
3137 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3138 1.1 christos h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3139 1.1 christos }
3140 1.1 christos break;
3141 1.1 christos
3142 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
3143 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
3144 1.8 christos case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
3145 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
3146 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
3147 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
3148 1.9 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
3149 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
3150 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
3151 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
3152 1.1 christos break;
3153 1.3 christos
3154 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
3155 1.1 christos if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
3156 1.1 christos {
3157 1.1 christos bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3158 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3159 1.1 christos }
3160 1.1 christos htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3161 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
3162 1.1 christos {
3163 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3164 1.1 christos h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3165 1.1 christos }
3166 1.1 christos break;
3167 1.1 christos
3168 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
3169 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
3170 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
3171 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
3172 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
3173 1.1 christos {
3174 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3175 1.1 christos h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3176 1.1 christos }
3177 1.1 christos break;
3178 1.1 christos
3179 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
3180 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
3181 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
3182 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
3183 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
3184 1.8 christos if (h != NULL)
3185 1.8 christos h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3186 1.8 christos break;
3187 1.8 christos
3188 1.8 christos case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
3189 1.8 christos if (h == NULL)
3190 1.8 christos break;
3191 1.1 christos ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
3192 1.1 christos goto pltentry;
3193 1.1 christos
3194 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
3195 1.1 christos sec->has_pltcall = 1;
3196 1.8 christos /* Fall through. */
3197 1.1 christos
3198 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLT32:
3199 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
3200 1.6 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
3201 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
3202 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
3203 1.8 christos pltentry:
3204 1.8 christos #ifdef DEBUG
3205 1.8 christos fprintf (stderr, "Reloc requires a PLT entry\n");
3206 1.8 christos #endif
3207 1.1 christos /* This symbol requires a procedure linkage table entry. */
3208 1.1 christos if (h == NULL)
3209 1.1 christos {
3210 1.8 christos pltent = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
3211 1.8 christos NON_GOT | PLT_KEEP);
3212 1.1 christos if (pltent == NULL)
3213 1.8 christos return FALSE;
3214 1.1 christos }
3215 1.8 christos else
3216 1.8 christos {
3217 1.8 christos if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
3218 1.8 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= PLT_KEEP;
3219 1.8 christos h->needs_plt = 1;
3220 1.8 christos pltent = &h->plt.plist;
3221 1.8 christos }
3222 1.8 christos addend = 0;
3223 1.8 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3224 1.1 christos && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
3225 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
3226 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
3227 1.1 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
3228 1.1 christos addend = rel->r_addend;
3229 1.1 christos if (!update_plt_info (abfd, pltent, got2, addend))
3230 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3231 1.1 christos break;
3232 1.1 christos
3233 1.1 christos /* The following relocations don't need to propagate the
3234 1.1 christos relocation if linking a shared object since they are
3235 1.1 christos section relative. */
3236 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
3237 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
3238 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
3239 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
3240 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
3241 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
3242 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
3243 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
3244 1.6 christos case R_PPC_TOC16:
3245 1.1 christos break;
3246 1.1 christos
3247 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16:
3248 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
3249 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
3250 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
3251 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
3252 1.1 christos ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->has_rel16 = 1;
3253 1.1 christos break;
3254 1.1 christos
3255 1.1 christos /* These are just markers. */
3256 1.7 christos case R_PPC_TLS:
3257 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
3258 1.1 christos case R_PPC_NONE:
3259 1.1 christos case R_PPC_max:
3260 1.1 christos case R_PPC_RELAX:
3261 1.1 christos case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
3262 1.1 christos case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
3263 1.1 christos case R_PPC_16DX_HA:
3264 1.1 christos break;
3265 1.1 christos
3266 1.1 christos /* These should only appear in dynamic objects. */
3267 1.1 christos case R_PPC_COPY:
3268 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
3269 1.1 christos case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
3270 1.1 christos case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
3271 1.1 christos case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
3272 1.1 christos break;
3273 1.1 christos
3274 1.1 christos /* These aren't handled yet. We'll report an error later. */
3275 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR30:
3276 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
3277 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
3278 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
3279 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
3280 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
3281 1.1 christos break;
3282 1.1 christos
3283 1.3 christos /* This refers only to functions defined in the shared library. */
3284 1.3 christos case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
3285 1.3 christos if (h != NULL && h == htab->elf.hgot && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3286 1.3 christos {
3287 1.3 christos htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3288 1.3 christos htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3289 1.1 christos }
3290 1.1 christos if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
3291 1.1 christos {
3292 1.1 christos h->needs_plt = 1;
3293 1.1 christos if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3294 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3295 1.1 christos }
3296 1.1 christos break;
3297 1.1 christos
3298 1.1 christos /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
3299 1.1 christos Reconstruct it for later use during GC. */
3300 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
3301 1.9 christos if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
3302 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3303 1.1 christos break;
3304 1.1 christos
3305 1.9 christos /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
3306 1.9 christos used. Record for later use during GC. */
3307 1.9 christos case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
3308 1.9 christos if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_addend))
3309 1.8 christos return FALSE;
3310 1.1 christos break;
3311 1.1 christos
3312 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
3313 1.8 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
3314 1.1 christos sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
3315 1.1 christos /* Fall through. */
3316 1.1 christos /* We shouldn't really be seeing TPREL32. */
3317 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL32:
3318 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16:
3319 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
3320 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_dll (info))
3321 1.1 christos info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
3322 1.1 christos goto dodyn;
3323 1.1 christos
3324 1.1 christos /* Nor these. */
3325 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
3326 1.6 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
3327 1.1 christos goto dodyn;
3328 1.1 christos
3329 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL32:
3330 1.1 christos if (h == NULL
3331 1.1 christos && got2 != NULL
3332 1.1 christos && (sec->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
3333 1.1 christos && bfd_link_pic (info)
3334 1.1 christos && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3335 1.1 christos {
3336 1.1 christos /* Old -fPIC gcc code has .long LCTOC1-LCFx just before
3337 1.1 christos the start of a function, which assembles to a REL32
3338 1.9 christos reference to .got2. If we detect one of these, then
3339 1.1 christos force the old PLT layout because the linker cannot
3340 1.1 christos reliably deduce the GOT pointer value needed for
3341 1.1 christos PLT call stubs. */
3342 1.1 christos asection *s;
3343 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
3344 1.1 christos
3345 1.1 christos isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->elf.sym_cache,
3346 1.1 christos abfd, r_symndx);
3347 1.1 christos if (isym == NULL)
3348 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3349 1.1 christos
3350 1.1 christos s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
3351 1.1 christos if (s == got2)
3352 1.1 christos {
3353 1.1 christos htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3354 1.1 christos htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3355 1.1 christos }
3356 1.1 christos }
3357 1.1 christos if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
3358 1.1 christos break;
3359 1.1 christos /* fall through */
3360 1.1 christos
3361 1.6 christos case R_PPC_ADDR32:
3362 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16:
3363 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
3364 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
3365 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
3366 1.1 christos case R_PPC_UADDR32:
3367 1.1 christos case R_PPC_UADDR16:
3368 1.1 christos if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3369 1.1 christos {
3370 1.1 christos /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3371 1.5 christos a function defined in a dynamic object. */
3372 1.5 christos if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3373 1.5 christos return FALSE;
3374 1.5 christos
3375 1.1 christos /* We may need a copy reloc too. */
3376 1.1 christos h->non_got_ref = 1;
3377 1.1 christos h->pointer_equality_needed = 1;
3378 1.1 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
3379 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha = 1;
3380 1.1 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO)
3381 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo = 1;
3382 1.1 christos }
3383 1.1 christos goto dodyn;
3384 1.1 christos
3385 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL24:
3386 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14:
3387 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
3388 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
3389 1.1 christos if (h == NULL)
3390 1.1 christos break;
3391 1.1 christos if (h == htab->elf.hgot)
3392 1.1 christos {
3393 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3394 1.1 christos {
3395 1.1 christos htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3396 1.1 christos htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3397 1.1 christos }
3398 1.1 christos break;
3399 1.6 christos }
3400 1.1 christos /* fall through */
3401 1.1 christos
3402 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR24:
3403 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14:
3404 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
3405 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
3406 1.1 christos if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3407 1.1 christos {
3408 1.1 christos /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3409 1.1 christos a function defined in a dynamic object. */
3410 1.1 christos h->needs_plt = 1;
3411 1.1 christos if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3412 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3413 1.1 christos break;
3414 1.1 christos }
3415 1.1 christos
3416 1.1 christos dodyn:
3417 1.1 christos /* If we are creating a shared library, and this is a reloc
3418 1.1 christos against a global symbol, or a non PC relative reloc
3419 1.1 christos against a local symbol, then we need to copy the reloc
3420 1.1 christos into the shared library. However, if we are linking with
3421 1.1 christos -Bsymbolic, we do not need to copy a reloc against a
3422 1.1 christos global symbol which is defined in an object we are
3423 1.1 christos including in the link (i.e., DEF_REGULAR is set). At
3424 1.1 christos this point we have not seen all the input files, so it is
3425 1.1 christos possible that DEF_REGULAR is not set now but will be set
3426 1.1 christos later (it is never cleared). In case of a weak definition,
3427 1.1 christos DEF_REGULAR may be cleared later by a strong definition in
3428 1.1 christos a shared library. We account for that possibility below by
3429 1.1 christos storing information in the dyn_relocs field of the hash
3430 1.1 christos table entry. A similar situation occurs when creating
3431 1.6 christos shared libraries and symbol visibility changes render the
3432 1.1 christos symbol local.
3433 1.1 christos
3434 1.1 christos If on the other hand, we are creating an executable, we
3435 1.1 christos may need to keep relocations for symbols satisfied by a
3436 1.1 christos dynamic library if we manage to avoid copy relocs for the
3437 1.1 christos symbol. */
3438 1.6 christos if ((bfd_link_pic (info)
3439 1.1 christos && (must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)
3440 1.1 christos || (h != NULL
3441 1.1 christos && (!SYMBOLIC_BIND (info, h)
3442 1.1 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
3443 1.1 christos || !h->def_regular))))
3444 1.1 christos || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
3445 1.1 christos && !bfd_link_pic (info)
3446 1.1 christos && h != NULL
3447 1.1 christos && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
3448 1.1 christos || !h->def_regular)))
3449 1.1 christos {
3450 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
3451 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr,
3452 1.1 christos "ppc_elf_check_relocs needs to "
3453 1.1 christos "create relocation for %s\n",
3454 1.1 christos (h && h->root.root.string
3455 1.1 christos ? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
3456 1.1 christos #endif
3457 1.1 christos if (sreloc == NULL)
3458 1.1 christos {
3459 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
3460 1.1 christos htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
3461 1.1 christos
3462 1.1 christos sreloc = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_reloc_section
3463 1.1 christos (sec, htab->elf.dynobj, 2, abfd, /*rela?*/ TRUE);
3464 1.1 christos
3465 1.1 christos if (sreloc == NULL)
3466 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3467 1.1 christos }
3468 1.1 christos
3469 1.9 christos /* If this is a global symbol, we count the number of
3470 1.1 christos relocations we need for this symbol. */
3471 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
3472 1.1 christos {
3473 1.1 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
3474 1.1 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
3475 1.1 christos
3476 1.1 christos rel_head = &h->dyn_relocs;
3477 1.1 christos p = *rel_head;
3478 1.1 christos if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec)
3479 1.1 christos {
3480 1.1 christos p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
3481 1.1 christos if (p == NULL)
3482 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3483 1.1 christos p->next = *rel_head;
3484 1.1 christos *rel_head = p;
3485 1.1 christos p->sec = sec;
3486 1.1 christos p->count = 0;
3487 1.1 christos p->pc_count = 0;
3488 1.1 christos }
3489 1.1 christos p->count += 1;
3490 1.1 christos if (!must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
3491 1.1 christos p->pc_count += 1;
3492 1.1 christos }
3493 1.1 christos else
3494 1.1 christos {
3495 1.1 christos /* Track dynamic relocs needed for local syms too.
3496 1.1 christos We really need local syms available to do this
3497 1.1 christos easily. Oh well. */
3498 1.9 christos struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
3499 1.1 christos struct ppc_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
3500 1.1 christos bfd_boolean is_ifunc;
3501 1.1 christos asection *s;
3502 1.1 christos void *vpp;
3503 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
3504 1.1 christos
3505 1.1 christos isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->elf.sym_cache,
3506 1.1 christos abfd, r_symndx);
3507 1.1 christos if (isym == NULL)
3508 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3509 1.1 christos
3510 1.1 christos s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
3511 1.1 christos if (s == NULL)
3512 1.1 christos s = sec;
3513 1.1 christos
3514 1.1 christos vpp = &elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel;
3515 1.1 christos rel_head = (struct ppc_dyn_relocs **) vpp;
3516 1.1 christos is_ifunc = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC;
3517 1.1 christos p = *rel_head;
3518 1.1 christos if (p != NULL && p->sec == sec && p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
3519 1.1 christos p = p->next;
3520 1.1 christos if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec || p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
3521 1.1 christos {
3522 1.1 christos p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
3523 1.1 christos if (p == NULL)
3524 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3525 1.1 christos p->next = *rel_head;
3526 1.1 christos *rel_head = p;
3527 1.1 christos p->sec = sec;
3528 1.1 christos p->ifunc = is_ifunc;
3529 1.1 christos p->count = 0;
3530 1.1 christos }
3531 1.1 christos p->count += 1;
3532 1.1 christos }
3533 1.1 christos }
3534 1.1 christos
3535 1.7 christos break;
3536 1.7 christos }
3537 1.8 christos }
3538 1.7 christos
3539 1.1 christos return TRUE;
3540 1.7 christos }
3541 1.1 christos
3542 1.1 christos /* Warn for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP attributes between IBFD
3544 1.9 christos and OBFD, and merge non-conflicting ones. */
3545 1.9 christos bfd_boolean
3546 1.9 christos _bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3547 1.9 christos {
3548 1.9 christos bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
3549 1.9 christos obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
3550 1.9 christos obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
3551 1.9 christos bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
3552 1.9 christos bfd_boolean warn_only;
3553 1.9 christos
3554 1.9 christos /* We only warn about shared library mismatches, because common
3555 1.1 christos libraries advertise support for a particular long double variant
3556 1.1 christos but actually support more than one variant. For example, glibc
3557 1.1 christos typically supports 128-bit IBM long double in the shared library
3558 1.1 christos but has a compatibility static archive for 64-bit long double.
3559 1.1 christos The linker doesn't have the smarts to see that an app using
3560 1.1 christos object files marked as 64-bit long double call the compatibility
3561 1.7 christos layer objects and only from there call into the shared library. */
3562 1.1 christos warn_only = (ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0;
3563 1.1 christos
3564 1.7 christos in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3565 1.7 christos out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3566 1.8 christos
3567 1.7 christos in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
3568 1.7 christos out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
3569 1.1 christos
3570 1.7 christos if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3571 1.7 christos {
3572 1.9 christos int in_fp = in_attr->i & 3;
3573 1.9 christos int out_fp = out_attr->i & 3;
3574 1.9 christos static bfd *last_fp, *last_ld;
3575 1.9 christos
3576 1.9 christos if (in_fp == 0)
3577 1.9 christos ;
3578 1.7 christos else if (out_fp == 0)
3579 1.7 christos {
3580 1.8 christos if (!warn_only)
3581 1.8 christos {
3582 1.8 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3583 1.8 christos out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
3584 1.8 christos last_fp = ibfd;
3585 1.9 christos }
3586 1.8 christos }
3587 1.7 christos else if (out_fp != 2 && in_fp == 2)
3588 1.8 christos {
3589 1.8 christos _bfd_error_handler
3590 1.8 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3591 1.8 christos (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
3592 1.8 christos last_fp, ibfd);
3593 1.9 christos ret = warn_only;
3594 1.8 christos }
3595 1.7 christos else if (out_fp == 2 && in_fp != 2)
3596 1.8 christos {
3597 1.8 christos _bfd_error_handler
3598 1.8 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3599 1.8 christos (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
3600 1.8 christos ibfd, last_fp);
3601 1.9 christos ret = warn_only;
3602 1.8 christos }
3603 1.7 christos else if (out_fp == 1 && in_fp == 3)
3604 1.8 christos {
3605 1.8 christos _bfd_error_handler
3606 1.8 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3607 1.8 christos (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
3608 1.8 christos "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), last_fp, ibfd);
3609 1.9 christos ret = warn_only;
3610 1.8 christos }
3611 1.7 christos else if (out_fp == 3 && in_fp == 1)
3612 1.7 christos {
3613 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
3614 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3615 1.7 christos (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
3616 1.7 christos "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), ibfd, last_fp);
3617 1.7 christos ret = warn_only;
3618 1.9 christos }
3619 1.9 christos
3620 1.9 christos in_fp = in_attr->i & 0xc;
3621 1.9 christos out_fp = out_attr->i & 0xc;
3622 1.9 christos if (in_fp == 0)
3623 1.9 christos ;
3624 1.7 christos else if (out_fp == 0)
3625 1.7 christos {
3626 1.8 christos if (!warn_only)
3627 1.8 christos {
3628 1.8 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3629 1.8 christos out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
3630 1.8 christos last_ld = ibfd;
3631 1.9 christos }
3632 1.8 christos }
3633 1.7 christos else if (out_fp != 2 * 4 && in_fp == 2 * 4)
3634 1.8 christos {
3635 1.8 christos _bfd_error_handler
3636 1.8 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3637 1.8 christos (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
3638 1.8 christos "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
3639 1.9 christos ret = warn_only;
3640 1.8 christos }
3641 1.7 christos else if (in_fp != 2 * 4 && out_fp == 2 * 4)
3642 1.8 christos {
3643 1.8 christos _bfd_error_handler
3644 1.8 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3645 1.8 christos (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
3646 1.8 christos "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
3647 1.9 christos ret = warn_only;
3648 1.8 christos }
3649 1.7 christos else if (out_fp == 1 * 4 && in_fp == 3 * 4)
3650 1.8 christos {
3651 1.8 christos _bfd_error_handler
3652 1.8 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3653 1.8 christos (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
3654 1.8 christos "%pB uses IEEE long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
3655 1.9 christos ret = warn_only;
3656 1.8 christos }
3657 1.8 christos else if (out_fp == 3 * 4 && in_fp == 1 * 4)
3658 1.8 christos {
3659 1.8 christos _bfd_error_handler
3660 1.8 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3661 1.8 christos (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
3662 1.8 christos "%pB uses IEEE long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
3663 1.1 christos ret = warn_only;
3664 1.8 christos }
3665 1.7 christos }
3666 1.7 christos
3667 1.7 christos if (!ret)
3668 1.7 christos {
3669 1.7 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3670 1.7 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3671 1.7 christos }
3672 1.7 christos return ret;
3673 1.7 christos }
3674 1.7 christos
3675 1.8 christos /* Merge object attributes from IBFD into OBFD. Warn if
3676 1.7 christos there are conflicting attributes. */
3677 1.8 christos static bfd_boolean
3678 1.8 christos ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3679 1.7 christos {
3680 1.7 christos bfd *obfd;
3681 1.7 christos obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
3682 1.7 christos obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
3683 1.1 christos bfd_boolean ret;
3684 1.1 christos
3685 1.1 christos if (!_bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (ibfd, info))
3686 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3687 1.1 christos
3688 1.8 christos obfd = info->output_bfd;
3689 1.1 christos in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3690 1.1 christos out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3691 1.7 christos
3692 1.7 christos /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector attributes and
3693 1.8 christos merge non-conflicting ones. */
3694 1.1 christos in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
3695 1.7 christos out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
3696 1.7 christos ret = TRUE;
3697 1.7 christos if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3698 1.1 christos {
3699 1.8 christos int in_vec = in_attr->i & 3;
3700 1.7 christos int out_vec = out_attr->i & 3;
3701 1.8 christos static bfd *last_vec;
3702 1.1 christos
3703 1.1 christos if (in_vec == 0)
3704 1.1 christos ;
3705 1.1 christos else if (out_vec == 0)
3706 1.1 christos {
3707 1.1 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3708 1.7 christos out_attr->i = in_vec;
3709 1.1 christos last_vec = ibfd;
3710 1.7 christos }
3711 1.7 christos /* For now, allow generic to transition to AltiVec or SPE
3712 1.8 christos without a warning. If GCC marked files with their stack
3713 1.7 christos alignment and used don't-care markings for files which are
3714 1.8 christos not affected by the vector ABI, we could warn about this
3715 1.7 christos case too. */
3716 1.7 christos else if (in_vec == 1)
3717 1.8 christos ;
3718 1.8 christos else if (out_vec == 1)
3719 1.8 christos {
3720 1.8 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3721 1.8 christos out_attr->i = in_vec;
3722 1.8 christos last_vec = ibfd;
3723 1.8 christos }
3724 1.8 christos else if (out_vec < in_vec)
3725 1.7 christos {
3726 1.8 christos _bfd_error_handler
3727 1.8 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3728 1.8 christos (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
3729 1.8 christos last_vec, ibfd);
3730 1.8 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3731 1.8 christos ret = FALSE;
3732 1.8 christos }
3733 1.8 christos else if (out_vec > in_vec)
3734 1.1 christos {
3735 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler
3736 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3737 1.1 christos (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
3738 1.1 christos ibfd, last_vec);
3739 1.1 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3740 1.1 christos ret = FALSE;
3741 1.1 christos }
3742 1.7 christos }
3743 1.7 christos
3744 1.8 christos /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return attributes
3745 1.7 christos and merge non-conflicting ones. */
3746 1.7 christos in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
3747 1.1 christos out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
3748 1.7 christos if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3749 1.7 christos {
3750 1.8 christos int in_struct = in_attr->i & 3;
3751 1.7 christos int out_struct = out_attr->i & 3;
3752 1.8 christos static bfd *last_struct;
3753 1.7 christos
3754 1.7 christos if (in_struct == 0 || in_struct == 3)
3755 1.8 christos ;
3756 1.8 christos else if (out_struct == 0)
3757 1.8 christos {
3758 1.8 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3759 1.8 christos out_attr->i = in_struct;
3760 1.8 christos last_struct = ibfd;
3761 1.8 christos }
3762 1.8 christos else if (out_struct < in_struct)
3763 1.7 christos {
3764 1.8 christos _bfd_error_handler
3765 1.8 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3766 1.8 christos (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
3767 1.8 christos "%pB uses memory"), last_struct, ibfd);
3768 1.8 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3769 1.8 christos ret = FALSE;
3770 1.8 christos }
3771 1.8 christos else if (out_struct > in_struct)
3772 1.8 christos {
3773 1.8 christos _bfd_error_handler
3774 1.8 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3775 1.8 christos (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
3776 1.8 christos "%pB uses memory"), ibfd, last_struct);
3777 1.1 christos out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3778 1.1 christos ret = FALSE;
3779 1.1 christos }
3780 1.8 christos }
3781 1.1 christos if (!ret)
3782 1.1 christos {
3783 1.1 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3784 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3785 1.1 christos }
3786 1.1 christos
3787 1.7 christos /* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones. */
3788 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, info);
3789 1.7 christos }
3790 1.1 christos
3791 1.1 christos /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
3792 1.1 christos object file when linking. */
3793 1.1 christos
3794 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
3795 1.1 christos ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3796 1.1 christos {
3797 1.1 christos bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
3798 1.7 christos flagword old_flags;
3799 1.1 christos flagword new_flags;
3800 1.1 christos bfd_boolean error;
3801 1.7 christos
3802 1.1 christos if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd) || !is_ppc_elf (obfd))
3803 1.1 christos return TRUE;
3804 1.9 christos
3805 1.9 christos /* Check if we have the same endianness. */
3806 1.9 christos if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, info))
3807 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3808 1.1 christos
3809 1.1 christos if (!ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (ibfd, info))
3810 1.1 christos return FALSE;
3811 1.1 christos
3812 1.1 christos if ((ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
3813 1.1 christos return TRUE;
3814 1.1 christos
3815 1.1 christos new_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
3816 1.1 christos old_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
3817 1.1 christos if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
3818 1.1 christos {
3819 1.1 christos /* First call, no flags set. */
3820 1.1 christos elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
3821 1.1 christos elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = new_flags;
3822 1.1 christos }
3823 1.1 christos
3824 1.1 christos /* Compatible flags are ok. */
3825 1.1 christos else if (new_flags == old_flags)
3826 1.1 christos ;
3827 1.1 christos
3828 1.1 christos /* Incompatible flags. */
3829 1.1 christos else
3830 1.7 christos {
3831 1.8 christos /* Warn about -mrelocatable mismatch. Allow -mrelocatable-lib
3832 1.1 christos to be linked with either. */
3833 1.1 christos error = FALSE;
3834 1.1 christos if ((new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0
3835 1.1 christos && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0)
3836 1.1 christos {
3837 1.1 christos error = TRUE;
3838 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
3839 1.8 christos (_("%pB: compiled with -mrelocatable and linked with "
3840 1.1 christos "modules compiled normally"), ibfd);
3841 1.1 christos }
3842 1.1 christos else if ((new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0
3843 1.1 christos && (old_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0)
3844 1.1 christos {
3845 1.1 christos error = TRUE;
3846 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler
3847 1.1 christos (_("%pB: compiled normally and linked with "
3848 1.1 christos "modules compiled with -mrelocatable"), ibfd);
3849 1.1 christos }
3850 1.1 christos
3851 1.1 christos /* The output is -mrelocatable-lib iff both the input files are. */
3852 1.1 christos if (! (new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB))
3853 1.1 christos elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB;
3854 1.1 christos
3855 1.1 christos /* The output is -mrelocatable iff it can't be -mrelocatable-lib,
3856 1.1 christos but each input file is either -mrelocatable or -mrelocatable-lib. */
3857 1.1 christos if (! (elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)
3858 1.1 christos && (new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE))
3859 1.1 christos && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE)))
3860 1.1 christos elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE;
3861 1.1 christos
3862 1.1 christos /* Do not warn about eabi vs. V.4 mismatch, just or in the bit if
3863 1.1 christos any module uses it. */
3864 1.1 christos elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= (new_flags & EF_PPC_EMB);
3865 1.7 christos
3866 1.7 christos new_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
3867 1.8 christos old_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
3868 1.8 christos
3869 1.8 christos /* Warn about any other mismatches. */
3870 1.1 christos if (new_flags != old_flags)
3871 1.1 christos {
3872 1.1 christos error = TRUE;
3873 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler
3874 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3875 1.1 christos (_("%pB: uses different e_flags (%#x) fields "
3876 1.1 christos "than previous modules (%#x)"),
3877 1.1 christos ibfd, new_flags, old_flags);
3878 1.1 christos }
3879 1.1 christos
3880 1.1 christos if (error)
3881 1.1 christos {
3882 1.1 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3883 1.7 christos return FALSE;
3884 1.7 christos }
3885 1.7 christos }
3886 1.7 christos
3887 1.3 christos return TRUE;
3888 1.7 christos }
3889 1.7 christos
3890 1.1 christos static void
3891 1.8 christos ppc_elf_vle_split16 (bfd *input_bfd,
3892 1.1 christos asection *input_section,
3893 1.7 christos unsigned long offset,
3894 1.8 christos bfd_byte *loc,
3895 1.7 christos bfd_vma value,
3896 1.7 christos split16_format_type split16_format,
3897 1.7 christos bfd_boolean fixup)
3898 1.7 christos {
3899 1.7 christos unsigned int insn, opcode;
3900 1.7 christos
3901 1.7 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, loc);
3902 1.7 christos opcode = insn & E_OPCODE_MASK;
3903 1.7 christos if (opcode == E_OR2I_INSN
3904 1.7 christos || opcode == E_AND2I_DOT_INSN
3905 1.7 christos || opcode == E_OR2IS_INSN
3906 1.7 christos || opcode == E_LIS_INSN
3907 1.7 christos || opcode == E_AND2IS_DOT_INSN)
3908 1.8 christos {
3909 1.7 christos if (split16_format != split16a_type)
3910 1.7 christos {
3911 1.7 christos if (fixup)
3912 1.7 christos split16_format = split16a_type;
3913 1.7 christos else
3914 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
3915 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3916 1.7 christos (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16A style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
3917 1.7 christos input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
3918 1.7 christos }
3919 1.7 christos }
3920 1.7 christos else if (opcode == E_ADD2I_DOT_INSN
3921 1.7 christos || opcode == E_ADD2IS_INSN
3922 1.7 christos || opcode == E_CMP16I_INSN
3923 1.7 christos || opcode == E_MULL2I_INSN
3924 1.7 christos || opcode == E_CMPL16I_INSN
3925 1.7 christos || opcode == E_CMPH16I_INSN
3926 1.7 christos || opcode == E_CMPHL16I_INSN)
3927 1.8 christos {
3928 1.7 christos if (split16_format != split16d_type)
3929 1.7 christos {
3930 1.7 christos if (fixup)
3931 1.8 christos split16_format = split16d_type;
3932 1.8 christos else
3933 1.8 christos _bfd_error_handler
3934 1.8 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
3935 1.8 christos (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16D style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
3936 1.8 christos input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
3937 1.8 christos }
3938 1.8 christos }
3939 1.8 christos if (split16_format == split16a_type)
3940 1.8 christos {
3941 1.8 christos insn &= ~((0xf800 << 5) | 0x7ff);
3942 1.8 christos insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
3943 1.8 christos if ((insn & E_LI_MASK) == E_LI_INSN)
3944 1.8 christos {
3945 1.8 christos /* Hack for e_li. Extend sign. */
3946 1.8 christos insn &= ~(0xf0000 >> 5);
3947 1.3 christos insn |= (-(value & 0x8000) & 0xf0000) >> 5;
3948 1.7 christos }
3949 1.1 christos }
3950 1.8 christos else
3951 1.8 christos {
3952 1.8 christos insn &= ~((0xf800 << 10) | 0x7ff);
3953 1.8 christos insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 10;
3954 1.8 christos }
3955 1.8 christos insn |= value & 0x7ff;
3956 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, loc);
3957 1.8 christos }
3958 1.8 christos
3959 1.8 christos static void
3960 1.8 christos ppc_elf_vle_split20 (bfd *output_bfd, bfd_byte *loc, bfd_vma value)
3961 1.8 christos {
3962 1.8 christos unsigned int insn;
3963 1.8 christos
3964 1.8 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
3965 1.8 christos /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31. */
3966 1.8 christos /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20. */
3967 1.1 christos insn |= (value & 0xf0000) >> 5;
3968 1.1 christos /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15. */
3969 1.1 christos insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
3970 1.1 christos /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31. */
3971 1.1 christos insn |= value & 0x7ff;
3972 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, insn, loc);
3973 1.1 christos }
3974 1.1 christos
3975 1.1 christos
3976 1.1 christos /* Choose which PLT scheme to use, and set .plt flags appropriately.
3978 1.1 christos Returns -1 on error, 0 for old PLT, 1 for new PLT. */
3979 1.1 christos int
3980 1.1 christos ppc_elf_select_plt_layout (bfd *output_bfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3981 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info)
3982 1.1 christos {
3983 1.3 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3984 1.1 christos flagword flags;
3985 1.6 christos
3986 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
3987 1.1 christos
3988 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3989 1.1 christos {
3990 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3991 1.1 christos
3992 1.1 christos if (htab->params->plt_style == PLT_OLD)
3993 1.8 christos htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3994 1.1 christos else if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3995 1.1 christos && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
3996 1.1 christos && (h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "_mcount",
3997 1.1 christos FALSE, FALSE, TRUE)) != NULL
3998 1.1 christos && (h->type == STT_FUNC
3999 1.1 christos || h->needs_plt)
4000 1.1 christos && h->ref_regular
4001 1.1 christos && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
4002 1.1 christos || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
4003 1.1 christos {
4004 1.3 christos /* Profiling of shared libs (and pies) is not supported with
4005 1.1 christos secure plt, because ppc32 does profiling before a
4006 1.1 christos function prologue and a secure plt pic call stubs needs
4007 1.1 christos r30 to be set up. */
4008 1.1 christos htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4009 1.1 christos }
4010 1.1 christos else
4011 1.1 christos {
4012 1.3 christos bfd *ibfd;
4013 1.1 christos enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type = htab->params->plt_style;
4014 1.1 christos
4015 1.1 christos /* Look through the reloc flags left by ppc_elf_check_relocs.
4016 1.1 christos Use the old style bss plt if a file makes plt calls
4017 1.1 christos without using the new relocs, and if ld isn't given
4018 1.1 christos --secure-plt and we never see REL16 relocs. */
4019 1.1 christos if (plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
4020 1.1 christos plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4021 1.1 christos for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4022 1.1 christos if (is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
4023 1.1 christos {
4024 1.1 christos if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->has_rel16)
4025 1.1 christos plt_type = PLT_NEW;
4026 1.1 christos else if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->makes_plt_call)
4027 1.3 christos {
4028 1.1 christos plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4029 1.1 christos htab->old_bfd = ibfd;
4030 1.8 christos break;
4031 1.1 christos }
4032 1.8 christos }
4033 1.1 christos htab->plt_type = plt_type;
4034 1.1 christos }
4035 1.1 christos }
4036 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD && htab->params->plt_style == PLT_NEW)
4037 1.1 christos {
4038 1.1 christos if (htab->old_bfd != NULL)
4039 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced due to %pB"), htab->old_bfd);
4040 1.1 christos else
4041 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced by profiling"));
4042 1.1 christos }
4043 1.7 christos
4044 1.9 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS);
4045 1.1 christos
4046 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
4047 1.1 christos {
4048 1.7 christos flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
4049 1.9 christos | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
4050 1.1 christos
4051 1.1 christos /* The new PLT is a loaded section. */
4052 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.splt != NULL
4053 1.1 christos && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.splt, flags))
4054 1.1 christos return -1;
4055 1.1 christos
4056 1.9 christos /* The new GOT is not executable. */
4057 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
4058 1.1 christos && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.sgot, flags))
4059 1.1 christos return -1;
4060 1.1 christos }
4061 1.1 christos else
4062 1.1 christos {
4063 1.1 christos /* Stop an unused .glink section from affecting .text alignment. */
4064 1.1 christos if (htab->glink != NULL
4065 1.1 christos && !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->glink, 0))
4066 1.1 christos return -1;
4067 1.1 christos }
4068 1.1 christos return htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW;
4069 1.1 christos }
4070 1.1 christos
4071 1.1 christos /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
4073 1.1 christos relocation. */
4074 1.1 christos
4075 1.1 christos static asection *
4076 1.1 christos ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
4077 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info,
4078 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4079 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4080 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
4081 1.1 christos {
4082 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
4083 1.1 christos switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
4084 1.8 christos {
4085 1.8 christos case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
4086 1.8 christos case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
4087 1.8 christos return NULL;
4088 1.8 christos }
4089 1.8 christos
4090 1.8 christos return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
4091 1.1 christos }
4092 1.8 christos
4093 1.8 christos static bfd_boolean
4094 1.8 christos get_sym_h (struct elf_link_hash_entry **hp,
4095 1.8 christos Elf_Internal_Sym **symp,
4096 1.8 christos asection **symsecp,
4097 1.8 christos unsigned char **tls_maskp,
4098 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym **locsymsp,
4099 1.8 christos unsigned long r_symndx,
4100 1.8 christos bfd *ibfd)
4101 1.8 christos {
4102 1.8 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4103 1.1 christos
4104 1.8 christos if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4105 1.8 christos {
4106 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4107 1.8 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4108 1.8 christos
4109 1.1 christos h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4110 1.8 christos while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4111 1.8 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4112 1.8 christos h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4113 1.8 christos
4114 1.8 christos if (hp != NULL)
4115 1.8 christos *hp = h;
4116 1.8 christos
4117 1.8 christos if (symp != NULL)
4118 1.1 christos *symp = NULL;
4119 1.8 christos
4120 1.8 christos if (symsecp != NULL)
4121 1.8 christos {
4122 1.8 christos asection *symsec = NULL;
4123 1.1 christos if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4124 1.8 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
4125 1.8 christos symsec = h->root.u.def.section;
4126 1.1 christos *symsecp = symsec;
4127 1.8 christos }
4128 1.1 christos
4129 1.8 christos if (tls_maskp != NULL)
4130 1.8 christos *tls_maskp = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
4131 1.8 christos }
4132 1.8 christos else
4133 1.8 christos {
4134 1.8 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
4135 1.8 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *locsyms = *locsymsp;
4136 1.8 christos
4137 1.8 christos if (locsyms == NULL)
4138 1.8 christos {
4139 1.1 christos locsyms = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
4140 1.8 christos if (locsyms == NULL)
4141 1.8 christos locsyms = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (ibfd, symtab_hdr,
4142 1.8 christos symtab_hdr->sh_info,
4143 1.8 christos 0, NULL, NULL, NULL);
4144 1.8 christos if (locsyms == NULL)
4145 1.8 christos return FALSE;
4146 1.8 christos *locsymsp = locsyms;
4147 1.8 christos }
4148 1.1 christos sym = locsyms + r_symndx;
4149 1.8 christos
4150 1.8 christos if (hp != NULL)
4151 1.8 christos *hp = NULL;
4152 1.8 christos
4153 1.1 christos if (symp != NULL)
4154 1.8 christos *symp = sym;
4155 1.8 christos
4156 1.8 christos if (symsecp != NULL)
4157 1.1 christos *symsecp = bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, sym->st_shndx);
4158 1.8 christos
4159 1.8 christos if (tls_maskp != NULL)
4160 1.8 christos {
4161 1.8 christos bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
4162 1.8 christos unsigned char *tls_mask;
4163 1.1 christos
4164 1.8 christos tls_mask = NULL;
4165 1.1 christos local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
4166 1.8 christos if (local_got != NULL)
4167 1.8 christos {
4168 1.8 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
4169 1.8 christos (local_got + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4170 1.8 christos unsigned char *lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
4171 1.8 christos (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4172 1.8 christos tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
4173 1.8 christos }
4174 1.8 christos *tls_maskp = tls_mask;
4175 1.8 christos }
4176 1.8 christos }
4177 1.8 christos return TRUE;
4178 1.8 christos }
4179 1.8 christos
4180 1.8 christos /* Analyze inline PLT call relocations to see whether calls to locally
4182 1.8 christos defined functions can be converted to direct calls. */
4183 1.8 christos
4184 1.8 christos bfd_boolean
4185 1.8 christos ppc_elf_inline_plt (struct bfd_link_info *info)
4186 1.8 christos {
4187 1.8 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4188 1.8 christos bfd *ibfd;
4189 1.8 christos asection *sec;
4190 1.8 christos bfd_vma low_vma, high_vma, limit;
4191 1.8 christos
4192 1.8 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4193 1.8 christos if (htab == NULL)
4194 1.8 christos return FALSE;
4195 1.8 christos
4196 1.8 christos /* A bl insn can reach -0x2000000 to 0x1fffffc. The limit is
4197 1.8 christos reduced somewhat to cater for possible stubs that might be added
4198 1.8 christos between the call and its destination. */
4199 1.1 christos limit = 0x1e00000;
4200 1.8 christos low_vma = -1;
4201 1.8 christos high_vma = 0;
4202 1.8 christos for (sec = info->output_bfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4203 1.8 christos if ((sec->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE)) == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE))
4204 1.8 christos {
4205 1.8 christos if (low_vma > sec->vma)
4206 1.8 christos low_vma = sec->vma;
4207 1.8 christos if (high_vma < sec->vma + sec->size)
4208 1.8 christos high_vma = sec->vma + sec->size;
4209 1.8 christos }
4210 1.8 christos
4211 1.8 christos /* If a "bl" can reach anywhere in local code sections, then we can
4212 1.8 christos convert all inline PLT sequences to direct calls when the symbol
4213 1.8 christos is local. */
4214 1.8 christos if (high_vma - low_vma < limit)
4215 1.8 christos {
4216 1.8 christos htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt = 1;
4217 1.8 christos return TRUE;
4218 1.8 christos }
4219 1.8 christos
4220 1.8 christos /* Otherwise, go looking through relocs for cases where a direct
4221 1.8 christos call won't reach. Mark the symbol on any such reloc to disable
4222 1.8 christos the optimization and keep the PLT entry as it seems likely that
4223 1.8 christos this will be better than creating trampolines. Note that this
4224 1.8 christos will disable the optimization for all inline PLT calls to a
4225 1.8 christos particular symbol, not just those that won't reach. The
4226 1.8 christos difficulty in doing a more precise optimization is that the
4227 1.8 christos linker needs to make a decision depending on whether a
4228 1.8 christos particular R_PPC_PLTCALL insn can be turned into a direct
4229 1.1 christos call, for each of the R_PPC_PLTSEQ and R_PPC_PLT16* insns in
4230 1.8 christos the sequence, and there is nothing that ties those relocs
4231 1.8 christos together except their symbol. */
4232 1.1 christos
4233 1.8 christos for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4234 1.8 christos {
4235 1.8 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
4236 1.8 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
4237 1.8 christos
4238 1.1 christos if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
4239 1.8 christos continue;
4240 1.8 christos
4241 1.8 christos local_syms = NULL;
4242 1.8 christos symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4243 1.8 christos
4244 1.1 christos for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4245 1.8 christos if (sec->has_pltcall
4246 1.8 christos && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
4247 1.8 christos {
4248 1.8 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
4249 1.8 christos
4250 1.8 christos /* Read the relocations. */
4251 1.8 christos relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
4252 1.8 christos info->keep_memory);
4253 1.8 christos if (relstart == NULL)
4254 1.8 christos return FALSE;
4255 1.8 christos
4256 1.8 christos relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
4257 1.8 christos for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; )
4258 1.8 christos {
4259 1.8 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
4260 1.8 christos unsigned long r_symndx;
4261 1.8 christos asection *sym_sec;
4262 1.8 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4263 1.8 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
4264 1.8 christos unsigned char *tls_maskp;
4265 1.9 christos
4266 1.8 christos r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4267 1.8 christos if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTCALL)
4268 1.8 christos continue;
4269 1.1 christos
4270 1.8 christos r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4271 1.8 christos if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, &tls_maskp, &local_syms,
4272 1.8 christos r_symndx, ibfd))
4273 1.8 christos {
4274 1.8 christos if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4275 1.8 christos free (relstart);
4276 1.8 christos if (symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
4277 1.8 christos free (local_syms);
4278 1.8 christos return FALSE;
4279 1.8 christos }
4280 1.8 christos
4281 1.8 christos if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
4282 1.8 christos {
4283 1.8 christos bfd_vma from, to;
4284 1.8 christos if (h != NULL)
4285 1.8 christos to = h->root.u.def.value;
4286 1.8 christos else
4287 1.8 christos to = sym->st_value;
4288 1.8 christos to += (rel->r_addend
4289 1.8 christos + sym_sec->output_offset
4290 1.1 christos + sym_sec->output_section->vma);
4291 1.8 christos from = (rel->r_offset
4292 1.8 christos + sec->output_offset
4293 1.8 christos + sec->output_section->vma);
4294 1.8 christos if (to - from + limit < 2 * limit)
4295 1.8 christos *tls_maskp &= ~PLT_KEEP;
4296 1.8 christos }
4297 1.8 christos }
4298 1.1 christos if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4299 1.1 christos free (relstart);
4300 1.8 christos }
4301 1.1 christos
4302 1.1 christos if (local_syms != NULL
4303 1.8 christos && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
4304 1.1 christos {
4305 1.1 christos if (!info->keep_memory)
4306 1.1 christos free (local_syms);
4307 1.1 christos else
4308 1.3 christos symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
4309 1.1 christos }
4310 1.1 christos }
4311 1.1 christos
4312 1.1 christos return TRUE;
4313 1.1 christos }
4314 1.1 christos
4315 1.5 christos /* Set plt output section type, htab->tls_get_addr, and call the
4316 1.5 christos generic ELF tls_setup function. */
4317 1.5 christos
4318 1.3 christos asection *
4319 1.1 christos ppc_elf_tls_setup (bfd *obfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4320 1.1 christos {
4321 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4322 1.1 christos
4323 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4324 1.1 christos htab->tls_get_addr = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
4325 1.1 christos FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
4326 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
4327 1.1 christos htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = TRUE;
4328 1.1 christos
4329 1.1 christos if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
4330 1.1 christos {
4331 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *opt, *tga;
4332 1.1 christos opt = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr_opt",
4333 1.1 christos FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
4334 1.1 christos if (opt != NULL
4335 1.1 christos && (opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4336 1.1 christos || opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
4337 1.8 christos {
4338 1.1 christos /* If glibc supports an optimized __tls_get_addr call stub,
4339 1.1 christos signalled by the presence of __tls_get_addr_opt, and we'll
4340 1.1 christos be calling __tls_get_addr via a plt call stub, then
4341 1.1 christos make __tls_get_addr point to __tls_get_addr_opt. */
4342 1.1 christos tga = htab->tls_get_addr;
4343 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
4344 1.1 christos && tga != NULL
4345 1.1 christos && (tga->type == STT_FUNC
4346 1.1 christos || tga->needs_plt)
4347 1.1 christos && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, tga)
4348 1.7 christos || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, tga)))
4349 1.1 christos {
4350 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
4351 1.1 christos for (ent = tga->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4352 1.1 christos if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4353 1.1 christos break;
4354 1.1 christos if (ent != NULL)
4355 1.1 christos {
4356 1.1 christos tga->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
4357 1.1 christos tga->root.u.i.link = &opt->root;
4358 1.1 christos ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt, tga);
4359 1.1 christos opt->mark = 1;
4360 1.1 christos if (opt->dynindx != -1)
4361 1.1 christos {
4362 1.1 christos /* Use __tls_get_addr_opt in dynamic relocations. */
4363 1.3 christos opt->dynindx = -1;
4364 1.1 christos _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
4365 1.1 christos opt->dynstr_index);
4366 1.7 christos if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, opt))
4367 1.7 christos return FALSE;
4368 1.1 christos }
4369 1.7 christos htab->tls_get_addr = opt;
4370 1.7 christos }
4371 1.1 christos }
4372 1.1 christos }
4373 1.1 christos else
4374 1.1 christos htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = TRUE;
4375 1.1 christos }
4376 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
4377 1.1 christos && htab->elf.splt != NULL
4378 1.1 christos && htab->elf.splt->output_section != NULL)
4379 1.1 christos {
4380 1.1 christos elf_section_type (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHT_PROGBITS;
4381 1.1 christos elf_section_flags (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE;
4382 1.1 christos }
4383 1.1 christos
4384 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_tls_setup (obfd, info);
4385 1.1 christos }
4386 1.1 christos
4387 1.1 christos /* Return TRUE iff REL is a branch reloc with a global symbol matching
4388 1.1 christos HASH. */
4389 1.1 christos
4390 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
4391 1.1 christos branch_reloc_hash_match (const bfd *ibfd,
4392 1.1 christos const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4393 1.1 christos const struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash)
4394 1.1 christos {
4395 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4396 1.1 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4397 1.1 christos unsigned int r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4398 1.1 christos
4399 1.1 christos if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
4400 1.1 christos {
4401 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4402 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4403 1.1 christos
4404 1.1 christos h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4405 1.1 christos while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4406 1.1 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4407 1.1 christos h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4408 1.1 christos if (h == hash)
4409 1.1 christos return TRUE;
4410 1.1 christos }
4411 1.1 christos return FALSE;
4412 1.1 christos }
4413 1.1 christos
4414 1.1 christos /* Run through all the TLS relocs looking for optimization
4415 1.6 christos opportunities. */
4416 1.1 christos
4417 1.1 christos bfd_boolean
4418 1.1 christos ppc_elf_tls_optimize (bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4419 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info)
4420 1.1 christos {
4421 1.1 christos bfd *ibfd;
4422 1.9 christos asection *sec;
4423 1.9 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4424 1.1 christos int pass;
4425 1.1 christos
4426 1.1 christos if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
4427 1.1 christos return TRUE;
4428 1.1 christos
4429 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4430 1.1 christos if (htab == NULL)
4431 1.3 christos return FALSE;
4432 1.1 christos
4433 1.1 christos htab->do_tls_opt = 1;
4434 1.1 christos
4435 1.1 christos /* Make two passes through the relocs. First time check that tls
4436 1.1 christos relocs involved in setting up a tls_get_addr call are indeed
4437 1.1 christos followed by such a call. If they are not, don't do any tls
4438 1.1 christos optimization. On the second pass twiddle tls_mask flags to
4439 1.1 christos notify relocate_section that optimization can be done, and
4440 1.1 christos adjust got and plt refcounts. */
4441 1.1 christos for (pass = 0; pass < 2; ++pass)
4442 1.1 christos for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4443 1.1 christos {
4444 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4445 1.1 christos asection *got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".got2");
4446 1.1 christos
4447 1.1 christos for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4448 1.1 christos if (sec->has_tls_reloc && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
4449 1.1 christos {
4450 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
4451 1.1 christos int expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
4452 1.1 christos
4453 1.1 christos /* Read the relocations. */
4454 1.8 christos relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
4455 1.8 christos info->keep_memory);
4456 1.1 christos if (relstart == NULL)
4457 1.1 christos return FALSE;
4458 1.1 christos
4459 1.1 christos relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
4460 1.1 christos for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++)
4461 1.1 christos {
4462 1.1 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
4463 1.1 christos unsigned long r_symndx;
4464 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
4465 1.1 christos unsigned char *tls_mask;
4466 1.1 christos unsigned char tls_set, tls_clear;
4467 1.1 christos bfd_boolean is_local;
4468 1.1 christos bfd_signed_vma *got_count;
4469 1.1 christos
4470 1.1 christos r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4471 1.9 christos if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4472 1.1 christos {
4473 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4474 1.1 christos
4475 1.1 christos sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4476 1.1 christos h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4477 1.1 christos while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4478 1.1 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4479 1.1 christos h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4480 1.9 christos }
4481 1.1 christos
4482 1.1 christos is_local = SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h);
4483 1.1 christos r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4484 1.1 christos /* If this section has old-style __tls_get_addr calls
4485 1.1 christos without marker relocs, then check that each
4486 1.1 christos __tls_get_addr call reloc is preceded by a reloc
4487 1.1 christos that conceivably belongs to the __tls_get_addr arg
4488 1.1 christos setup insn. If we don't find matching arg setup
4489 1.1 christos relocs, don't do any tls optimization. */
4490 1.1 christos if (pass == 0
4491 1.1 christos && sec->nomark_tls_get_addr
4492 1.1 christos && h != NULL
4493 1.1 christos && h == htab->tls_get_addr
4494 1.1 christos && !expecting_tls_get_addr
4495 1.1 christos && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
4496 1.1 christos {
4497 1.1 christos info->callbacks->minfo ("%H __tls_get_addr lost arg, "
4498 1.1 christos "TLS optimization disabled\n",
4499 1.1 christos ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
4500 1.7 christos if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4501 1.1 christos free (relstart);
4502 1.1 christos return TRUE;
4503 1.1 christos }
4504 1.1 christos
4505 1.1 christos expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
4506 1.1 christos switch (r_type)
4507 1.1 christos {
4508 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
4509 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
4510 1.1 christos expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
4511 1.1 christos /* Fall through. */
4512 1.1 christos
4513 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
4514 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
4515 1.1 christos /* These relocs should never be against a symbol
4516 1.1 christos defined in a shared lib. Leave them alone if
4517 1.1 christos that turns out to be the case. */
4518 1.7 christos if (!is_local)
4519 1.1 christos continue;
4520 1.1 christos
4521 1.1 christos /* LD -> LE */
4522 1.1 christos tls_set = 0;
4523 1.1 christos tls_clear = TLS_LD;
4524 1.1 christos break;
4525 1.1 christos
4526 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
4527 1.9 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
4528 1.1 christos expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
4529 1.1 christos /* Fall through. */
4530 1.1 christos
4531 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
4532 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
4533 1.1 christos if (is_local)
4534 1.1 christos /* GD -> LE */
4535 1.1 christos tls_set = 0;
4536 1.1 christos else
4537 1.1 christos /* GD -> IE */
4538 1.1 christos tls_set = TLS_TLS | TLS_GDIE;
4539 1.1 christos tls_clear = TLS_GD;
4540 1.1 christos break;
4541 1.1 christos
4542 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
4543 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
4544 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
4545 1.9 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
4546 1.9 christos if (is_local)
4547 1.9 christos {
4548 1.9 christos /* IE -> LE */
4549 1.1 christos tls_set = 0;
4550 1.8 christos tls_clear = TLS_TPREL;
4551 1.8 christos break;
4552 1.8 christos }
4553 1.8 christos else
4554 1.8 christos continue;
4555 1.8 christos
4556 1.8 christos case R_PPC_TLSLD:
4557 1.8 christos if (!is_local)
4558 1.8 christos continue;
4559 1.8 christos /* Fall through. */
4560 1.8 christos case R_PPC_TLSGD:
4561 1.8 christos if (rel + 1 < relend
4562 1.8 christos && is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
4563 1.8 christos {
4564 1.8 christos if (pass != 0
4565 1.8 christos && ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) != R_PPC_PLTSEQ)
4566 1.8 christos {
4567 1.8 christos r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info);
4568 1.8 christos r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel[1].r_info);
4569 1.8 christos if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4570 1.8 christos {
4571 1.8 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4572 1.8 christos
4573 1.8 christos sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4574 1.8 christos h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4575 1.8 christos while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4576 1.8 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4577 1.8 christos h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4578 1.8 christos if (h != NULL)
4579 1.8 christos {
4580 1.8 christos struct plt_entry *ent = NULL;
4581 1.8 christos bfd_vma addend = 0;
4582 1.8 christos
4583 1.8 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4584 1.1 christos addend = rel->r_addend;
4585 1.1 christos ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist,
4586 1.1 christos got2, addend);
4587 1.1 christos if (ent != NULL
4588 1.1 christos && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4589 1.9 christos ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
4590 1.9 christos }
4591 1.9 christos }
4592 1.9 christos }
4593 1.9 christos continue;
4594 1.9 christos }
4595 1.9 christos expecting_tls_get_addr = 2;
4596 1.9 christos tls_set = 0;
4597 1.9 christos tls_clear = 0;
4598 1.9 christos break;
4599 1.9 christos
4600 1.9 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
4601 1.9 christos if (pass == 0)
4602 1.9 christos {
4603 1.9 christos unsigned char buf[4];
4604 1.9 christos unsigned int insn;
4605 1.9 christos bfd_vma off = rel->r_offset & ~3;
4606 1.9 christos if (!bfd_get_section_contents (ibfd, sec, buf,
4607 1.9 christos off, 4))
4608 1.9 christos {
4609 1.9 christos if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4610 1.9 christos free (relstart);
4611 1.9 christos return FALSE;
4612 1.9 christos }
4613 1.9 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buf);
4614 1.9 christos /* addis rt,2,imm */
4615 1.9 christos if ((insn & ((0x3fu << 26) | 0x1f << 16))
4616 1.9 christos != ((15u << 26) | (2 << 16)))
4617 1.9 christos {
4618 1.9 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
4619 1.9 christos info->callbacks->minfo
4620 1.1 christos (_("%H: warning: %s unexpected insn %#x.\n"),
4621 1.1 christos ibfd, sec, off, "R_PPC_TPREL16_HA", insn);
4622 1.1 christos htab->do_tls_opt = 0;
4623 1.1 christos }
4624 1.1 christos }
4625 1.1 christos continue;
4626 1.1 christos
4627 1.9 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
4628 1.1 christos htab->do_tls_opt = 0;
4629 1.1 christos continue;
4630 1.1 christos
4631 1.1 christos default:
4632 1.1 christos continue;
4633 1.1 christos }
4634 1.1 christos
4635 1.1 christos if (pass == 0)
4636 1.1 christos {
4637 1.1 christos if (!expecting_tls_get_addr
4638 1.1 christos || !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr)
4639 1.1 christos continue;
4640 1.1 christos
4641 1.1 christos if (rel + 1 < relend
4642 1.1 christos && branch_reloc_hash_match (ibfd, rel + 1,
4643 1.1 christos htab->tls_get_addr))
4644 1.1 christos continue;
4645 1.1 christos
4646 1.1 christos /* Uh oh, we didn't find the expected call. We
4647 1.1 christos could just mark this symbol to exclude it
4648 1.1 christos from tls optimization but it's safer to skip
4649 1.1 christos the entire optimization. */
4650 1.1 christos info->callbacks->minfo (_("%H arg lost __tls_get_addr, "
4651 1.1 christos "TLS optimization disabled\n"),
4652 1.1 christos ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
4653 1.1 christos if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4654 1.1 christos free (relstart);
4655 1.1 christos return TRUE;
4656 1.8 christos }
4657 1.1 christos
4658 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
4659 1.1 christos {
4660 1.1 christos tls_mask = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
4661 1.1 christos got_count = &h->got.refcount;
4662 1.1 christos }
4663 1.8 christos else
4664 1.8 christos {
4665 1.1 christos bfd_signed_vma *lgot_refs;
4666 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt;
4667 1.1 christos unsigned char *lgot_masks;
4668 1.1 christos
4669 1.8 christos lgot_refs = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
4670 1.8 christos if (lgot_refs == NULL)
4671 1.8 christos abort ();
4672 1.8 christos local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
4673 1.8 christos (lgot_refs + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4674 1.8 christos lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
4675 1.8 christos (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4676 1.8 christos tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
4677 1.9 christos got_count = &lgot_refs[r_symndx];
4678 1.8 christos }
4679 1.8 christos
4680 1.8 christos /* If we don't have old-style __tls_get_addr calls
4681 1.8 christos without TLSGD/TLSLD marker relocs, and we haven't
4682 1.9 christos found a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a
4683 1.8 christos marker for this symbol, then we either have a
4684 1.8 christos broken object file or an -mlongcall style
4685 1.8 christos indirect call to __tls_get_addr without a marker.
4686 1.8 christos Disable optimization in this case. */
4687 1.8 christos if ((tls_clear & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)) != 0
4688 1.8 christos && !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr
4689 1.8 christos && ((*tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
4690 1.8 christos != (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK)))
4691 1.8 christos continue;
4692 1.8 christos
4693 1.8 christos if (expecting_tls_get_addr == 1 + !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr)
4694 1.8 christos {
4695 1.8 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
4696 1.9 christos bfd_vma addend = 0;
4697 1.9 christos
4698 1.8 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)
4699 1.1 christos && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTREL24
4700 1.1 christos || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTCALL))
4701 1.1 christos addend = rel[1].r_addend;
4702 1.1 christos ent = find_plt_ent (&htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist,
4703 1.1 christos got2, addend);
4704 1.1 christos if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4705 1.1 christos ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
4706 1.1 christos }
4707 1.1 christos if (tls_clear == 0)
4708 1.1 christos continue;
4709 1.1 christos
4710 1.1 christos if (tls_set == 0)
4711 1.1 christos {
4712 1.1 christos /* We managed to get rid of a got entry. */
4713 1.1 christos if (*got_count > 0)
4714 1.1 christos *got_count -= 1;
4715 1.1 christos }
4716 1.1 christos
4717 1.8 christos *tls_mask |= tls_set;
4718 1.8 christos *tls_mask &= ~tls_clear;
4719 1.8 christos }
4720 1.8 christos
4721 1.8 christos if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4722 1.8 christos free (relstart);
4723 1.8 christos }
4724 1.8 christos }
4725 1.8 christos return TRUE;
4726 1.8 christos }
4727 1.9 christos
4728 1.1 christos /* Return true if we have dynamic relocs against H or any of its weak
4730 1.8 christos aliases, that apply to read-only sections. Cannot be used after
4731 1.8 christos size_dynamic_sections. */
4732 1.8 christos
4733 1.8 christos static bfd_boolean
4734 1.8 christos alias_readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4735 1.8 christos {
4736 1.8 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
4737 1.8 christos do
4738 1.8 christos {
4739 1.8 christos if (_bfd_elf_readonly_dynrelocs (&eh->elf))
4740 1.8 christos return TRUE;
4741 1.8 christos eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (eh->elf.u.alias);
4742 1.9 christos } while (eh != NULL && &eh->elf != h);
4743 1.8 christos
4744 1.8 christos return FALSE;
4745 1.1 christos }
4746 1.1 christos
4747 1.1 christos /* Return whether H has pc-relative dynamic relocs. */
4748 1.1 christos
4749 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
4750 1.1 christos pc_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4751 1.1 christos {
4752 1.1 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
4753 1.1 christos
4754 1.1 christos for (p = h->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
4755 1.1 christos if (p->pc_count != 0)
4756 1.1 christos return TRUE;
4757 1.1 christos return FALSE;
4758 1.1 christos }
4759 1.1 christos
4760 1.1 christos /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
4761 1.1 christos regular object. The current definition is in some section of the
4762 1.1 christos dynamic object, but we're not including those sections. We have to
4763 1.1 christos change the definition to something the rest of the link can
4764 1.1 christos understand. */
4765 1.1 christos
4766 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
4767 1.1 christos ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
4768 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4769 1.1 christos {
4770 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4771 1.8 christos asection *s;
4772 1.1 christos
4773 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
4774 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol called for %s\n",
4775 1.1 christos h->root.root.string);
4776 1.1 christos #endif
4777 1.1 christos
4778 1.1 christos /* Make sure we know what is going on here. */
4779 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4780 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL
4781 1.8 christos && (h->needs_plt
4782 1.8 christos || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4783 1.8 christos || h->is_weakalias
4784 1.8 christos || (h->def_dynamic
4785 1.8 christos && h->ref_regular
4786 1.9 christos && !h->def_regular)));
4787 1.8 christos
4788 1.1 christos /* Deal with function syms. */
4789 1.1 christos if (h->type == STT_FUNC
4790 1.1 christos || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4791 1.1 christos || h->needs_plt)
4792 1.1 christos {
4793 1.1 christos bfd_boolean local = (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
4794 1.1 christos || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h));
4795 1.1 christos /* Discard dyn_relocs when non-pic if we've decided that a
4796 1.8 christos function symbol is local. */
4797 1.8 christos if (!bfd_link_pic (info) && local)
4798 1.8 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4799 1.8 christos
4800 1.1 christos /* Clear procedure linkage table information for any symbol that
4801 1.1 christos won't need a .plt entry. */
4802 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
4803 1.1 christos for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4804 1.1 christos if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4805 1.1 christos break;
4806 1.1 christos if (ent == NULL
4807 1.1 christos || (h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC
4808 1.1 christos && local
4809 1.1 christos && (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
4810 1.1 christos || (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
4811 1.1 christos & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)))
4812 1.1 christos {
4813 1.3 christos /* A PLT entry is not required/allowed when:
4814 1.1 christos
4815 1.1 christos 1. We are not using ld.so; because then the PLT entry
4816 1.1 christos can't be set up, so we can't use one. In this case,
4817 1.3 christos ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol won't even be called.
4818 1.3 christos
4819 1.3 christos 2. GC has rendered the entry unused.
4820 1.7 christos
4821 1.7 christos 3. We know for certain that a call to this symbol
4822 1.7 christos will go to this object, or will remain undefined. */
4823 1.7 christos h->plt.plist = NULL;
4824 1.7 christos h->needs_plt = 0;
4825 1.7 christos h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
4826 1.7 christos }
4827 1.8 christos else
4828 1.8 christos {
4829 1.8 christos /* Taking a function's address in a read/write section
4830 1.9 christos doesn't require us to define the function symbol in the
4831 1.3 christos executable on a plt call stub. A dynamic reloc can
4832 1.9 christos be used instead, giving better runtime performance.
4833 1.3 christos (Calls via that function pointer don't need to bounce
4834 1.3 christos through the plt call stub.) Similarly, use a dynamic
4835 1.8 christos reloc for a weak reference when possible, allowing the
4836 1.8 christos resolution of the symbol to be set at load time rather
4837 1.8 christos than link time. */
4838 1.8 christos if ((h->pointer_equality_needed
4839 1.8 christos || (h->non_got_ref
4840 1.8 christos && !h->ref_regular_nonweak
4841 1.8 christos && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
4842 1.8 christos && htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks
4843 1.9 christos && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
4844 1.1 christos && !_bfd_elf_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
4845 1.5 christos {
4846 1.8 christos h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
4847 1.1 christos /* If we haven't seen a branch reloc and the symbol
4848 1.1 christos isn't an ifunc then we don't need a plt entry. */
4849 1.1 christos if (!h->needs_plt && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
4850 1.1 christos h->plt.plist = NULL;
4851 1.1 christos }
4852 1.1 christos else if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
4853 1.1 christos /* We are going to be defining the function symbol on the
4854 1.1 christos plt stub, so no dyn_relocs needed when non-pic. */
4855 1.8 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4856 1.1 christos }
4857 1.8 christos h->protected_def = 0;
4858 1.8 christos /* Function symbols can't have copy relocs. */
4859 1.8 christos return TRUE;
4860 1.8 christos }
4861 1.8 christos else
4862 1.8 christos h->plt.plist = NULL;
4863 1.8 christos
4864 1.9 christos /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
4865 1.1 christos processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
4866 1.1 christos real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */
4867 1.1 christos if (h->is_weakalias)
4868 1.1 christos {
4869 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *def = weakdef (h);
4870 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (def->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined);
4871 1.1 christos h->root.u.def.section = def->root.u.def.section;
4872 1.1 christos h->root.u.def.value = def->root.u.def.value;
4873 1.1 christos if (def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynbss
4874 1.1 christos || def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro
4875 1.6 christos || def->root.u.def.section == htab->dynsbss)
4876 1.5 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4877 1.5 christos return TRUE;
4878 1.5 christos }
4879 1.5 christos
4880 1.1 christos /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
4881 1.1 christos is not a function. */
4882 1.1 christos
4883 1.1 christos /* If we are creating a shared library, we must presume that the
4884 1.5 christos only references to the symbol are via the global offset table.
4885 1.5 christos For such cases we need not do anything here; the relocations will
4886 1.5 christos be handled correctly by relocate_section. */
4887 1.5 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4888 1.5 christos {
4889 1.5 christos h->protected_def = 0;
4890 1.5 christos return TRUE;
4891 1.5 christos }
4892 1.5 christos
4893 1.5 christos /* If there are no references to this symbol that do not use the
4894 1.5 christos GOT, we don't need to generate a copy reloc. */
4895 1.5 christos if (!h->non_got_ref)
4896 1.5 christos {
4897 1.5 christos h->protected_def = 0;
4898 1.5 christos return TRUE;
4899 1.5 christos }
4900 1.5 christos
4901 1.5 christos /* Protected variables do not work with .dynbss. The copy in
4902 1.5 christos .dynbss won't be used by the shared library with the protected
4903 1.5 christos definition for the variable. Editing to PIC, or text relocations
4904 1.5 christos are preferable to an incorrect program. */
4905 1.5 christos if (h->protected_def)
4906 1.8 christos {
4907 1.1 christos if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
4908 1.8 christos && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
4909 1.1 christos && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
4910 1.1 christos && htab->params->pic_fixup == 0
4911 1.1 christos && info->disable_target_specific_optimizations <= 1)
4912 1.1 christos htab->params->pic_fixup = 1;
4913 1.1 christos return TRUE;
4914 1.1 christos }
4915 1.1 christos
4916 1.9 christos /* If -z nocopyreloc was given, we won't generate them either. */
4917 1.1 christos if (info->nocopyreloc)
4918 1.8 christos return TRUE;
4919 1.8 christos
4920 1.1 christos /* If we don't find any dynamic relocs in read-only sections, then
4921 1.1 christos we'll be keeping the dynamic relocs and avoiding the copy reloc.
4922 1.1 christos We can't do this if there are any small data relocations. This
4923 1.1 christos doesn't work on VxWorks, where we can not have dynamic
4924 1.1 christos relocations (other than copy and jump slot relocations) in an
4925 1.1 christos executable. */
4926 1.1 christos if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
4927 1.1 christos && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
4928 1.1 christos && htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks
4929 1.1 christos && !h->def_regular
4930 1.1 christos && !alias_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
4931 1.1 christos return TRUE;
4932 1.1 christos
4933 1.1 christos /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
4934 1.1 christos become part of the .bss section of the executable. There will be
4935 1.7 christos an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section. The dynamic
4936 1.7 christos object will contain position independent code, so all references
4937 1.1 christos from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
4938 1.7 christos offset table. The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
4939 1.1 christos determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
4940 1.1 christos both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
4941 1.1 christos same memory location for the variable.
4942 1.1 christos
4943 1.1 christos Of course, if the symbol is referenced using SDAREL relocs, we
4944 1.1 christos must instead allocate it in .sbss. */
4945 1.8 christos if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
4946 1.8 christos s = htab->dynsbss;
4947 1.8 christos else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4948 1.1 christos s = htab->elf.sdynrelro;
4949 1.1 christos else
4950 1.7 christos s = htab->elf.sdynbss;
4951 1.7 christos BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
4952 1.1 christos
4953 1.7 christos if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0 && h->size != 0)
4954 1.1 christos {
4955 1.1 christos asection *srel;
4956 1.1 christos
4957 1.1 christos /* We must generate a R_PPC_COPY reloc to tell the dynamic
4958 1.1 christos linker to copy the initial value out of the dynamic object
4959 1.8 christos and into the runtime process image. */
4960 1.9 christos if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
4961 1.3 christos srel = htab->relsbss;
4962 1.1 christos else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4963 1.1 christos srel = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
4964 1.1 christos else
4965 1.1 christos srel = htab->elf.srelbss;
4966 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (srel != NULL);
4967 1.1 christos srel->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
4968 1.1 christos h->needs_copy = 1;
4969 1.1 christos }
4970 1.1 christos
4971 1.1 christos /* We no longer want dyn_relocs. */
4972 1.1 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4973 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (info, h, s);
4974 1.1 christos }
4975 1.1 christos
4976 1.1 christos /* Generate a symbol to mark plt call stubs. For non-PIC code the sym is
4978 1.1 christos xxxxxxxx.plt_call32.<callee> where xxxxxxxx is a hex number, usually 0,
4979 1.1 christos specifying the addend on the plt relocation. For -fpic code, the sym
4980 1.1 christos is xxxxxxxx.plt_pic32.<callee>, and for -fPIC
4981 1.6 christos xxxxxxxx.got2.plt_pic32.<callee>. */
4982 1.1 christos
4983 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
4984 1.1 christos add_stub_sym (struct plt_entry *ent,
4985 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4986 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info)
4987 1.1 christos {
4988 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
4989 1.1 christos size_t len1, len2, len3;
4990 1.1 christos char *name;
4991 1.1 christos const char *stub;
4992 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4993 1.1 christos
4994 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4995 1.1 christos stub = ".plt_pic32.";
4996 1.1 christos else
4997 1.1 christos stub = ".plt_call32.";
4998 1.1 christos
4999 1.1 christos len1 = strlen (h->root.root.string);
5000 1.1 christos len2 = strlen (stub);
5001 1.1 christos len3 = 0;
5002 1.1 christos if (ent->sec)
5003 1.1 christos len3 = strlen (ent->sec->name);
5004 1.1 christos name = bfd_malloc (len1 + len2 + len3 + 9);
5005 1.1 christos if (name == NULL)
5006 1.1 christos return FALSE;
5007 1.1 christos sprintf (name, "%08x", (unsigned) ent->addend & 0xffffffff);
5008 1.1 christos if (ent->sec)
5009 1.1 christos memcpy (name + 8, ent->sec->name, len3);
5010 1.1 christos memcpy (name + 8 + len3, stub, len2);
5011 1.1 christos memcpy (name + 8 + len3 + len2, h->root.root.string, len1 + 1);
5012 1.5 christos sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, name, TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
5013 1.1 christos if (sh == NULL)
5014 1.1 christos return FALSE;
5015 1.1 christos if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5016 1.1 christos {
5017 1.1 christos sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5018 1.1 christos sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5019 1.1 christos sh->root.u.def.value = ent->glink_offset;
5020 1.1 christos sh->ref_regular = 1;
5021 1.1 christos sh->def_regular = 1;
5022 1.1 christos sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5023 1.1 christos sh->forced_local = 1;
5024 1.1 christos sh->non_elf = 0;
5025 1.1 christos sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5026 1.1 christos }
5027 1.1 christos return TRUE;
5028 1.7 christos }
5029 1.7 christos
5030 1.1 christos /* Allocate NEED contiguous space in .got, and return the offset.
5031 1.1 christos Handles allocation of the got header when crossing 32k. */
5032 1.1 christos
5033 1.1 christos static bfd_vma
5034 1.1 christos allocate_got (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab, unsigned int need)
5035 1.1 christos {
5036 1.1 christos bfd_vma where;
5037 1.1 christos unsigned int max_before_header;
5038 1.1 christos
5039 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
5040 1.1 christos {
5041 1.7 christos where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5042 1.7 christos htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
5043 1.1 christos }
5044 1.7 christos else
5045 1.7 christos {
5046 1.1 christos max_before_header = htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW ? 32768 : 32764;
5047 1.7 christos if (need <= htab->got_gap)
5048 1.7 christos {
5049 1.1 christos where = max_before_header - htab->got_gap;
5050 1.1 christos htab->got_gap -= need;
5051 1.1 christos }
5052 1.1 christos else
5053 1.1 christos {
5054 1.8 christos if (htab->elf.sgot->size + need > max_before_header
5055 1.8 christos && htab->elf.sgot->size <= max_before_header)
5056 1.8 christos {
5057 1.8 christos htab->got_gap = max_before_header - htab->elf.sgot->size;
5058 1.8 christos htab->elf.sgot->size = max_before_header + htab->got_header_size;
5059 1.8 christos }
5060 1.8 christos where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5061 1.8 christos htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
5062 1.8 christos }
5063 1.8 christos }
5064 1.8 christos return where;
5065 1.8 christos }
5066 1.8 christos
5067 1.8 christos /* Calculate size of GOT entries for symbol given its TLS_MASK.
5068 1.9 christos TLS_LD is excluded because those go in a special GOT slot. */
5069 1.8 christos
5070 1.8 christos static inline unsigned int
5071 1.8 christos got_entries_needed (int tls_mask)
5072 1.8 christos {
5073 1.8 christos unsigned int need;
5074 1.8 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) == 0)
5075 1.8 christos need = 4;
5076 1.8 christos else
5077 1.7 christos {
5078 1.7 christos need = 0;
5079 1.8 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
5080 1.8 christos need += 8;
5081 1.7 christos if ((tls_mask & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
5082 1.7 christos need += 4;
5083 1.7 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
5084 1.7 christos need += 4;
5085 1.8 christos }
5086 1.8 christos return need;
5087 1.8 christos }
5088 1.7 christos
5089 1.7 christos /* If H is undefined, make it dynamic if that makes sense. */
5090 1.7 christos
5091 1.7 christos static bfd_boolean
5092 1.7 christos ensure_undef_dynamic (struct bfd_link_info *info,
5093 1.7 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5094 1.7 christos {
5095 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
5096 1.1 christos
5097 1.1 christos if (htab->dynamic_sections_created
5098 1.1 christos && ((info->dynamic_undefined_weak != 0
5099 1.1 christos && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
5100 1.1 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
5101 1.1 christos && h->dynindx == -1
5102 1.1 christos && !h->forced_local
5103 1.1 christos && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT)
5104 1.7 christos return bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h);
5105 1.1 christos return TRUE;
5106 1.1 christos }
5107 1.1 christos
5108 1.1 christos /* Allocate space in associated reloc sections for dynamic relocs. */
5109 1.1 christos
5110 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
5111 1.5 christos allocate_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
5112 1.5 christos {
5113 1.5 christos struct bfd_link_info *info = inf;
5114 1.5 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
5115 1.5 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5116 1.5 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
5117 1.5 christos bfd_boolean dyn;
5118 1.1 christos
5119 1.1 christos if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
5120 1.1 christos return TRUE;
5121 1.8 christos
5122 1.8 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
5123 1.7 christos eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
5124 1.1 christos if (eh->elf.got.refcount > 0
5125 1.1 christos || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
5126 1.8 christos && !eh->elf.def_regular
5127 1.1 christos && eh->elf.protected_def
5128 1.9 christos && eh->has_addr16_ha
5129 1.8 christos && eh->has_addr16_lo
5130 1.8 christos && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
5131 1.8 christos {
5132 1.8 christos unsigned int need;
5133 1.8 christos
5134 1.1 christos /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5135 1.1 christos if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, &eh->elf))
5136 1.8 christos return FALSE;
5137 1.1 christos
5138 1.1 christos need = 0;
5139 1.1 christos if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5140 1.1 christos {
5141 1.1 christos if (SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf))
5142 1.9 christos /* We'll just use htab->tlsld_got.offset. This should
5143 1.9 christos always be the case. It's a little odd if we have
5144 1.9 christos a local dynamic reloc against a non-local symbol. */
5145 1.9 christos htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
5146 1.7 christos else
5147 1.7 christos need += 8;
5148 1.7 christos }
5149 1.8 christos need += got_entries_needed (eh->tls_mask);
5150 1.1 christos if (need == 0)
5151 1.8 christos eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5152 1.9 christos else
5153 1.9 christos {
5154 1.9 christos eh->elf.got.offset = allocate_got (htab, need);
5155 1.8 christos if (((bfd_link_pic (info)
5156 1.8 christos && !((eh->tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
5157 1.1 christos && bfd_link_executable (info)
5158 1.7 christos && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf)))
5159 1.8 christos || (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5160 1.1 christos && eh->elf.dynindx != -1
5161 1.1 christos && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf)))
5162 1.1 christos && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, &eh->elf))
5163 1.1 christos {
5164 1.1 christos asection *rsec;
5165 1.1 christos
5166 1.8 christos need *= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4;
5167 1.8 christos if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5168 1.7 christos need -= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5169 1.7 christos rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
5170 1.9 christos if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5171 1.7 christos rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
5172 1.8 christos rsec->size += need;
5173 1.8 christos }
5174 1.8 christos }
5175 1.9 christos }
5176 1.8 christos else
5177 1.8 christos eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5178 1.8 christos
5179 1.8 christos /* If no dynamic sections we can't have dynamic relocs, except for
5180 1.9 christos IFUNCs which are handled even in static executables. */
5181 1.8 christos if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5182 1.9 christos && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5183 1.7 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5184 1.1 christos
5185 1.1 christos /* Discard relocs on undefined symbols that must be local. */
5186 1.1 christos else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
5187 1.1 christos && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT)
5188 1.1 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5189 1.1 christos
5190 1.7 christos /* Also discard relocs on undefined weak syms with non-default
5191 1.1 christos visibility, or when dynamic_undefined_weak says so. */
5192 1.1 christos else if (UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
5193 1.1 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5194 1.1 christos
5195 1.1 christos if (h->dyn_relocs == NULL)
5196 1.1 christos ;
5197 1.1 christos
5198 1.1 christos /* In the shared -Bsymbolic case, discard space allocated for
5199 1.1 christos dynamic pc-relative relocs against symbols which turn out to be
5200 1.1 christos defined in regular objects. For the normal shared case, discard
5201 1.1 christos space for relocs that have become local due to symbol visibility
5202 1.9 christos changes. */
5203 1.1 christos else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5204 1.1 christos {
5205 1.1 christos /* Relocs that use pc_count are those that appear on a call insn,
5206 1.1 christos or certain REL relocs (see must_be_dyn_reloc) that can be
5207 1.1 christos generated via assembly. We want calls to protected symbols to
5208 1.1 christos resolve directly to the function rather than going via the plt.
5209 1.1 christos If people want function pointer comparisons to work as expected
5210 1.1 christos then they should avoid writing weird assembly. */
5211 1.1 christos if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h))
5212 1.1 christos {
5213 1.9 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
5214 1.1 christos
5215 1.1 christos for (pp = &h->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
5216 1.1 christos {
5217 1.9 christos p->count -= p->pc_count;
5218 1.1 christos p->pc_count = 0;
5219 1.1 christos if (p->count == 0)
5220 1.1 christos *pp = p->next;
5221 1.1 christos else
5222 1.1 christos pp = &p->next;
5223 1.1 christos }
5224 1.1 christos }
5225 1.1 christos
5226 1.9 christos if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks)
5227 1.1 christos {
5228 1.8 christos struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
5229 1.8 christos
5230 1.7 christos for (pp = &h->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
5231 1.1 christos {
5232 1.1 christos if (strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name, ".tls_vars") == 0)
5233 1.1 christos *pp = p->next;
5234 1.1 christos else
5235 1.7 christos pp = &p->next;
5236 1.1 christos }
5237 1.1 christos }
5238 1.8 christos
5239 1.5 christos if (h->dyn_relocs != NULL)
5240 1.8 christos {
5241 1.5 christos /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5242 1.5 christos if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5243 1.5 christos return FALSE;
5244 1.5 christos }
5245 1.1 christos }
5246 1.8 christos else if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS)
5247 1.8 christos {
5248 1.7 christos /* For the non-pic case, discard space for relocs against
5249 1.1 christos symbols which turn out to need copy relocs or are not
5250 1.7 christos dynamic. */
5251 1.9 christos if (h->dynamic_adjusted
5252 1.1 christos && !h->def_regular
5253 1.7 christos && !ELF_COMMON_DEF_P (h)
5254 1.9 christos && !(h->protected_def
5255 1.1 christos && eh->has_addr16_ha
5256 1.1 christos && eh->has_addr16_lo
5257 1.7 christos && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
5258 1.9 christos {
5259 1.1 christos /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5260 1.1 christos if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5261 1.1 christos return FALSE;
5262 1.7 christos
5263 1.1 christos if (h->dynindx == -1)
5264 1.1 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5265 1.1 christos }
5266 1.8 christos else
5267 1.8 christos h->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5268 1.8 christos }
5269 1.8 christos
5270 1.8 christos /* Allocate space. */
5271 1.8 christos for (p = h->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
5272 1.7 christos {
5273 1.8 christos asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
5274 1.8 christos if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5275 1.8 christos sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
5276 1.8 christos sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5277 1.8 christos }
5278 1.8 christos
5279 1.8 christos /* Handle PLT relocs. Done last, after dynindx has settled.
5280 1.8 christos We might need a PLT entry when the symbol
5281 1.8 christos a) is dynamic, or
5282 1.7 christos b) is an ifunc, or
5283 1.7 christos c) has plt16 relocs and has been processed by adjust_dynamic_symbol, or
5284 1.7 christos d) has plt16 relocs and we are linking statically. */
5285 1.8 christos dyn = htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created && h->dynindx != -1;
5286 1.7 christos if (dyn
5287 1.7 christos || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
5288 1.7 christos || (h->needs_plt && h->dynamic_adjusted)
5289 1.7 christos || (h->needs_plt
5290 1.7 christos && h->def_regular
5291 1.7 christos && !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5292 1.7 christos && !htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
5293 1.8 christos && (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
5294 1.8 christos & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) == PLT_KEEP))
5295 1.8 christos {
5296 1.8 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
5297 1.8 christos bfd_boolean doneone = FALSE;
5298 1.8 christos bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5299 1.7 christos
5300 1.7 christos for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
5301 1.7 christos if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
5302 1.7 christos {
5303 1.7 christos asection *s = htab->elf.splt;
5304 1.7 christos
5305 1.7 christos if (!dyn)
5306 1.7 christos {
5307 1.7 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5308 1.7 christos s = htab->elf.iplt;
5309 1.8 christos else
5310 1.8 christos s = htab->pltlocal;
5311 1.8 christos }
5312 1.7 christos
5313 1.8 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW || !dyn)
5314 1.8 christos {
5315 1.8 christos if (!doneone)
5316 1.8 christos {
5317 1.8 christos plt_offset = s->size;
5318 1.8 christos s->size += 4;
5319 1.8 christos }
5320 1.8 christos ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5321 1.8 christos
5322 1.8 christos if (s == htab->pltlocal)
5323 1.8 christos ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5324 1.8 christos else
5325 1.8 christos {
5326 1.8 christos s = htab->glink;
5327 1.8 christos if (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info))
5328 1.8 christos {
5329 1.8 christos glink_offset = s->size;
5330 1.8 christos s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
5331 1.8 christos }
5332 1.7 christos if (!doneone
5333 1.7 christos && !bfd_link_pic (info)
5334 1.7 christos && h->def_dynamic
5335 1.7 christos && !h->def_regular)
5336 1.7 christos {
5337 1.7 christos h->root.u.def.section = s;
5338 1.7 christos h->root.u.def.value = glink_offset;
5339 1.7 christos }
5340 1.7 christos ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5341 1.7 christos
5342 1.7 christos if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms
5343 1.7 christos && !add_stub_sym (ent, h, info))
5344 1.7 christos return FALSE;
5345 1.7 christos }
5346 1.7 christos }
5347 1.7 christos else
5348 1.7 christos {
5349 1.7 christos if (!doneone)
5350 1.7 christos {
5351 1.7 christos /* If this is the first .plt entry, make room
5352 1.7 christos for the special first entry. */
5353 1.7 christos if (s->size == 0)
5354 1.7 christos s->size += htab->plt_initial_entry_size;
5355 1.7 christos
5356 1.7 christos /* The PowerPC PLT is actually composed of two
5357 1.7 christos parts, the first part is 2 words (for a load
5358 1.7 christos and a jump), and then there is a remaining
5359 1.7 christos word available at the end. */
5360 1.7 christos plt_offset = (htab->plt_initial_entry_size
5361 1.7 christos + (htab->plt_slot_size
5362 1.7 christos * ((s->size
5363 1.7 christos - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5364 1.7 christos / htab->plt_entry_size)));
5365 1.7 christos
5366 1.7 christos /* If this symbol is not defined in a regular
5367 1.7 christos file, and we are not generating a shared
5368 1.7 christos library, then set the symbol to this location
5369 1.7 christos in the .plt. This is to avoid text
5370 1.7 christos relocations, and is required to make
5371 1.7 christos function pointers compare as equal between
5372 1.7 christos the normal executable and the shared library. */
5373 1.7 christos if (! bfd_link_pic (info)
5374 1.7 christos && h->def_dynamic
5375 1.7 christos && !h->def_regular)
5376 1.7 christos {
5377 1.7 christos h->root.u.def.section = s;
5378 1.7 christos h->root.u.def.value = plt_offset;
5379 1.7 christos }
5380 1.7 christos
5381 1.7 christos /* Make room for this entry. */
5382 1.7 christos s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
5383 1.7 christos /* After the 8192nd entry, room for two entries
5384 1.7 christos is allocated. */
5385 1.8 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD
5386 1.8 christos && (s->size - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5387 1.8 christos / htab->plt_entry_size
5388 1.8 christos > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES)
5389 1.8 christos s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
5390 1.8 christos }
5391 1.8 christos ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5392 1.8 christos }
5393 1.8 christos
5394 1.8 christos /* We also need to make an entry in the .rela.plt section. */
5395 1.8 christos if (!doneone)
5396 1.8 christos {
5397 1.7 christos if (!dyn)
5398 1.7 christos {
5399 1.7 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5400 1.7 christos {
5401 1.7 christos s = htab->elf.irelplt;
5402 1.7 christos s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5403 1.7 christos }
5404 1.7 christos else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5405 1.7 christos {
5406 1.7 christos s = htab->relpltlocal;
5407 1.7 christos s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5408 1.7 christos }
5409 1.7 christos }
5410 1.7 christos else
5411 1.7 christos {
5412 1.7 christos htab->elf.srelplt->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5413 1.7 christos
5414 1.7 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
5415 1.7 christos {
5416 1.7 christos /* Allocate space for the unloaded relocations. */
5417 1.7 christos if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
5418 1.7 christos && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5419 1.7 christos {
5420 1.7 christos if (ent->plt.offset
5421 1.7 christos == (bfd_vma) htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5422 1.7 christos {
5423 1.7 christos htab->srelplt2->size
5424 1.7 christos += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
5425 1.7 christos * VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS);
5426 1.7 christos }
5427 1.7 christos
5428 1.7 christos htab->srelplt2->size
5429 1.7 christos += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
5430 1.7 christos * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS);
5431 1.7 christos }
5432 1.7 christos
5433 1.7 christos /* Every PLT entry has an associated GOT entry in
5434 1.7 christos .got.plt. */
5435 1.7 christos htab->elf.sgotplt->size += 4;
5436 1.7 christos }
5437 1.7 christos }
5438 1.7 christos doneone = TRUE;
5439 1.7 christos }
5440 1.7 christos }
5441 1.7 christos else
5442 1.7 christos ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5443 1.1 christos
5444 1.1 christos if (!doneone)
5445 1.1 christos {
5446 1.1 christos h->plt.plist = NULL;
5447 1.1 christos h->needs_plt = 0;
5448 1.1 christos }
5449 1.1 christos }
5450 1.1 christos else
5451 1.1 christos {
5452 1.1 christos h->plt.plist = NULL;
5453 1.1 christos h->needs_plt = 0;
5454 1.1 christos }
5455 1.1 christos
5456 1.1 christos return TRUE;
5457 1.1 christos }
5458 1.1 christos
5459 1.1 christos static const unsigned char glink_eh_frame_cie[] =
5460 1.1 christos {
5461 1.1 christos 0, 0, 0, 16, /* length. */
5462 1.1 christos 0, 0, 0, 0, /* id. */
5463 1.3 christos 1, /* CIE version. */
5464 1.1 christos 'z', 'R', 0, /* Augmentation string. */
5465 1.1 christos 4, /* Code alignment. */
5466 1.1 christos 0x7c, /* Data alignment. */
5467 1.1 christos 65, /* RA reg. */
5468 1.1 christos 1, /* Augmentation size. */
5469 1.1 christos DW_EH_PE_pcrel | DW_EH_PE_sdata4, /* FDE encoding. */
5470 1.1 christos DW_CFA_def_cfa, 1, 0 /* def_cfa: r1 offset 0. */
5471 1.1 christos };
5472 1.1 christos
5473 1.1 christos /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections. */
5474 1.1 christos
5475 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
5476 1.1 christos ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
5477 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info)
5478 1.1 christos {
5479 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5480 1.1 christos asection *s;
5481 1.6 christos bfd_boolean relocs;
5482 1.1 christos bfd *ibfd;
5483 1.1 christos
5484 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
5485 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections called\n");
5486 1.1 christos #endif
5487 1.1 christos
5488 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
5489 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL);
5490 1.1 christos
5491 1.1 christos if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
5492 1.1 christos {
5493 1.1 christos /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter. */
5494 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_executable (info) && !info->nointerp)
5495 1.1 christos {
5496 1.1 christos s = bfd_get_linker_section (htab->elf.dynobj, ".interp");
5497 1.3 christos BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
5498 1.1 christos s->size = sizeof ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
5499 1.1 christos s->contents = (unsigned char *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
5500 1.1 christos }
5501 1.1 christos }
5502 1.1 christos
5503 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
5504 1.1 christos htab->got_header_size = 16;
5505 1.1 christos else if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
5506 1.1 christos htab->got_header_size = 12;
5507 1.1 christos
5508 1.1 christos /* Set up .got offsets for local syms, and space for local dynamic
5509 1.1 christos relocs. */
5510 1.1 christos for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
5511 1.1 christos {
5512 1.1 christos bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
5513 1.1 christos bfd_signed_vma *end_local_got;
5514 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt;
5515 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **end_local_plt;
5516 1.1 christos char *lgot_masks;
5517 1.1 christos bfd_size_type locsymcount;
5518 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
5519 1.1 christos
5520 1.1 christos if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
5521 1.1 christos continue;
5522 1.1 christos
5523 1.1 christos for (s = ibfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5524 1.1 christos {
5525 1.1 christos struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
5526 1.1 christos
5527 1.9 christos for (p = ((struct ppc_dyn_relocs *)
5528 1.1 christos elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel);
5529 1.1 christos p != NULL;
5530 1.1 christos p = p->next)
5531 1.1 christos {
5532 1.1 christos if (!bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec)
5533 1.1 christos && bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec->output_section))
5534 1.1 christos {
5535 1.1 christos /* Input section has been discarded, either because
5536 1.1 christos it is a copy of a linkonce section or due to
5537 1.1 christos linker script /DISCARD/, so we'll be discarding
5538 1.7 christos the relocs too. */
5539 1.1 christos }
5540 1.1 christos else if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
5541 1.1 christos && strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name,
5542 1.1 christos ".tls_vars") == 0)
5543 1.8 christos {
5544 1.8 christos /* Relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections are
5545 1.8 christos handled specially by the loader. */
5546 1.8 christos }
5547 1.8 christos else if (p->count != 0)
5548 1.1 christos {
5549 1.1 christos asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
5550 1.1 christos if (p->ifunc)
5551 1.1 christos sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
5552 1.1 christos sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5553 1.1 christos if ((p->sec->output_section->flags
5554 1.1 christos & (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
5555 1.1 christos == (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
5556 1.1 christos {
5557 1.1 christos info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
5558 1.1 christos info->callbacks->minfo (_("%pB: dynamic relocation in read-only section `%pA'\n"),
5559 1.1 christos p->sec->owner, p->sec);
5560 1.1 christos }
5561 1.1 christos }
5562 1.1 christos }
5563 1.1 christos }
5564 1.1 christos
5565 1.1 christos local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
5566 1.8 christos if (!local_got)
5567 1.8 christos continue;
5568 1.8 christos
5569 1.8 christos symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
5570 1.1 christos locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
5571 1.1 christos end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
5572 1.1 christos local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
5573 1.1 christos end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
5574 1.1 christos lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
5575 1.9 christos
5576 1.9 christos for (; local_got < end_local_got; ++local_got, ++lgot_masks)
5577 1.9 christos if (*local_got > 0)
5578 1.1 christos {
5579 1.8 christos unsigned int need;
5580 1.8 christos if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5581 1.9 christos htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
5582 1.8 christos need = got_entries_needed (*lgot_masks);
5583 1.8 christos if (need == 0)
5584 1.7 christos *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
5585 1.8 christos else
5586 1.1 christos {
5587 1.1 christos *local_got = allocate_got (htab, need);
5588 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)
5589 1.1 christos && !((*lgot_masks & TLS_TLS) != 0
5590 1.1 christos && bfd_link_executable (info)))
5591 1.1 christos {
5592 1.9 christos asection *srel;
5593 1.1 christos
5594 1.1 christos need *= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4;
5595 1.1 christos srel = htab->elf.srelgot;
5596 1.8 christos if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5597 1.8 christos srel = htab->elf.irelplt;
5598 1.1 christos srel->size += need;
5599 1.1 christos }
5600 1.1 christos }
5601 1.8 christos }
5602 1.1 christos else
5603 1.1 christos *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
5604 1.1 christos
5605 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks)
5606 1.8 christos continue;
5607 1.8 christos
5608 1.8 christos /* Allocate space for calls to local STT_GNU_IFUNC syms in .iplt. */
5609 1.8 christos lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
5610 1.8 christos for (; local_plt < end_local_plt; ++local_plt, ++lgot_masks)
5611 1.8 christos {
5612 1.8 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
5613 1.8 christos bfd_boolean doneone = FALSE;
5614 1.8 christos bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5615 1.8 christos
5616 1.1 christos for (ent = *local_plt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
5617 1.1 christos if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
5618 1.1 christos {
5619 1.1 christos if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5620 1.1 christos s = htab->elf.iplt;
5621 1.1 christos else if (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
5622 1.1 christos || (*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)
5623 1.1 christos {
5624 1.8 christos ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5625 1.1 christos continue;
5626 1.8 christos }
5627 1.1 christos else
5628 1.8 christos s = htab->pltlocal;
5629 1.1 christos
5630 1.1 christos if (!doneone)
5631 1.1 christos {
5632 1.1 christos plt_offset = s->size;
5633 1.1 christos s->size += 4;
5634 1.8 christos }
5635 1.8 christos ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5636 1.8 christos
5637 1.8 christos if (s != htab->pltlocal && (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info)))
5638 1.8 christos {
5639 1.8 christos s = htab->glink;
5640 1.8 christos glink_offset = s->size;
5641 1.8 christos s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, NULL);
5642 1.8 christos }
5643 1.8 christos ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5644 1.1 christos
5645 1.1 christos if (!doneone)
5646 1.1 christos {
5647 1.1 christos if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5648 1.1 christos {
5649 1.1 christos s = htab->elf.irelplt;
5650 1.1 christos s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5651 1.1 christos }
5652 1.1 christos else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5653 1.1 christos {
5654 1.1 christos s = htab->relpltlocal;
5655 1.1 christos s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5656 1.1 christos }
5657 1.1 christos doneone = TRUE;
5658 1.9 christos }
5659 1.7 christos }
5660 1.1 christos else
5661 1.1 christos ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5662 1.1 christos }
5663 1.1 christos }
5664 1.7 christos
5665 1.1 christos /* Allocate space for global sym dynamic relocs. */
5666 1.1 christos elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), allocate_dynrelocs, info);
5667 1.1 christos
5668 1.1 christos if (htab->tlsld_got.refcount > 0)
5669 1.1 christos {
5670 1.1 christos htab->tlsld_got.offset = allocate_got (htab, 8);
5671 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_dll (info))
5672 1.7 christos htab->elf.srelgot->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5673 1.1 christos }
5674 1.7 christos else
5675 1.1 christos htab->tlsld_got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5676 1.1 christos
5677 1.7 christos if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL && htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS)
5678 1.1 christos {
5679 1.1 christos unsigned int g_o_t = 32768;
5680 1.1 christos
5681 1.1 christos /* If we haven't allocated the header, do so now. When we get here,
5682 1.6 christos for old plt/got the got size will be 0 to 32764 (not allocated),
5683 1.1 christos or 32780 to 65536 (header allocated). For new plt/got, the
5684 1.1 christos corresponding ranges are 0 to 32768 and 32780 to 65536. */
5685 1.3 christos if (htab->elf.sgot->size <= 32768)
5686 1.3 christos {
5687 1.3 christos g_o_t = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5688 1.3 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
5689 1.3 christos g_o_t += 4;
5690 1.3 christos htab->elf.sgot->size += htab->got_header_size;
5691 1.3 christos }
5692 1.3 christos
5693 1.3 christos htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value = g_o_t;
5694 1.3 christos }
5695 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5696 1.3 christos {
5697 1.3 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
5698 1.1 christos
5699 1.1 christos sda->root.u.def.section = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section;
5700 1.1 christos sda->root.u.def.value = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
5701 1.1 christos }
5702 1.1 christos if (info->emitrelocations)
5703 1.1 christos {
5704 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
5705 1.8 christos
5706 1.8 christos if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
5707 1.8 christos sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5708 1.1 christos sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
5709 1.3 christos if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
5710 1.3 christos sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5711 1.1 christos }
5712 1.1 christos
5713 1.3 christos if (htab->glink != NULL
5714 1.1 christos && htab->glink->size != 0
5715 1.1 christos && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5716 1.1 christos {
5717 1.1 christos htab->glink_pltresolve = htab->glink->size;
5718 1.1 christos /* Space for the branch table. */
5719 1.1 christos htab->glink->size
5720 1.1 christos += htab->elf.srelplt->size / (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4) - 4;
5721 1.1 christos /* Pad out to align the start of PLTresolve. */
5722 1.1 christos htab->glink->size += -htab->glink->size & (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
5723 1.1 christos ? 63 : 15);
5724 1.1 christos htab->glink->size += GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
5725 1.1 christos
5726 1.1 christos if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
5727 1.1 christos {
5728 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
5729 1.1 christos sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink",
5730 1.5 christos TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
5731 1.1 christos if (sh == NULL)
5732 1.1 christos return FALSE;
5733 1.1 christos if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5734 1.1 christos {
5735 1.1 christos sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5736 1.1 christos sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5737 1.1 christos sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink_pltresolve;
5738 1.1 christos sh->ref_regular = 1;
5739 1.1 christos sh->def_regular = 1;
5740 1.1 christos sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5741 1.1 christos sh->forced_local = 1;
5742 1.1 christos sh->non_elf = 0;
5743 1.1 christos sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5744 1.1 christos }
5745 1.1 christos sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink_PLTresolve",
5746 1.5 christos TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
5747 1.1 christos if (sh == NULL)
5748 1.1 christos return FALSE;
5749 1.1 christos if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5750 1.1 christos {
5751 1.1 christos sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5752 1.1 christos sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5753 1.1 christos sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
5754 1.1 christos sh->ref_regular = 1;
5755 1.1 christos sh->def_regular = 1;
5756 1.1 christos sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5757 1.1 christos sh->forced_local = 1;
5758 1.1 christos sh->non_elf = 0;
5759 1.6 christos sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5760 1.1 christos }
5761 1.1 christos }
5762 1.1 christos }
5763 1.1 christos
5764 1.1 christos if (htab->glink != NULL
5765 1.1 christos && htab->glink->size != 0
5766 1.1 christos && htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
5767 1.1 christos && !bfd_is_abs_section (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section)
5768 1.1 christos && _bfd_elf_eh_frame_present (info))
5769 1.1 christos {
5770 1.1 christos s = htab->glink_eh_frame;
5771 1.1 christos s->size = sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + 20;
5772 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5773 1.1 christos {
5774 1.1 christos s->size += 4;
5775 1.1 christos if (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8 >= 256)
5776 1.1 christos s->size += 4;
5777 1.7 christos }
5778 1.7 christos }
5779 1.1 christos
5780 1.1 christos /* We've now determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections.
5781 1.1 christos Allocate memory for them. */
5782 1.1 christos relocs = FALSE;
5783 1.1 christos for (s = htab->elf.dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5784 1.1 christos {
5785 1.1 christos bfd_boolean strip_section = TRUE;
5786 1.1 christos
5787 1.1 christos if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
5788 1.7 christos continue;
5789 1.8 christos
5790 1.1 christos if (s == htab->elf.splt
5791 1.1 christos || s == htab->elf.sgot)
5792 1.7 christos {
5793 1.1 christos /* We'd like to strip these sections if they aren't needed, but if
5794 1.7 christos we've exported dynamic symbols from them we must leave them.
5795 1.7 christos It's too late to tell BFD to get rid of the symbols. */
5796 1.3 christos if (htab->elf.hplt != NULL)
5797 1.3 christos strip_section = FALSE;
5798 1.3 christos /* Strip this section if we don't need it; see the
5799 1.3 christos comment below. */
5800 1.3 christos }
5801 1.1 christos else if (s == htab->elf.iplt
5802 1.1 christos || s == htab->pltlocal
5803 1.3 christos || s == htab->glink
5804 1.1 christos || s == htab->glink_eh_frame
5805 1.9 christos || s == htab->elf.sgotplt
5806 1.1 christos || s == htab->sbss
5807 1.1 christos || s == htab->elf.sdynbss
5808 1.1 christos || s == htab->elf.sdynrelro
5809 1.1 christos || s == htab->dynsbss)
5810 1.1 christos {
5811 1.1 christos /* Strip these too. */
5812 1.1 christos }
5813 1.1 christos else if (s == htab->sdata[0].section
5814 1.1 christos || s == htab->sdata[1].section)
5815 1.1 christos {
5816 1.1 christos strip_section = (s->flags & SEC_KEEP) == 0;
5817 1.1 christos }
5818 1.1 christos else if (CONST_STRNEQ (bfd_section_name (s), ".rela"))
5819 1.1 christos {
5820 1.1 christos if (s->size != 0)
5821 1.1 christos {
5822 1.1 christos /* Remember whether there are any relocation sections. */
5823 1.1 christos relocs = TRUE;
5824 1.1 christos
5825 1.1 christos /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
5826 1.1 christos to copy relocs into the output file. */
5827 1.1 christos s->reloc_count = 0;
5828 1.1 christos }
5829 1.1 christos }
5830 1.1 christos else
5831 1.1 christos {
5832 1.1 christos /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space. */
5833 1.1 christos continue;
5834 1.1 christos }
5835 1.1 christos
5836 1.1 christos if (s->size == 0 && strip_section)
5837 1.1 christos {
5838 1.1 christos /* If we don't need this section, strip it from the
5839 1.1 christos output file. This is mostly to handle .rela.bss and
5840 1.1 christos .rela.plt. We must create both sections in
5841 1.1 christos create_dynamic_sections, because they must be created
5842 1.1 christos before the linker maps input sections to output
5843 1.1 christos sections. The linker does that before
5844 1.1 christos adjust_dynamic_symbol is called, and it is that
5845 1.1 christos function which decides whether anything needs to go
5846 1.1 christos into these sections. */
5847 1.1 christos s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
5848 1.1 christos continue;
5849 1.1 christos }
5850 1.1 christos
5851 1.1 christos if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
5852 1.1 christos continue;
5853 1.1 christos
5854 1.1 christos /* Allocate memory for the section contents. */
5855 1.1 christos s->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->elf.dynobj, s->size);
5856 1.1 christos if (s->contents == NULL)
5857 1.9 christos return FALSE;
5858 1.9 christos }
5859 1.9 christos
5860 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5861 1.3 christos {
5862 1.3 christos /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section. We fill in the
5863 1.3 christos values later, in ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
5864 1.1 christos must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
5865 1.1 christos the .dynamic section. The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the
5866 1.1 christos dynamic linker and used by the debugger. */
5867 1.3 christos #define add_dynamic_entry(TAG, VAL) \
5868 1.1 christos _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, TAG, VAL)
5869 1.1 christos
5870 1.1 christos if (!_bfd_elf_maybe_vxworks_add_dynamic_tags (output_bfd, info,
5871 1.1 christos relocs))
5872 1.1 christos return FALSE;
5873 1.1 christos
5874 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
5875 1.1 christos && htab->glink != NULL
5876 1.1 christos && htab->glink->size != 0)
5877 1.1 christos {
5878 1.1 christos if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_GOT, 0))
5879 1.1 christos return FALSE;
5880 1.1 christos if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt
5881 1.1 christos && htab->tls_get_addr != NULL
5882 1.1 christos && htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist != NULL
5883 1.1 christos && !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_OPT, PPC_OPT_TLS))
5884 1.1 christos return FALSE;
5885 1.1 christos }
5886 1.1 christos }
5887 1.1 christos #undef add_dynamic_entry
5888 1.1 christos
5889 1.1 christos if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
5890 1.1 christos && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
5891 1.1 christos {
5892 1.1 christos unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
5893 1.1 christos bfd_vma val;
5894 1.1 christos
5895 1.1 christos memcpy (p, glink_eh_frame_cie, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie));
5896 1.1 christos /* CIE length (rewrite in case little-endian). */
5897 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) - 4, p);
5898 1.1 christos p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
5899 1.1 christos /* FDE length. */
5900 1.1 christos val = htab->glink_eh_frame->size - 4 - sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
5901 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
5902 1.6 christos p += 4;
5903 1.1 christos /* CIE pointer. */
5904 1.1 christos val = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
5905 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
5906 1.1 christos p += 4;
5907 1.1 christos /* Offset to .glink. Set later. */
5908 1.1 christos p += 4;
5909 1.1 christos /* .glink size. */
5910 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->glink->size, p);
5911 1.1 christos p += 4;
5912 1.1 christos /* Augmentation. */
5913 1.1 christos p += 1;
5914 1.1 christos
5915 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)
5916 1.1 christos && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5917 1.1 christos {
5918 1.1 christos bfd_vma adv = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8) >> 2;
5919 1.1 christos if (adv < 64)
5920 1.1 christos *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + adv;
5921 1.1 christos else if (adv < 256)
5922 1.1 christos {
5923 1.1 christos *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc1;
5924 1.1 christos *p++ = adv;
5925 1.1 christos }
5926 1.1 christos else if (adv < 65536)
5927 1.1 christos {
5928 1.1 christos *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc2;
5929 1.1 christos bfd_put_16 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
5930 1.1 christos p += 2;
5931 1.1 christos }
5932 1.1 christos else
5933 1.1 christos {
5934 1.1 christos *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc4;
5935 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
5936 1.1 christos p += 4;
5937 1.1 christos }
5938 1.1 christos *p++ = DW_CFA_register;
5939 1.3 christos *p++ = 65;
5940 1.3 christos p++;
5941 1.3 christos *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 4;
5942 1.3 christos *p++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
5943 1.3 christos *p++ = 65;
5944 1.3 christos }
5945 1.3 christos BFD_ASSERT ((bfd_vma) ((p + 3 - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents) & -4)
5946 1.3 christos == htab->glink_eh_frame->size);
5947 1.3 christos }
5948 1.3 christos
5949 1.3 christos return TRUE;
5950 1.3 christos }
5951 1.3 christos
5952 1.3 christos /* Arrange to have _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_ stripped from the output
5953 1.3 christos if it looks like nothing is using them. */
5954 1.3 christos
5955 1.3 christos static void
5956 1.3 christos maybe_strip_sdasym (bfd *output_bfd, elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
5957 1.3 christos {
5958 1.3 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = lsect->sym;
5959 1.3 christos
5960 1.3 christos if (sda != NULL && !sda->ref_regular && sda->dynindx == -1)
5961 1.3 christos {
5962 1.3 christos asection *s;
5963 1.3 christos
5964 1.3 christos s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->name);
5965 1.3 christos if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
5966 1.3 christos {
5967 1.3 christos s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->bss_name);
5968 1.3 christos if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
5969 1.3 christos {
5970 1.3 christos sda->def_regular = 0;
5971 1.3 christos /* This is somewhat magic. See elf_link_output_extsym. */
5972 1.3 christos sda->ref_dynamic = 1;
5973 1.3 christos sda->forced_local = 0;
5974 1.3 christos }
5975 1.3 christos }
5976 1.3 christos }
5977 1.3 christos }
5978 1.3 christos
5979 1.1 christos void
5980 1.1 christos ppc_elf_maybe_strip_sdata_syms (struct bfd_link_info *info)
5981 1.1 christos {
5982 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
5983 1.1 christos
5984 1.1 christos if (htab != NULL)
5985 1.1 christos {
5986 1.1 christos maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[0]);
5987 1.1 christos maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[1]);
5988 1.1 christos }
5989 1.1 christos }
5990 1.1 christos
5991 1.1 christos
5992 1.1 christos /* Return TRUE if symbol should be hashed in the `.gnu.hash' section. */
5993 1.1 christos
5994 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
5995 1.1 christos ppc_elf_hash_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5996 1.1 christos {
5997 1.1 christos if (h->plt.plist != NULL
5998 1.1 christos && !h->def_regular
5999 1.1 christos && (!h->pointer_equality_needed
6000 1.1 christos || !h->ref_regular_nonweak))
6001 1.1 christos return FALSE;
6002 1.1 christos
6003 1.3 christos return _bfd_elf_hash_symbol (h);
6004 1.1 christos }
6005 1.1 christos
6006 1.1 christos #define ARRAY_SIZE(a) (sizeof (a) / sizeof ((a)[0]))
6008 1.1 christos
6009 1.1 christos /* Relaxation trampolines. r12 is available for clobbering (r11, is
6010 1.1 christos used for some functions that are allowed to break the ABI). */
6011 1.1 christos static const int shared_stub_entry[] =
6012 1.1 christos {
6013 1.1 christos 0x7c0802a6, /* mflr 0 */
6014 1.1 christos 0x429f0005, /* bcl 20, 31, .Lxxx */
6015 1.1 christos 0x7d8802a6, /* mflr 12 */
6016 1.1 christos 0x3d8c0000, /* addis 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@ha */
6017 1.3 christos 0x398c0000, /* addi 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@l */
6018 1.3 christos 0x7c0803a6, /* mtlr 0 */
6019 1.3 christos 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
6020 1.5 christos 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
6021 1.3 christos };
6022 1.3 christos
6023 1.3 christos static const int stub_entry[] =
6024 1.3 christos {
6025 1.3 christos 0x3d800000, /* lis 12,xxx@ha */
6026 1.3 christos 0x398c0000, /* addi 12,12,xxx@l */
6027 1.3 christos 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
6028 1.1 christos 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
6029 1.1 christos };
6030 1.1 christos
6031 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_relax_info
6032 1.1 christos {
6033 1.1 christos unsigned int workaround_size;
6034 1.5 christos unsigned int picfixup_size;
6035 1.1 christos };
6036 1.5 christos
6037 1.1 christos /* This function implements long branch trampolines, and the ppc476
6038 1.1 christos icache bug workaround. Any section needing trampolines or patch
6039 1.1 christos space for the workaround has its size extended so that we can
6040 1.1 christos add trampolines at the end of the section. */
6041 1.1 christos
6042 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
6043 1.1 christos ppc_elf_relax_section (bfd *abfd,
6044 1.1 christos asection *isec,
6045 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
6046 1.1 christos bfd_boolean *again)
6047 1.1 christos {
6048 1.3 christos struct one_branch_fixup
6049 1.5 christos {
6050 1.3 christos struct one_branch_fixup *next;
6051 1.1 christos asection *tsec;
6052 1.3 christos /* Final link, can use the symbol offset. For a
6053 1.1 christos relocatable link we use the symbol's index. */
6054 1.5 christos bfd_vma toff;
6055 1.1 christos bfd_vma trampoff;
6056 1.1 christos };
6057 1.1 christos
6058 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6059 1.1 christos bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
6060 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL;
6061 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs = NULL;
6062 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend = NULL;
6063 1.3 christos struct one_branch_fixup *branch_fixups = NULL;
6064 1.3 christos struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
6065 1.1 christos unsigned changes = 0;
6066 1.1 christos bfd_boolean workaround_change;
6067 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6068 1.1 christos bfd_size_type trampbase, trampoff, newsize, picfixup_size;
6069 1.1 christos asection *got2;
6070 1.6 christos bfd_boolean maybe_pasted;
6071 1.3 christos
6072 1.3 christos *again = FALSE;
6073 1.3 christos
6074 1.3 christos /* No need to do anything with non-alloc or non-code sections. */
6075 1.3 christos if ((isec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
6076 1.3 christos || (isec->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0
6077 1.3 christos || (isec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
6078 1.3 christos || isec->size < 4)
6079 1.3 christos return TRUE;
6080 1.3 christos
6081 1.3 christos /* We cannot represent the required PIC relocs in the output, so don't
6082 1.3 christos do anything. The linker doesn't support mixing -shared and -r
6083 1.3 christos anyway. */
6084 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6085 1.3 christos return TRUE;
6086 1.5 christos
6087 1.5 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (link_info);
6088 1.3 christos if (htab == NULL)
6089 1.3 christos return TRUE;
6090 1.3 christos
6091 1.3 christos isec->size = (isec->size + 3) & -4;
6092 1.3 christos if (isec->rawsize == 0)
6093 1.3 christos isec->rawsize = isec->size;
6094 1.3 christos trampbase = isec->size;
6095 1.3 christos
6096 1.3 christos BFD_ASSERT (isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_NONE
6097 1.3 christos || isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET);
6098 1.3 christos isec->sec_info_type = SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET;
6099 1.1 christos
6100 1.1 christos if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
6101 1.1 christos || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6102 1.1 christos {
6103 1.3 christos if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
6104 1.3 christos {
6105 1.1 christos elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info
6106 1.1 christos = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_relax_info));
6107 1.1 christos if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
6108 1.5 christos return FALSE;
6109 1.5 christos }
6110 1.5 christos relax_info = elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info;
6111 1.1 christos trampbase -= relax_info->workaround_size;
6112 1.3 christos }
6113 1.3 christos
6114 1.1 christos maybe_pasted = (strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
6115 1.3 christos || strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0);
6116 1.3 christos /* Space for a branch around any trampolines. */
6117 1.3 christos trampoff = trampbase;
6118 1.3 christos if (maybe_pasted && trampbase == isec->rawsize)
6119 1.3 christos trampoff += 4;
6120 1.1 christos
6121 1.3 christos symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
6122 1.1 christos picfixup_size = 0;
6123 1.3 christos if (htab->params->branch_trampolines
6124 1.3 christos || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6125 1.3 christos {
6126 1.3 christos /* Get a copy of the native relocations. */
6127 1.3 christos if (isec->reloc_count != 0)
6128 1.3 christos {
6129 1.5 christos internal_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, isec, NULL, NULL,
6130 1.3 christos link_info->keep_memory);
6131 1.5 christos if (internal_relocs == NULL)
6132 1.3 christos goto error_return;
6133 1.3 christos }
6134 1.3 christos
6135 1.8 christos got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
6136 1.3 christos
6137 1.3 christos irelend = internal_relocs + isec->reloc_count;
6138 1.3 christos for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
6139 1.3 christos {
6140 1.3 christos unsigned long r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
6141 1.3 christos bfd_vma toff, roff;
6142 1.3 christos asection *tsec;
6143 1.3 christos struct one_branch_fixup *f;
6144 1.8 christos size_t insn_offset = 0;
6145 1.3 christos bfd_vma max_branch_offset = 0, val;
6146 1.3 christos bfd_byte *hit_addr;
6147 1.1 christos unsigned long t0;
6148 1.3 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6149 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
6150 1.3 christos struct plt_entry **plist;
6151 1.3 christos unsigned char sym_type;
6152 1.3 christos
6153 1.1 christos switch (r_type)
6154 1.5 christos {
6155 1.5 christos case R_PPC_REL24:
6156 1.5 christos case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
6157 1.5 christos case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
6158 1.5 christos case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
6159 1.3 christos max_branch_offset = 1 << 25;
6160 1.3 christos break;
6161 1.1 christos
6162 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14:
6163 1.3 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
6164 1.8 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
6165 1.8 christos max_branch_offset = 1 << 15;
6166 1.8 christos break;
6167 1.8 christos
6168 1.8 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
6169 1.3 christos if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6170 1.8 christos break;
6171 1.8 christos continue;
6172 1.3 christos
6173 1.3 christos default:
6174 1.3 christos continue;
6175 1.8 christos }
6176 1.1 christos
6177 1.3 christos /* Get the value of the symbol referred to by the reloc. */
6178 1.3 christos if (!get_sym_h (&h, &isym, &tsec, NULL, &isymbuf,
6179 1.1 christos ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info), abfd))
6180 1.3 christos goto error_return;
6181 1.1 christos
6182 1.8 christos if (isym != NULL)
6183 1.8 christos {
6184 1.3 christos if (tsec != NULL)
6185 1.3 christos ;
6186 1.1 christos else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
6187 1.8 christos tsec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
6188 1.8 christos else
6189 1.8 christos continue;
6190 1.3 christos
6191 1.6 christos toff = isym->st_value;
6192 1.1 christos sym_type = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info);
6193 1.1 christos }
6194 1.3 christos else
6195 1.3 christos {
6196 1.3 christos if (tsec != NULL)
6197 1.3 christos toff = h->root.u.def.value;
6198 1.3 christos else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
6199 1.6 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6200 1.3 christos {
6201 1.3 christos unsigned long indx;
6202 1.1 christos
6203 1.3 christos indx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info) - symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6204 1.3 christos tsec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
6205 1.3 christos toff = bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) ? indx : 0;
6206 1.3 christos }
6207 1.3 christos else
6208 1.3 christos continue;
6209 1.3 christos
6210 1.3 christos /* If this branch is to __tls_get_addr then we may later
6211 1.3 christos optimise away the call. We won't be needing a long-
6212 1.3 christos branch stub in that case. */
6213 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_executable (link_info)
6214 1.3 christos && h == htab->tls_get_addr
6215 1.3 christos && irel != internal_relocs)
6216 1.3 christos {
6217 1.3 christos unsigned long t_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel[-1].r_info);
6218 1.3 christos unsigned long t_rtype = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel[-1].r_info);
6219 1.3 christos unsigned int tls_mask = 0;
6220 1.3 christos
6221 1.3 christos /* The previous reloc should be one of R_PPC_TLSGD or
6222 1.3 christos R_PPC_TLSLD, or for older object files, a reloc
6223 1.3 christos on the __tls_get_addr arg setup insn. Get tls
6224 1.3 christos mask bits from the symbol on that reloc. */
6225 1.3 christos if (t_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
6226 1.3 christos {
6227 1.3 christos bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
6228 1.1 christos
6229 1.3 christos if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
6230 1.3 christos {
6231 1.3 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6232 1.1 christos (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6233 1.3 christos char *lgot_masks = (char *)
6234 1.3 christos (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6235 1.3 christos tls_mask = lgot_masks[t_symndx];
6236 1.1 christos }
6237 1.3 christos }
6238 1.3 christos else
6239 1.3 christos {
6240 1.3 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *th
6241 1.3 christos = elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[t_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
6242 1.3 christos
6243 1.3 christos while (th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
6244 1.3 christos || th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
6245 1.3 christos th = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) th->root.u.i.link;
6246 1.3 christos
6247 1.3 christos tls_mask
6248 1.3 christos = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) th)->tls_mask;
6249 1.3 christos }
6250 1.1 christos
6251 1.3 christos /* The mask bits tell us if the call will be
6252 1.3 christos optimised away. */
6253 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
6254 1.5 christos && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSGD
6255 1.5 christos || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16
6256 1.5 christos || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO))
6257 1.5 christos continue;
6258 1.5 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
6259 1.5 christos && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSLD
6260 1.5 christos || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16
6261 1.5 christos || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO))
6262 1.5 christos continue;
6263 1.5 christos }
6264 1.5 christos
6265 1.3 christos sym_type = h->type;
6266 1.3 christos }
6267 1.3 christos
6268 1.3 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
6269 1.3 christos {
6270 1.3 christos if (h != NULL
6271 1.3 christos && !h->def_regular
6272 1.3 christos && h->protected_def
6273 1.3 christos && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
6274 1.3 christos && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo)
6275 1.3 christos picfixup_size += 12;
6276 1.3 christos continue;
6277 1.3 christos }
6278 1.3 christos
6279 1.3 christos /* The condition here under which we call find_plt_ent must
6280 1.3 christos match that in relocate_section. If we call find_plt_ent here
6281 1.3 christos but not in relocate_section, or vice versa, then the branch
6282 1.3 christos destination used here may be incorrect. */
6283 1.3 christos plist = NULL;
6284 1.3 christos if (h != NULL)
6285 1.3 christos {
6286 1.3 christos /* We know is_branch_reloc (r_type) is true. */
6287 1.3 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6288 1.3 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6289 1.1 christos plist = &h->plt.plist;
6290 1.6 christos }
6291 1.3 christos else if (sym_type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6292 1.3 christos && elf_local_got_offsets (abfd) != NULL)
6293 1.3 christos {
6294 1.3 christos bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
6295 1.3 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6296 1.3 christos (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6297 1.3 christos plist = local_plt + ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info);
6298 1.3 christos }
6299 1.3 christos if (plist != NULL)
6300 1.3 christos {
6301 1.3 christos bfd_vma addend = 0;
6302 1.3 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
6303 1.3 christos
6304 1.3 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24 && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6305 1.7 christos addend = irel->r_addend;
6306 1.3 christos ent = find_plt_ent (plist, got2, addend);
6307 1.3 christos if (ent != NULL)
6308 1.3 christos {
6309 1.3 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
6310 1.1 christos || h == NULL
6311 1.3 christos || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
6312 1.3 christos || h->dynindx == -1)
6313 1.3 christos {
6314 1.3 christos tsec = htab->glink;
6315 1.1 christos toff = ent->glink_offset;
6316 1.1 christos }
6317 1.8 christos else
6318 1.8 christos {
6319 1.8 christos tsec = htab->elf.splt;
6320 1.8 christos toff = ent->plt.offset;
6321 1.8 christos }
6322 1.8 christos }
6323 1.8 christos }
6324 1.8 christos
6325 1.8 christos /* If the branch and target are in the same section, you have
6326 1.8 christos no hope of adding stubs. We'll error out later should the
6327 1.8 christos branch overflow. */
6328 1.3 christos if (tsec == isec)
6329 1.3 christos continue;
6330 1.3 christos
6331 1.3 christos /* toff is used for the symbol index when the symbol is
6332 1.3 christos undefined and we're doing a relocatable link, so we can't
6333 1.3 christos support addends. It would be possible to do so by
6334 1.3 christos putting the addend in one_branch_fixup but addends on
6335 1.3 christos branches are rare so it hardly seems worth supporting. */
6336 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6337 1.3 christos && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr
6338 1.3 christos && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24
6339 1.3 christos && irel->r_addend != 0)
6340 1.3 christos continue;
6341 1.3 christos
6342 1.3 christos /* There probably isn't any reason to handle symbols in
6343 1.3 christos SEC_MERGE sections; SEC_MERGE doesn't seem a likely
6344 1.3 christos attribute for a code section, and we are only looking at
6345 1.3 christos branches. However, implement it correctly here as a
6346 1.3 christos reference for other target relax_section functions. */
6347 1.3 christos if (0 && tsec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
6348 1.3 christos {
6349 1.3 christos /* At this stage in linking, no SEC_MERGE symbol has been
6350 1.3 christos adjusted, so all references to such symbols need to be
6351 1.8 christos passed through _bfd_merged_section_offset. (Later, in
6352 1.8 christos relocate_section, all SEC_MERGE symbols *except* for
6353 1.3 christos section symbols have been adjusted.)
6354 1.3 christos
6355 1.3 christos gas may reduce relocations against symbols in SEC_MERGE
6356 1.3 christos sections to a relocation against the section symbol when
6357 1.3 christos the original addend was zero. When the reloc is against
6358 1.3 christos a section symbol we should include the addend in the
6359 1.1 christos offset passed to _bfd_merged_section_offset, since the
6360 1.8 christos location of interest is the original symbol. On the
6361 1.8 christos other hand, an access to "sym+addend" where "sym" is not
6362 1.3 christos a section symbol should not include the addend; Such an
6363 1.3 christos access is presumed to be an offset from "sym"; The
6364 1.3 christos location of interest is just "sym". */
6365 1.3 christos if (sym_type == STT_SECTION
6366 1.3 christos && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6367 1.1 christos toff += irel->r_addend;
6368 1.3 christos
6369 1.6 christos toff
6370 1.3 christos = _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, &tsec,
6371 1.3 christos elf_section_data (tsec)->sec_info,
6372 1.3 christos toff);
6373 1.3 christos
6374 1.1 christos if (sym_type != STT_SECTION
6375 1.1 christos && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6376 1.3 christos toff += irel->r_addend;
6377 1.3 christos }
6378 1.8 christos /* PLTREL24 addends are special. */
6379 1.8 christos else if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6380 1.8 christos toff += irel->r_addend;
6381 1.8 christos
6382 1.8 christos /* Attempted -shared link of non-pic code loses. */
6383 1.8 christos if ((!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6384 1.8 christos && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr)
6385 1.8 christos || tsec->output_section == NULL
6386 1.8 christos || (tsec->owner != NULL
6387 1.8 christos && (tsec->owner->flags & BFD_PLUGIN) != 0))
6388 1.3 christos continue;
6389 1.3 christos
6390 1.6 christos roff = irel->r_offset;
6391 1.3 christos
6392 1.3 christos /* Avoid creating a lot of unnecessary fixups when
6393 1.3 christos relocatable if the output section size is such that a
6394 1.3 christos fixup can be created at final link.
6395 1.3 christos The max_branch_offset adjustment allows for some number
6396 1.3 christos of other fixups being needed at final link. */
6397 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6398 1.3 christos && (isec->output_section->rawsize - (isec->output_offset + roff)
6399 1.3 christos < max_branch_offset - (max_branch_offset >> 4)))
6400 1.3 christos continue;
6401 1.3 christos
6402 1.1 christos /* If the branch is in range, no need to do anything. */
6403 1.3 christos if (tsec != bfd_und_section_ptr
6404 1.3 christos && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6405 1.5 christos /* A relocatable link may have sections moved during
6406 1.3 christos final link, so do not presume they remain in range. */
6407 1.3 christos || tsec->output_section == isec->output_section))
6408 1.3 christos {
6409 1.3 christos bfd_vma symaddr, reladdr;
6410 1.1 christos
6411 1.3 christos symaddr = tsec->output_section->vma + tsec->output_offset + toff;
6412 1.3 christos reladdr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset + roff;
6413 1.1 christos if (symaddr - reladdr + max_branch_offset
6414 1.3 christos < 2 * max_branch_offset)
6415 1.3 christos continue;
6416 1.3 christos }
6417 1.3 christos
6418 1.3 christos /* Look for an existing fixup to this address. */
6419 1.1 christos for (f = branch_fixups; f ; f = f->next)
6420 1.6 christos if (f->tsec == tsec && f->toff == toff)
6421 1.3 christos break;
6422 1.3 christos
6423 1.3 christos if (f == NULL)
6424 1.3 christos {
6425 1.3 christos size_t size;
6426 1.3 christos unsigned long stub_rtype;
6427 1.3 christos
6428 1.3 christos val = trampoff - roff;
6429 1.3 christos if (val >= max_branch_offset)
6430 1.3 christos /* Oh dear, we can't reach a trampoline. Don't try to add
6431 1.7 christos one. We'll report an error later. */
6432 1.3 christos continue;
6433 1.3 christos
6434 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6435 1.3 christos {
6436 1.3 christos size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry);
6437 1.3 christos insn_offset = 12;
6438 1.1 christos }
6439 1.3 christos else
6440 1.3 christos {
6441 1.3 christos size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
6442 1.3 christos insn_offset = 0;
6443 1.3 christos }
6444 1.3 christos stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX;
6445 1.3 christos if (tsec == htab->elf.splt
6446 1.3 christos || tsec == htab->glink)
6447 1.3 christos {
6448 1.3 christos stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLT;
6449 1.3 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6450 1.5 christos stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24;
6451 1.3 christos }
6452 1.3 christos
6453 1.3 christos /* Hijack the old relocation. Since we need two
6454 1.5 christos relocations for this use a "composite" reloc. */
6455 1.1 christos irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info),
6456 1.3 christos stub_rtype);
6457 1.3 christos irel->r_offset = trampoff + insn_offset;
6458 1.3 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
6459 1.1 christos && stub_rtype != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
6460 1.1 christos irel->r_addend = 0;
6461 1.3 christos
6462 1.3 christos /* Record the fixup so we don't do it again this section. */
6463 1.3 christos f = bfd_malloc (sizeof (*f));
6464 1.3 christos f->next = branch_fixups;
6465 1.3 christos f->tsec = tsec;
6466 1.3 christos f->toff = toff;
6467 1.3 christos f->trampoff = trampoff;
6468 1.3 christos branch_fixups = f;
6469 1.3 christos
6470 1.3 christos trampoff += size;
6471 1.3 christos changes++;
6472 1.3 christos }
6473 1.3 christos else
6474 1.3 christos {
6475 1.1 christos val = f->trampoff - roff;
6476 1.3 christos if (val >= max_branch_offset)
6477 1.1 christos continue;
6478 1.1 christos
6479 1.1 christos /* Nop out the reloc, since we're finalizing things here. */
6480 1.3 christos irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
6481 1.3 christos }
6482 1.3 christos
6483 1.3 christos /* Get the section contents. */
6484 1.3 christos if (contents == NULL)
6485 1.3 christos {
6486 1.3 christos /* Get cached copy if it exists. */
6487 1.3 christos if (elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
6488 1.3 christos contents = elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents;
6489 1.3 christos /* Go get them off disk. */
6490 1.3 christos else if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, isec, &contents))
6491 1.3 christos goto error_return;
6492 1.1 christos }
6493 1.3 christos
6494 1.3 christos /* Fix up the existing branch to hit the trampoline. */
6495 1.3 christos hit_addr = contents + roff;
6496 1.3 christos switch (r_type)
6497 1.3 christos {
6498 1.3 christos case R_PPC_REL24:
6499 1.3 christos case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
6500 1.3 christos case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
6501 1.3 christos t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
6502 1.1 christos t0 &= ~0x3fffffc;
6503 1.1 christos t0 |= val & 0x3fffffc;
6504 1.5 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
6505 1.1 christos break;
6506 1.5 christos
6507 1.5 christos case R_PPC_REL14:
6508 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
6509 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
6510 1.3 christos t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
6511 1.1 christos t0 &= ~0xfffc;
6512 1.3 christos t0 |= val & 0xfffc;
6513 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
6514 1.3 christos break;
6515 1.6 christos }
6516 1.3 christos }
6517 1.3 christos
6518 1.3 christos while (branch_fixups != NULL)
6519 1.3 christos {
6520 1.3 christos struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
6521 1.3 christos branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
6522 1.3 christos free (f);
6523 1.3 christos }
6524 1.3 christos }
6525 1.3 christos
6526 1.3 christos workaround_change = FALSE;
6527 1.3 christos newsize = trampoff;
6528 1.3 christos if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
6529 1.3 christos && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6530 1.3 christos || isec->output_section->alignment_power >= htab->params->pagesize_p2))
6531 1.3 christos {
6532 1.3 christos bfd_vma addr, end_addr;
6533 1.3 christos unsigned int crossings;
6534 1.3 christos bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
6535 1.3 christos
6536 1.3 christos addr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset;
6537 1.3 christos end_addr = addr + trampoff;
6538 1.3 christos addr &= -pagesize;
6539 1.3 christos crossings = ((end_addr & -pagesize) - addr) >> htab->params->pagesize_p2;
6540 1.1 christos if (crossings != 0)
6541 1.3 christos {
6542 1.3 christos /* Keep space aligned, to ensure the patch code itself does
6543 1.1 christos not cross a page. Don't decrease size calculated on a
6544 1.5 christos previous pass as otherwise we might never settle on a layout. */
6545 1.5 christos newsize = 15 - ((end_addr - 1) & 15);
6546 1.5 christos newsize += crossings * 16;
6547 1.5 christos if (relax_info->workaround_size < newsize)
6548 1.5 christos {
6549 1.5 christos relax_info->workaround_size = newsize;
6550 1.5 christos workaround_change = TRUE;
6551 1.5 christos }
6552 1.5 christos /* Ensure relocate_section is called. */
6553 1.3 christos isec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
6554 1.1 christos }
6555 1.1 christos newsize = trampoff + relax_info->workaround_size;
6556 1.1 christos }
6557 1.1 christos
6558 1.1 christos if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6559 1.1 christos {
6560 1.1 christos picfixup_size -= relax_info->picfixup_size;
6561 1.1 christos if (picfixup_size != 0)
6562 1.1 christos relax_info->picfixup_size += picfixup_size;
6563 1.1 christos newsize += relax_info->picfixup_size;
6564 1.1 christos }
6565 1.1 christos
6566 1.1 christos if (changes != 0 || picfixup_size != 0 || workaround_change)
6567 1.1 christos isec->size = newsize;
6568 1.1 christos
6569 1.1 christos if (isymbuf != NULL
6570 1.1 christos && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) isymbuf)
6571 1.1 christos {
6572 1.1 christos if (! link_info->keep_memory)
6573 1.1 christos free (isymbuf);
6574 1.1 christos else
6575 1.1 christos {
6576 1.1 christos /* Cache the symbols for elf_link_input_bfd. */
6577 1.1 christos symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) isymbuf;
6578 1.1 christos }
6579 1.5 christos }
6580 1.1 christos
6581 1.1 christos if (contents != NULL
6582 1.1 christos && elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6583 1.1 christos {
6584 1.1 christos if (!changes && !link_info->keep_memory)
6585 1.1 christos free (contents);
6586 1.1 christos else
6587 1.1 christos {
6588 1.1 christos /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd. */
6589 1.1 christos elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
6590 1.1 christos }
6591 1.1 christos }
6592 1.1 christos
6593 1.1 christos changes += picfixup_size;
6594 1.1 christos if (changes != 0)
6595 1.1 christos {
6596 1.1 christos /* Append sufficient NOP relocs so we can write out relocation
6597 1.1 christos information for the trampolines. */
6598 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
6599 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *new_relocs = bfd_malloc ((changes + isec->reloc_count)
6600 1.1 christos * sizeof (*new_relocs));
6601 1.1 christos unsigned ix;
6602 1.1 christos
6603 1.1 christos if (!new_relocs)
6604 1.1 christos goto error_return;
6605 1.1 christos memcpy (new_relocs, internal_relocs,
6606 1.9 christos isec->reloc_count * sizeof (*new_relocs));
6607 1.1 christos for (ix = changes; ix--;)
6608 1.1 christos {
6609 1.3 christos irel = new_relocs + ix + isec->reloc_count;
6610 1.1 christos
6611 1.1 christos irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
6612 1.1 christos }
6613 1.5 christos if (internal_relocs != elf_section_data (isec)->relocs)
6614 1.3 christos free (internal_relocs);
6615 1.5 christos elf_section_data (isec)->relocs = new_relocs;
6616 1.5 christos isec->reloc_count += changes;
6617 1.3 christos rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (isec);
6618 1.3 christos rel_hdr->sh_size += changes * rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
6619 1.9 christos }
6620 1.1 christos else if (elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
6621 1.9 christos free (internal_relocs);
6622 1.1 christos
6623 1.9 christos *again = changes != 0 || workaround_change;
6624 1.1 christos return TRUE;
6625 1.1 christos
6626 1.1 christos error_return:
6627 1.1 christos while (branch_fixups != NULL)
6628 1.1 christos {
6629 1.1 christos struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
6630 1.1 christos branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
6631 1.1 christos free (f);
6632 1.1 christos }
6633 1.1 christos if ((unsigned char *) isymbuf != symtab_hdr->contents)
6634 1.1 christos free (isymbuf);
6635 1.1 christos if (elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6636 1.1 christos free (contents);
6637 1.1 christos if (elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
6638 1.1 christos free (internal_relocs);
6639 1.1 christos return FALSE;
6640 1.1 christos }
6641 1.1 christos
6642 1.1 christos /* What to do when ld finds relocations against symbols defined in
6644 1.1 christos discarded sections. */
6645 1.1 christos
6646 1.1 christos static unsigned int
6647 1.1 christos ppc_elf_action_discarded (asection *sec)
6648 1.1 christos {
6649 1.1 christos if (strcmp (".fixup", sec->name) == 0)
6650 1.1 christos return 0;
6651 1.1 christos
6652 1.1 christos if (strcmp (".got2", sec->name) == 0)
6653 1.1 christos return 0;
6654 1.1 christos
6655 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_default_action_discarded (sec);
6656 1.1 christos }
6657 1.1 christos
6658 1.1 christos /* Fill in the address for a pointer generated in a linker section. */
6660 1.1 christos
6661 1.1 christos static bfd_vma
6662 1.1 christos elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (bfd *input_bfd,
6663 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
6664 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
6665 1.1 christos bfd_vma relocation,
6666 1.1 christos const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
6667 1.1 christos {
6668 1.1 christos elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
6669 1.1 christos
6670 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
6671 1.1 christos
6672 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
6673 1.1 christos {
6674 1.1 christos /* Handle global symbol. */
6675 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
6676 1.1 christos
6677 1.1 christos eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6678 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (eh->elf.def_regular);
6679 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr = eh->linker_section_pointer;
6680 1.1 christos }
6681 1.1 christos else
6682 1.1 christos {
6683 1.1 christos /* Handle local symbol. */
6684 1.1 christos unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
6685 1.1 christos
6686 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (input_bfd));
6687 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd) != NULL);
6688 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd)[r_symndx];
6689 1.1 christos }
6690 1.1 christos
6691 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr = elf_find_pointer_linker_section (linker_section_ptr,
6692 1.1 christos rel->r_addend,
6693 1.1 christos lsect);
6694 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (linker_section_ptr != NULL);
6695 1.1 christos
6696 1.1 christos /* Offset will always be a multiple of four, so use the bottom bit
6697 1.1 christos as a "written" flag. */
6698 1.1 christos if ((linker_section_ptr->offset & 1) == 0)
6699 1.1 christos {
6700 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (lsect->section->owner,
6701 1.1 christos relocation + linker_section_ptr->addend,
6702 1.1 christos lsect->section->contents + linker_section_ptr->offset);
6703 1.1 christos linker_section_ptr->offset += 1;
6704 1.1 christos }
6705 1.1 christos
6706 1.1 christos relocation = (lsect->section->output_section->vma
6707 1.1 christos + lsect->section->output_offset
6708 1.1 christos + linker_section_ptr->offset - 1
6709 1.8 christos - SYM_VAL (lsect->sym));
6710 1.8 christos
6711 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
6712 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr,
6713 1.1 christos "Finish pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld (0x%lx)\n",
6714 1.1 christos lsect->name, (long) relocation, (long) relocation);
6715 1.1 christos #endif
6716 1.8 christos
6717 1.8 christos return relocation;
6718 1.8 christos }
6719 1.8 christos
6720 1.8 christos #define PPC_LO(v) ((v) & 0xffff)
6721 1.8 christos #define PPC_HI(v) (((v) >> 16) & 0xffff)
6722 1.8 christos #define PPC_HA(v) PPC_HI ((v) + 0x8000)
6723 1.8 christos
6724 1.8 christos static void
6725 1.8 christos write_glink_stub (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, struct plt_entry *ent,
6726 1.8 christos asection *plt_sec, unsigned char *p,
6727 1.8 christos struct bfd_link_info *info)
6728 1.8 christos {
6729 1.8 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
6730 1.8 christos bfd *output_bfd = info->output_bfd;
6731 1.8 christos bfd_vma plt;
6732 1.8 christos unsigned char *end = p + GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
6733 1.8 christos
6734 1.8 christos if (h != NULL
6735 1.8 christos && h == htab->tls_get_addr
6736 1.8 christos && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
6737 1.8 christos {
6738 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_3, p);
6739 1.1 christos p += 4;
6740 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_3 + 4, p);
6741 1.1 christos p += 4;
6742 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_0_3, p);
6743 1.1 christos p += 4;
6744 1.6 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, CMPWI_11_0, p);
6745 1.1 christos p += 4;
6746 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_3_12_2, p);
6747 1.1 christos p += 4;
6748 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BEQLR, p);
6749 1.1 christos p += 4;
6750 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_3_0, p);
6751 1.1 christos p += 4;
6752 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
6753 1.1 christos p += 4;
6754 1.1 christos }
6755 1.1 christos
6756 1.1 christos plt = ((ent->plt.offset & ~1)
6757 1.1 christos + plt_sec->output_section->vma
6758 1.8 christos + plt_sec->output_offset);
6759 1.1 christos
6760 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
6761 1.1 christos {
6762 1.1 christos bfd_vma got = 0;
6763 1.1 christos
6764 1.1 christos if (ent->addend >= 32768)
6765 1.1 christos got = (ent->addend
6766 1.1 christos + ent->sec->output_section->vma
6767 1.1 christos + ent->sec->output_offset);
6768 1.1 christos else if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
6769 1.1 christos got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
6770 1.1 christos
6771 1.8 christos plt -= got;
6772 1.8 christos
6773 1.8 christos if (plt + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
6774 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_30 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6775 1.8 christos else
6776 1.8 christos {
6777 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_30 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
6778 1.8 christos p += 4;
6779 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6780 1.1 christos }
6781 1.1 christos }
6782 1.1 christos else
6783 1.1 christos {
6784 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_11 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
6785 1.1 christos p += 4;
6786 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6787 1.1 christos }
6788 1.1 christos p += 4;
6789 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_11, p);
6790 1.1 christos p += 4;
6791 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
6792 1.1 christos p += 4;
6793 1.1 christos while (p < end)
6794 1.1 christos {
6795 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
6796 1.1 christos p += 4;
6797 1.1 christos }
6798 1.1 christos }
6799 1.1 christos
6800 1.1 christos /* Return true if symbol is defined statically. */
6801 1.1 christos
6802 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
6803 1.1 christos is_static_defined (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6804 1.9 christos {
6805 1.1 christos return ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6806 1.1 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6807 1.1 christos && h->root.u.def.section != NULL
6808 1.1 christos && h->root.u.def.section->output_section != NULL);
6809 1.1 christos }
6810 1.1 christos
6811 1.1 christos /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tls operand, return
6812 1.1 christos the transformed insn for TLS optimisation, otherwise return 0. If
6813 1.1 christos REG is non-zero only match an insn with RB or RA equal to REG. */
6814 1.1 christos
6815 1.1 christos unsigned int
6816 1.1 christos _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
6817 1.1 christos {
6818 1.1 christos unsigned int rtra;
6819 1.1 christos
6820 1.1 christos if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) != 31 << 26)
6821 1.1 christos return 0;
6822 1.9 christos
6823 1.1 christos if (reg == 0 || ((insn >> 11) & 0x1f) == reg)
6824 1.1 christos rtra = insn & ((1 << 26) - (1 << 16));
6825 1.9 christos else if (((insn >> 16) & 0x1f) == reg)
6826 1.1 christos rtra = (insn & (0x1f << 21)) | ((insn & (0x1f << 11)) << 5);
6827 1.1 christos else
6828 1.9 christos return 0;
6829 1.1 christos
6830 1.1 christos if ((insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == 266 << 1)
6831 1.1 christos /* add -> addi. */
6832 1.1 christos insn = 14 << 26;
6833 1.1 christos else if ((insn & (0x1f << 1)) == 23 << 1
6834 1.1 christos && ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 14 << 6
6835 1.1 christos || ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) >= 16 << 6
6836 1.1 christos && (insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 24 << 6)))
6837 1.1 christos /* load and store indexed -> dform. */
6838 1.1 christos insn = (32u | ((insn >> 6) & 0x1f)) << 26;
6839 1.1 christos else if ((insn & (((0x1a << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 21 << 1)
6840 1.1 christos /* ldx, ldux, stdx, stdux -> ld, ldu, std, stdu. */
6841 1.1 christos insn = ((58u | ((insn >> 6) & 4)) << 26) | ((insn >> 6) & 1);
6842 1.1 christos else if ((insn & (((0x1f << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 341 << 1)
6843 1.9 christos /* lwax -> lwa. */
6844 1.9 christos insn = (58u << 26) | 2;
6845 1.9 christos else
6846 1.9 christos return 0;
6847 1.9 christos insn |= rtra;
6848 1.9 christos return insn;
6849 1.9 christos }
6850 1.9 christos
6851 1.9 christos /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tprel operand, return
6852 1.9 christos the transformed insn for an undefined weak symbol, ie. with the
6853 1.9 christos thread pointer REG operand removed. Otherwise return 0. */
6854 1.9 christos
6855 1.9 christos unsigned int
6856 1.9 christos _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
6857 1.9 christos {
6858 1.9 christos if ((insn & (0x1f << 16)) == reg << 16
6859 1.1 christos && ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
6860 1.9 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 15u << 26 /* addis */
6861 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
6862 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
6863 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
6864 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
6865 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
6866 1.9 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
6867 1.9 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
6868 1.9 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
6869 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
6870 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
6871 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
6872 1.9 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
6873 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
6874 1.1 christos || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
6875 1.1 christos && (insn & 3) != 1)
6876 1.1 christos || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
6877 1.1 christos && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3))))
6878 1.1 christos {
6879 1.1 christos insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
6880 1.1 christos }
6881 1.1 christos else if ((insn & (0x1f << 21)) == reg << 21
6882 1.1 christos && ((insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori, oris */
6883 1.9 christos || (insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori,xoris */
6884 1.9 christos || (insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi,andis */))
6885 1.9 christos {
6886 1.9 christos insn &= ~(0x1f << 21);
6887 1.1 christos insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 16)) << 5;
6888 1.1 christos if ((insn & (0x3eu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori,xoris */)
6889 1.1 christos insn -= 2 >> 26; /* convert to ori,oris */
6890 1.1 christos }
6891 1.1 christos else
6892 1.9 christos insn = 0;
6893 1.9 christos return insn;
6894 1.6 christos }
6895 1.1 christos
6896 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
6897 1.1 christos is_insn_ds_form (unsigned int insn)
6898 1.1 christos {
6899 1.1 christos return ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* ld,ldu,lwa */
6900 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std,stdu,stq */
6901 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 57u << 26 /* lfdp */
6902 1.1 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 61u << 26 /* stfdp */);
6903 1.1 christos }
6904 1.1 christos
6905 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
6906 1.1 christos is_insn_dq_form (unsigned int insn)
6907 1.1 christos {
6908 1.1 christos return ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 56u << 26 /* lq */
6909 1.1 christos || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (61u << 26) /* lxv, stxv */
6910 1.1 christos && (insn & 3) == 1));
6911 1.1 christos }
6912 1.1 christos
6913 1.1 christos /* The RELOCATE_SECTION function is called by the ELF backend linker
6914 1.1 christos to handle the relocations for a section.
6915 1.1 christos
6916 1.1 christos The relocs are always passed as Rela structures; if the section
6917 1.1 christos actually uses Rel structures, the r_addend field will always be
6918 1.1 christos zero.
6919 1.1 christos
6920 1.1 christos This function is responsible for adjust the section contents as
6921 1.1 christos necessary, and (if using Rela relocs and generating a
6922 1.1 christos relocatable output file) adjusting the reloc addend as
6923 1.1 christos necessary.
6924 1.1 christos
6925 1.1 christos This function does not have to worry about setting the reloc
6926 1.1 christos address or the reloc symbol index.
6927 1.1 christos
6928 1.1 christos LOCAL_SYMS is a pointer to the swapped in local symbols.
6929 1.1 christos
6930 1.1 christos LOCAL_SECTIONS is an array giving the section in the input file
6931 1.1 christos corresponding to the st_shndx field of each local symbol.
6932 1.1 christos
6933 1.1 christos The global hash table entry for the global symbols can be found
6934 1.1 christos via elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd).
6935 1.1 christos
6936 1.1 christos When generating relocatable output, this function must handle
6937 1.1 christos STB_LOCAL/STT_SECTION symbols specially. The output symbol is
6938 1.1 christos going to be the section symbol corresponding to the output
6939 1.1 christos section, which means that the addend must be adjusted
6940 1.6 christos accordingly. */
6941 1.1 christos
6942 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
6943 1.1 christos ppc_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd,
6944 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info,
6945 1.1 christos bfd *input_bfd,
6946 1.7 christos asection *input_section,
6947 1.1 christos bfd_byte *contents,
6948 1.5 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
6949 1.5 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
6950 1.1 christos asection **local_sections)
6951 1.1 christos {
6952 1.8 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6953 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
6954 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6955 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
6956 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *wrel;
6957 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
6958 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
6959 1.8 christos asection *got2;
6960 1.8 christos bfd_vma *local_got_offsets;
6961 1.8 christos bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
6962 1.8 christos bfd_vma d_offset = (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd) ? 2 : 0);
6963 1.8 christos bfd_boolean is_vxworks_tls;
6964 1.8 christos unsigned int picfixup_size = 0;
6965 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
6966 1.1 christos
6967 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
6968 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_relocate_section called for %pB section %pA, "
6969 1.1 christos "%ld relocations%s",
6970 1.1 christos input_bfd, input_section,
6971 1.1 christos (long) input_section->reloc_count,
6972 1.1 christos (bfd_link_relocatable (info)) ? " (relocatable)" : "");
6973 1.1 christos #endif
6974 1.1 christos
6975 1.1 christos if (!is_ppc_elf (input_bfd))
6976 1.1 christos {
6977 1.9 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
6978 1.1 christos return FALSE;
6979 1.1 christos }
6980 1.5 christos
6981 1.5 christos got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (input_bfd, ".got2");
6982 1.6 christos
6983 1.1 christos /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
6984 1.6 christos if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
6985 1.1 christos ppc_elf_howto_init ();
6986 1.1 christos
6987 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
6988 1.1 christos local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (input_bfd);
6989 1.1 christos symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_bfd);
6990 1.1 christos sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd);
6991 1.1 christos /* We have to handle relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections
6992 1.1 christos specially, because the dynamic loader is 'weird'. */
6993 1.1 christos is_vxworks_tls = (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks && bfd_link_pic (info)
6994 1.1 christos && !strcmp (input_section->output_section->name,
6995 1.1 christos ".tls_vars"));
6996 1.1 christos if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET)
6997 1.8 christos relax_info = elf_section_data (input_section)->sec_info;
6998 1.1 christos rel = wrel = relocs;
6999 1.1 christos relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count;
7000 1.8 christos for (; rel < relend; wrel++, rel++)
7001 1.3 christos {
7002 1.1 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
7003 1.6 christos bfd_vma addend;
7004 1.1 christos bfd_reloc_status_type r;
7005 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7006 1.1 christos asection *sec;
7007 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7008 1.1 christos const char *sym_name;
7009 1.1 christos reloc_howto_type *howto;
7010 1.1 christos unsigned long r_symndx;
7011 1.1 christos bfd_vma relocation;
7012 1.1 christos bfd_vma branch_bit, from;
7013 1.1 christos bfd_boolean unresolved_reloc, save_unresolved_reloc;
7014 1.1 christos bfd_boolean warned;
7015 1.1 christos unsigned int tls_type, tls_mask, tls_gd;
7016 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **ifunc, **plt_list;
7017 1.1 christos struct reloc_howto_struct alt_howto;
7018 1.1 christos
7019 1.1 christos again:
7020 1.1 christos r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
7021 1.1 christos sym = NULL;
7022 1.1 christos sec = NULL;
7023 1.1 christos h = NULL;
7024 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7025 1.1 christos warned = FALSE;
7026 1.1 christos r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7027 1.1 christos
7028 1.1 christos if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7029 1.1 christos {
7030 1.1 christos sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
7031 1.1 christos sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
7032 1.1 christos sym_name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr, sym, sec);
7033 1.1 christos
7034 1.1 christos relocation = _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
7035 1.1 christos }
7036 1.1 christos else
7037 1.1 christos {
7038 1.1 christos bfd_boolean ignored;
7039 1.1 christos
7040 1.6 christos RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL (info, input_bfd, input_section, rel,
7041 1.6 christos r_symndx, symtab_hdr, sym_hashes,
7042 1.8 christos h, sec, relocation,
7043 1.6 christos unresolved_reloc, warned, ignored);
7044 1.6 christos
7045 1.6 christos sym_name = h->root.root.string;
7046 1.6 christos }
7047 1.6 christos
7048 1.8 christos if (sec != NULL && discarded_section (sec))
7049 1.6 christos {
7050 1.6 christos /* For relocs against symbols from removed linkonce sections,
7051 1.6 christos or sections discarded by a linker script, we just want the
7052 1.6 christos section contents zeroed. Avoid any special processing. */
7053 1.6 christos howto = NULL;
7054 1.6 christos if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
7055 1.6 christos howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
7056 1.1 christos
7057 1.1 christos _bfd_clear_contents (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
7058 1.6 christos contents, rel->r_offset);
7059 1.1 christos wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset;
7060 1.1 christos wrel->r_info = 0;
7061 1.1 christos wrel->r_addend = 0;
7062 1.1 christos
7063 1.1 christos /* For ld -r, remove relocations in debug sections against
7064 1.1 christos symbols defined in discarded sections. Not done for
7065 1.1 christos non-debug to preserve relocs in .eh_frame which the
7066 1.1 christos eh_frame editing code expects to be present. */
7067 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (info)
7068 1.3 christos && (input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING))
7069 1.3 christos wrel--;
7070 1.3 christos
7071 1.6 christos continue;
7072 1.1 christos }
7073 1.1 christos
7074 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
7075 1.1 christos {
7076 1.1 christos if (got2 != NULL
7077 1.1 christos && r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
7078 1.1 christos && rel->r_addend != 0)
7079 1.1 christos {
7080 1.1 christos /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special. If non-zero, the
7081 1.1 christos addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2. */
7082 1.1 christos rel->r_addend += got2->output_offset;
7083 1.1 christos }
7084 1.1 christos if (r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLT
7085 1.1 christos && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24
7086 1.1 christos && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX)
7087 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
7088 1.1 christos }
7089 1.1 christos
7090 1.1 christos /* TLS optimizations. Replace instruction sequences and relocs
7091 1.1 christos based on information we collected in tls_optimize. We edit
7092 1.1 christos RELOCS so that --emit-relocs will output something sensible
7093 1.1 christos for the final instruction stream. */
7094 1.1 christos tls_mask = 0;
7095 1.1 christos tls_gd = 0;
7096 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
7097 1.1 christos tls_mask = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->tls_mask;
7098 1.1 christos else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
7099 1.1 christos {
7100 1.1 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt;
7101 1.1 christos char *lgot_masks;
7102 1.1 christos local_plt
7103 1.1 christos = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7104 1.1 christos lgot_masks = (char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7105 1.1 christos tls_mask = lgot_masks[r_symndx];
7106 1.1 christos }
7107 1.1 christos
7108 1.1 christos /* Ensure reloc mapping code below stays sane. */
7109 1.1 christos if ((R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)
7110 1.1 christos || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO & 3)
7111 1.1 christos || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI & 3)
7112 1.1 christos || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA & 3)
7113 1.1 christos || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16 & 3)
7114 1.7 christos || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO & 3)
7115 1.6 christos || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI & 3)
7116 1.1 christos || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA & 3))
7117 1.1 christos abort ();
7118 1.7 christos switch (r_type)
7119 1.6 christos {
7120 1.1 christos default:
7121 1.1 christos break;
7122 1.1 christos
7123 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
7124 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
7125 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7126 1.1 christos && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
7127 1.1 christos {
7128 1.1 christos bfd_vma insn;
7129 1.1 christos
7130 1.1 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7131 1.7 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7132 1.1 christos insn &= 31 << 21;
7133 1.1 christos insn |= 0x3c020000; /* addis 0,2,0 */
7134 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
7135 1.7 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7136 1.1 christos r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
7137 1.1 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7138 1.1 christos }
7139 1.1 christos break;
7140 1.1 christos
7141 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TLS:
7142 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7143 1.1 christos && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
7144 1.1 christos {
7145 1.1 christos bfd_vma insn;
7146 1.1 christos
7147 1.9 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7148 1.1 christos insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (insn, 2);
7149 1.1 christos if (insn == 0)
7150 1.1 christos abort ();
7151 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
7152 1.1 christos r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
7153 1.1 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7154 1.1 christos
7155 1.1 christos /* Was PPC_TLS which sits on insn boundary, now
7156 1.1 christos PPC_TPREL16_LO which is at low-order half-word. */
7157 1.1 christos rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7158 1.1 christos }
7159 1.1 christos break;
7160 1.1 christos
7161 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
7162 1.5 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
7163 1.7 christos tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
7164 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
7165 1.1 christos goto tls_gdld_hi;
7166 1.1 christos break;
7167 1.1 christos
7168 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
7169 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
7170 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
7171 1.1 christos {
7172 1.9 christos tls_gdld_hi:
7173 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
7174 1.1 christos r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
7175 1.1 christos + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
7176 1.1 christos else
7177 1.1 christos {
7178 1.1 christos rel->r_offset -= d_offset;
7179 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
7180 1.1 christos r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
7181 1.1 christos }
7182 1.1 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7183 1.1 christos }
7184 1.1 christos break;
7185 1.1 christos
7186 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
7187 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
7188 1.1 christos tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
7189 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
7190 1.1 christos goto tls_ldgd_opt;
7191 1.9 christos break;
7192 1.1 christos
7193 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
7194 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
7195 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
7196 1.5 christos {
7197 1.5 christos unsigned int insn1, insn2;
7198 1.5 christos bfd_vma offset;
7199 1.5 christos
7200 1.7 christos tls_ldgd_opt:
7201 1.5 christos offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
7202 1.1 christos /* If not using the newer R_PPC_TLSGD/LD to mark
7203 1.1 christos __tls_get_addr calls, we must trust that the call
7204 1.1 christos stays with its arg setup insns, ie. that the next
7205 1.5 christos reloc is the __tls_get_addr call associated with
7206 1.9 christos the current reloc. Edit both insns. */
7207 1.1 christos if (input_section->nomark_tls_get_addr
7208 1.1 christos && rel + 1 < relend
7209 1.1 christos && branch_reloc_hash_match (input_bfd, rel + 1,
7210 1.1 christos htab->tls_get_addr))
7211 1.7 christos offset = rel[1].r_offset;
7212 1.1 christos /* We read the low GOT_TLS insn because we need to keep
7213 1.1 christos the destination reg. It may be something other than
7214 1.1 christos the usual r3, and moved to r3 before the call by
7215 1.1 christos intervening code. */
7216 1.1 christos insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7217 1.1 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7218 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
7219 1.1 christos {
7220 1.5 christos /* IE */
7221 1.5 christos insn1 &= (0x1f << 21) | (0x1f << 16);
7222 1.1 christos insn1 |= 32u << 26; /* lwz */
7223 1.1 christos if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
7224 1.1 christos {
7225 1.1 christos rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7226 1.1 christos insn2 = 0x7c631214; /* add 3,3,2 */
7227 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7228 1.1 christos }
7229 1.1 christos r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
7230 1.1 christos + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
7231 1.1 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7232 1.1 christos }
7233 1.1 christos else
7234 1.1 christos {
7235 1.1 christos /* LE */
7236 1.1 christos insn1 &= 0x1f << 21;
7237 1.1 christos insn1 |= 0x3c020000; /* addis r,2,0 */
7238 1.1 christos if (tls_gd == 0)
7239 1.1 christos {
7240 1.1 christos /* Was an LD reloc. */
7241 1.1 christos for (r_symndx = 0;
7242 1.1 christos r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7243 1.1 christos r_symndx++)
7244 1.1 christos if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
7245 1.1 christos break;
7246 1.7 christos if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7247 1.1 christos r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
7248 1.1 christos rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7249 1.7 christos if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
7250 1.1 christos rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
7251 1.1 christos + sec->output_offset
7252 1.1 christos + sec->output_section->vma);
7253 1.1 christos }
7254 1.1 christos r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
7255 1.6 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7256 1.1 christos if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
7257 1.1 christos {
7258 1.1 christos rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
7259 1.1 christos rel[1].r_offset = offset + d_offset;
7260 1.1 christos rel[1].r_addend = rel->r_addend;
7261 1.8 christos insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7262 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7263 1.1 christos }
7264 1.1 christos }
7265 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn1,
7266 1.1 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7267 1.8 christos if (tls_gd == 0)
7268 1.8 christos {
7269 1.8 christos /* We changed the symbol on an LD reloc. Start over
7270 1.8 christos in order to get h, sym, sec etc. right. */
7271 1.8 christos goto again;
7272 1.8 christos }
7273 1.8 christos }
7274 1.9 christos break;
7275 1.1 christos
7276 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TLSGD:
7277 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
7278 1.1 christos && rel + 1 < relend)
7279 1.1 christos {
7280 1.1 christos unsigned int insn2;
7281 1.1 christos bfd_vma offset = rel->r_offset;
7282 1.1 christos
7283 1.1 christos if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
7284 1.1 christos {
7285 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + offset);
7286 1.1 christos rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7287 1.1 christos break;
7288 1.7 christos }
7289 1.1 christos
7290 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_GDIE) != 0)
7291 1.1 christos {
7292 1.1 christos /* IE */
7293 1.1 christos r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
7294 1.1 christos insn2 = 0x7c631214; /* add 3,3,2 */
7295 1.1 christos }
7296 1.8 christos else
7297 1.8 christos {
7298 1.1 christos /* LE */
7299 1.1 christos r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
7300 1.1 christos rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7301 1.8 christos insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7302 1.8 christos }
7303 1.8 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7304 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7305 1.8 christos /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
7306 1.8 christos BFD_ASSERT (offset == rel[1].r_offset);
7307 1.8 christos rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7308 1.1 christos }
7309 1.1 christos break;
7310 1.1 christos
7311 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TLSLD:
7312 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
7313 1.1 christos && rel + 1 < relend)
7314 1.1 christos {
7315 1.1 christos unsigned int insn2;
7316 1.1 christos
7317 1.1 christos if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
7318 1.1 christos {
7319 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
7320 1.1 christos rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7321 1.1 christos break;
7322 1.1 christos }
7323 1.1 christos
7324 1.7 christos for (r_symndx = 0;
7325 1.1 christos r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7326 1.1 christos r_symndx++)
7327 1.1 christos if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
7328 1.1 christos break;
7329 1.6 christos if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7330 1.1 christos r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
7331 1.1 christos rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7332 1.1 christos if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
7333 1.1 christos rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
7334 1.1 christos + sec->output_offset
7335 1.1 christos + sec->output_section->vma);
7336 1.1 christos
7337 1.1 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
7338 1.1 christos rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7339 1.1 christos insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7340 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2,
7341 1.1 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7342 1.1 christos /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
7343 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (rel->r_offset - d_offset == rel[1].r_offset);
7344 1.1 christos rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7345 1.7 christos goto again;
7346 1.1 christos }
7347 1.1 christos break;
7348 1.1 christos }
7349 1.1 christos
7350 1.1 christos /* Handle other relocations that tweak non-addend part of insn. */
7351 1.8 christos branch_bit = 0;
7352 1.1 christos switch (r_type)
7353 1.7 christos {
7354 1.1 christos default:
7355 1.1 christos break;
7356 1.1 christos
7357 1.1 christos /* Branch taken prediction relocations. */
7358 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
7359 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
7360 1.1 christos branch_bit = BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7361 1.1 christos /* Fall through. */
7362 1.1 christos
7363 1.1 christos /* Branch not taken prediction relocations. */
7364 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
7365 1.7 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
7366 1.1 christos {
7367 1.8 christos unsigned int insn;
7368 1.8 christos
7369 1.8 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7370 1.8 christos insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7371 1.8 christos insn |= branch_bit;
7372 1.8 christos
7373 1.8 christos from = (rel->r_offset
7374 1.8 christos + input_section->output_offset
7375 1.9 christos + input_section->output_section->vma);
7376 1.8 christos
7377 1.8 christos /* Invert 'y' bit if not the default. */
7378 1.8 christos if ((bfd_signed_vma) (relocation + rel->r_addend - from) < 0)
7379 1.8 christos insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7380 1.8 christos
7381 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
7382 1.8 christos }
7383 1.8 christos break;
7384 1.8 christos
7385 1.8 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
7386 1.8 christos {
7387 1.8 christos unsigned int insn;
7388 1.8 christos
7389 1.8 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7390 1.8 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7391 1.8 christos if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 15u << 26
7392 1.8 christos && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) != 0)
7393 1.1 christos {
7394 1.1 christos if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
7395 1.5 christos {
7396 1.5 christos /* Convert addis to lis. */
7397 1.5 christos insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
7398 1.5 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
7399 1.5 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7400 1.5 christos }
7401 1.5 christos }
7402 1.5 christos else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
7403 1.5 christos info->callbacks->einfo
7404 1.5 christos (_("%P: %H: error: %s with unexpected instruction %x\n"),
7405 1.5 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7406 1.5 christos "R_PPC_PLT16_HA", insn);
7407 1.5 christos }
7408 1.5 christos break;
7409 1.7 christos }
7410 1.5 christos
7411 1.9 christos if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
7412 1.5 christos && h != NULL
7413 1.5 christos && !h->def_regular
7414 1.5 christos && h->protected_def
7415 1.5 christos && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
7416 1.5 christos && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
7417 1.5 christos && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
7418 1.5 christos {
7419 1.5 christos /* Convert lis;addi or lis;load/store accessing a protected
7420 1.5 christos variable defined in a shared library to PIC. */
7421 1.5 christos unsigned int insn;
7422 1.5 christos
7423 1.5 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
7424 1.5 christos {
7425 1.7 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7426 1.5 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7427 1.5 christos if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (15u << 26)
7428 1.7 christos && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) == 0 /* lis */)
7429 1.5 christos {
7430 1.7 christos bfd_byte *p;
7431 1.7 christos bfd_vma off;
7432 1.5 christos bfd_vma got_addr;
7433 1.6 christos
7434 1.6 christos p = (contents + input_section->size
7435 1.6 christos - relax_info->workaround_size
7436 1.5 christos - relax_info->picfixup_size
7437 1.7 christos + picfixup_size);
7438 1.7 christos off = (p - contents) - (rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7439 1.5 christos if (off > 0x1fffffc || (off & 3) != 0)
7440 1.5 christos info->callbacks->einfo
7441 1.5 christos (_("%H: fixup branch overflow\n"),
7442 1.5 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
7443 1.5 christos
7444 1.5 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | off,
7445 1.7 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7446 1.5 christos got_addr = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7447 1.7 christos + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7448 1.5 christos + (h->got.offset & ~1));
7449 1.5 christos wrel->r_offset = (p - contents) + d_offset;
7450 1.5 christos wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
7451 1.5 christos wrel->r_addend = got_addr;
7452 1.5 christos insn &= ~0xffff;
7453 1.6 christos insn |= ((unsigned int) (got_addr + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
7454 1.6 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
7455 1.5 christos
7456 1.6 christos /* Convert lis to lwz, loading address from GOT. */
7457 1.5 christos insn &= ~0xffff;
7458 1.5 christos insn ^= (32u ^ 15u) << 26;
7459 1.5 christos insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 21)) >> 5;
7460 1.5 christos insn |= got_addr & 0xffff;
7461 1.5 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p + 4);
7462 1.5 christos
7463 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | ((-4 - off) & 0x3ffffff), p + 8);
7464 1.7 christos picfixup_size += 12;
7465 1.8 christos
7466 1.8 christos /* Use one of the spare relocs, so --emit-relocs
7467 1.8 christos output is reasonable. */
7468 1.5 christos memmove (rel + 1, rel, (relend - rel - 1) * sizeof (*rel));
7469 1.5 christos wrel++, rel++;
7470 1.5 christos rel->r_offset = wrel[-1].r_offset + 4;
7471 1.5 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
7472 1.7 christos rel->r_addend = wrel[-1].r_addend;
7473 1.5 christos
7474 1.9 christos /* Continue on as if we had a got reloc, to output
7475 1.9 christos dynamic reloc. */
7476 1.9 christos r_type = R_PPC_GOT16_LO;
7477 1.9 christos }
7478 1.9 christos else
7479 1.9 christos _bfd_error_handler
7480 1.9 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
7481 1.9 christos (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
7482 1.9 christos "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
7483 1.9 christos input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
7484 1.9 christos "R_PPC_ADDR16_HA", insn);
7485 1.9 christos }
7486 1.9 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO)
7487 1.9 christos {
7488 1.9 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7489 1.5 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7490 1.9 christos if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
7491 1.5 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
7492 1.5 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
7493 1.5 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
7494 1.5 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
7495 1.5 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
7496 1.5 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
7497 1.5 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
7498 1.5 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
7499 1.8 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
7500 1.7 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
7501 1.8 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
7502 1.8 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
7503 1.8 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
7504 1.5 christos || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
7505 1.5 christos && (insn & 3) != 1)
7506 1.5 christos || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
7507 1.5 christos && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3)))
7508 1.1 christos {
7509 1.9 christos /* Arrange to apply the reloc addend, if any. */
7510 1.1 christos relocation = 0;
7511 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7512 1.1 christos rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, r_type);
7513 1.1 christos }
7514 1.1 christos else
7515 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler
7516 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
7517 1.1 christos (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
7518 1.1 christos "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
7519 1.1 christos input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
7520 1.1 christos "R_PPC_ADDR16_LO", insn);
7521 1.1 christos }
7522 1.1 christos }
7523 1.1 christos
7524 1.1 christos ifunc = NULL;
7525 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.target_os != is_vxworks)
7526 1.1 christos {
7527 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
7528 1.1 christos
7529 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
7530 1.6 christos {
7531 1.8 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
7532 1.8 christos ifunc = &h->plt.plist;
7533 1.8 christos }
7534 1.8 christos else if (local_got_offsets != NULL
7535 1.1 christos && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
7536 1.1 christos {
7537 1.8 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt;
7538 1.8 christos
7539 1.8 christos local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
7540 1.8 christos + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7541 1.8 christos ifunc = local_plt + r_symndx;
7542 1.1 christos }
7543 1.1 christos
7544 1.1 christos ent = NULL;
7545 1.1 christos if (ifunc != NULL
7546 1.1 christos && (!bfd_link_pic (info)
7547 1.7 christos || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
7548 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
7549 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
7550 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
7551 1.7 christos {
7552 1.7 christos addend = 0;
7553 1.7 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)
7554 1.7 christos && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
7555 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
7556 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
7557 1.7 christos || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
7558 1.7 christos addend = rel->r_addend;
7559 1.7 christos ent = find_plt_ent (ifunc, got2, addend);
7560 1.7 christos }
7561 1.7 christos if (ent != NULL)
7562 1.7 christos {
7563 1.7 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)
7564 1.7 christos && ent->sec != got2
7565 1.7 christos && htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW
7566 1.7 christos && (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7567 1.7 christos || h == NULL
7568 1.1 christos || h->dynindx == -1))
7569 1.1 christos {
7570 1.1 christos /* Uh oh, we are going to create a pic glink stub
7571 1.1 christos for an ifunc (here for h == NULL and later in
7572 1.3 christos finish_dynamic_symbol for h != NULL), and
7573 1.3 christos apparently are using code compiled with
7574 1.1 christos -mbss-plt. The difficulty is that -mbss-plt code
7575 1.1 christos gives no indication via a magic PLTREL24 addend
7576 1.1 christos whether r30 is equal to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or
7577 1.1 christos is pointing into a .got2 section (and how far
7578 1.7 christos into .got2). */
7579 1.7 christos info->callbacks->einfo
7580 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
7581 1.1 christos (_("%X%H: unsupported bss-plt -fPIC ifunc %s\n"),
7582 1.1 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, sym_name);
7583 1.1 christos }
7584 1.1 christos
7585 1.8 christos unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7586 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
7587 1.1 christos || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7588 1.1 christos || h == NULL
7589 1.8 christos || h->dynindx == -1)
7590 1.8 christos relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
7591 1.1 christos + htab->glink->output_offset
7592 1.1 christos + (ent->glink_offset & ~1));
7593 1.1 christos else
7594 1.8 christos relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
7595 1.8 christos + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
7596 1.8 christos + ent->plt.offset);
7597 1.1 christos }
7598 1.1 christos }
7599 1.1 christos
7600 1.6 christos addend = rel->r_addend;
7601 1.1 christos save_unresolved_reloc = unresolved_reloc;
7602 1.1 christos howto = NULL;
7603 1.1 christos if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
7604 1.1 christos howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
7605 1.1 christos
7606 1.1 christos tls_type = 0;
7607 1.1 christos switch (r_type)
7608 1.1 christos {
7609 1.6 christos default:
7610 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
7611 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
7612 1.1 christos input_bfd, howto->name);
7613 1.1 christos
7614 1.1 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7615 1.1 christos ret = FALSE;
7616 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
7617 1.1 christos
7618 1.1 christos case R_PPC_NONE:
7619 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TLS:
7620 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TLSGD:
7621 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TLSLD:
7622 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
7623 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
7624 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
7625 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
7626 1.1 christos
7627 1.1 christos /* GOT16 relocations. Like an ADDR16 using the symbol's
7628 1.1 christos address in the GOT as relocation value instead of the
7629 1.1 christos symbol's value itself. Also, create a GOT entry for the
7630 1.1 christos symbol and put the symbol value there. */
7631 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
7632 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
7633 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
7634 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
7635 1.1 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
7636 1.1 christos goto dogot;
7637 1.1 christos
7638 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
7639 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
7640 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
7641 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
7642 1.1 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
7643 1.1 christos goto dogot;
7644 1.1 christos
7645 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
7646 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
7647 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
7648 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
7649 1.1 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
7650 1.1 christos goto dogot;
7651 1.1 christos
7652 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
7653 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
7654 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
7655 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
7656 1.7 christos tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
7657 1.1 christos goto dogot;
7658 1.1 christos
7659 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16:
7660 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
7661 1.9 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
7662 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
7663 1.1 christos tls_mask = 0;
7664 1.1 christos dogot:
7665 1.7 christos {
7666 1.7 christos /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the global
7667 1.7 christos offset table. */
7668 1.8 christos bfd_vma off;
7669 1.1 christos bfd_vma *offp;
7670 1.1 christos unsigned long indx;
7671 1.1 christos
7672 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
7673 1.1 christos abort ();
7674 1.1 christos
7675 1.1 christos indx = 0;
7676 1.1 christos if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)
7677 1.1 christos && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7678 1.1 christos offp = &htab->tlsld_got.offset;
7679 1.1 christos else if (h != NULL)
7680 1.1 christos {
7681 1.1 christos if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7682 1.1 christos || h->dynindx == -1
7683 1.1 christos || SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)
7684 1.1 christos || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
7685 1.1 christos /* This is actually a static link, or it is a
7686 1.1 christos -Bsymbolic link and the symbol is defined
7687 1.1 christos locally, or the symbol was forced to be local
7688 1.1 christos because of a version file. */
7689 1.1 christos ;
7690 1.1 christos else
7691 1.1 christos {
7692 1.1 christos indx = h->dynindx;
7693 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7694 1.1 christos }
7695 1.1 christos offp = &h->got.offset;
7696 1.8 christos }
7697 1.8 christos else
7698 1.9 christos {
7699 1.8 christos if (local_got_offsets == NULL)
7700 1.1 christos abort ();
7701 1.1 christos offp = &local_got_offsets[r_symndx];
7702 1.1 christos }
7703 1.9 christos
7704 1.9 christos /* The offset must always be a multiple of 4. We use the
7705 1.1 christos least significant bit to record whether we have already
7706 1.1 christos processed this entry. */
7707 1.1 christos off = *offp;
7708 1.1 christos if ((off & 1) != 0)
7709 1.1 christos off &= ~1;
7710 1.1 christos else
7711 1.1 christos {
7712 1.1 christos unsigned int tls_m = ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7713 1.1 christos ? tls_mask & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL
7714 1.1 christos | TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)
7715 1.1 christos : 0);
7716 1.1 christos
7717 1.1 christos if (offp == &htab->tlsld_got.offset)
7718 1.1 christos tls_m = TLS_LD;
7719 1.1 christos else if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0
7720 1.1 christos && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7721 1.1 christos tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
7722 1.1 christos
7723 1.1 christos /* We might have multiple got entries for this sym.
7724 1.1 christos Initialize them all. */
7725 1.1 christos do
7726 1.1 christos {
7727 1.1 christos int tls_ty = 0;
7728 1.9 christos
7729 1.1 christos if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0)
7730 1.1 christos {
7731 1.1 christos tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
7732 1.1 christos tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
7733 1.1 christos }
7734 1.1 christos else if ((tls_m & TLS_GD) != 0)
7735 1.7 christos {
7736 1.7 christos tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
7737 1.7 christos tls_m &= ~TLS_GD;
7738 1.9 christos }
7739 1.9 christos else if ((tls_m & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
7740 1.8 christos {
7741 1.8 christos tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
7742 1.1 christos tls_m &= ~TLS_DTPREL;
7743 1.7 christos }
7744 1.1 christos else if ((tls_m & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
7745 1.1 christos {
7746 1.1 christos tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
7747 1.7 christos tls_m = 0;
7748 1.7 christos }
7749 1.7 christos
7750 1.7 christos /* Generate relocs for the dynamic linker. */
7751 1.7 christos if (indx != 0
7752 1.7 christos || (bfd_link_pic (info)
7753 1.7 christos && (h == NULL
7754 1.7 christos || !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
7755 1.7 christos && !(tls_ty != 0
7756 1.1 christos && bfd_link_executable (info)
7757 1.1 christos && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))))
7758 1.1 christos {
7759 1.1 christos asection *rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
7760 1.1 christos bfd_byte * loc;
7761 1.1 christos
7762 1.1 christos if (ifunc != NULL)
7763 1.1 christos {
7764 1.1 christos rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
7765 1.1 christos if (indx == 0)
7766 1.1 christos htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
7767 1.1 christos else if (is_static_defined (h))
7768 1.1 christos htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
7769 1.1 christos }
7770 1.1 christos outrel.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7771 1.1 christos + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7772 1.1 christos + off);
7773 1.1 christos outrel.r_addend = 0;
7774 1.1 christos if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7775 1.1 christos {
7776 1.1 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPMOD32);
7777 1.1 christos if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
7778 1.1 christos {
7779 1.1 christos loc = rsec->contents;
7780 1.1 christos loc += (rsec->reloc_count++
7781 1.1 christos * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
7782 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd,
7783 1.1 christos &outrel, loc);
7784 1.1 christos outrel.r_offset += 4;
7785 1.1 christos outrel.r_info
7786 1.1 christos = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
7787 1.5 christos }
7788 1.5 christos }
7789 1.5 christos else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
7790 1.5 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
7791 1.5 christos else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL))
7792 1.5 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_TPREL32);
7793 1.1 christos else if (indx != 0)
7794 1.1 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_GLOB_DAT);
7795 1.1 christos else if (ifunc != NULL)
7796 1.1 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
7797 1.1 christos else
7798 1.1 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
7799 1.1 christos if (indx == 0 && tls_ty != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
7800 1.1 christos {
7801 1.1 christos outrel.r_addend += relocation;
7802 1.1 christos if (tls_ty & (TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL | TLS_TPREL))
7803 1.1 christos {
7804 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
7805 1.1 christos outrel.r_addend = 0;
7806 1.7 christos else
7807 1.1 christos outrel.r_addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma;
7808 1.5 christos }
7809 1.5 christos }
7810 1.5 christos loc = rsec->contents;
7811 1.5 christos loc += (rsec->reloc_count++
7812 1.7 christos * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
7813 1.7 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
7814 1.7 christos }
7815 1.7 christos
7816 1.8 christos /* Init the .got section contents if we're not
7817 1.5 christos emitting a reloc. */
7818 1.5 christos else
7819 1.1 christos {
7820 1.7 christos bfd_vma value = relocation;
7821 1.1 christos
7822 1.7 christos if (tls_ty != 0)
7823 1.7 christos {
7824 1.8 christos if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
7825 1.1 christos value = 0;
7826 1.1 christos else
7827 1.7 christos {
7828 1.7 christos if (tls_ty & TLS_LD)
7829 1.1 christos value = 0;
7830 1.1 christos else
7831 1.1 christos value -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7832 1.1 christos if (tls_ty & TLS_TPREL)
7833 1.1 christos value += DTP_OFFSET - TP_OFFSET;
7834 1.1 christos }
7835 1.1 christos
7836 1.1 christos if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7837 1.1 christos {
7838 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
7839 1.1 christos htab->elf.sgot->contents + off + 4);
7840 1.1 christos value = 1;
7841 1.1 christos }
7842 1.1 christos }
7843 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
7844 1.1 christos htab->elf.sgot->contents + off);
7845 1.1 christos }
7846 1.1 christos
7847 1.1 christos off += 4;
7848 1.1 christos if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7849 1.9 christos off += 4;
7850 1.1 christos }
7851 1.1 christos while (tls_m != 0);
7852 1.1 christos
7853 1.1 christos off = *offp;
7854 1.1 christos *offp = off | 1;
7855 1.1 christos }
7856 1.1 christos
7857 1.1 christos if (off >= (bfd_vma) -2)
7858 1.1 christos abort ();
7859 1.1 christos
7860 1.1 christos if ((tls_type & TLS_TLS) != 0)
7861 1.1 christos {
7862 1.1 christos if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
7863 1.1 christos {
7864 1.5 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_LD) != 0
7865 1.5 christos && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7866 1.6 christos off += 8;
7867 1.5 christos if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
7868 1.7 christos {
7869 1.7 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
7870 1.1 christos off += 8;
7871 1.1 christos if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
7872 1.1 christos {
7873 1.1 christos if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
7874 1.1 christos off += 4;
7875 1.1 christos }
7876 1.1 christos }
7877 1.1 christos }
7878 1.1 christos }
7879 1.7 christos
7880 1.7 christos /* If here for a picfixup, we're done. */
7881 1.1 christos if (r_type != ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
7882 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
7883 1.1 christos
7884 1.1 christos relocation = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7885 1.3 christos + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7886 1.1 christos + off
7887 1.3 christos - SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot));
7888 1.1 christos
7889 1.1 christos /* Addends on got relocations don't make much sense.
7890 1.1 christos x+off@got is actually x@got+off, and since the got is
7891 1.1 christos generated by a hash table traversal, the value in the
7892 1.1 christos got at entry m+n bears little relation to the entry m. */
7893 1.6 christos if (addend != 0)
7894 1.6 christos info->callbacks->einfo
7895 1.6 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
7896 1.6 christos (_("%H: non-zero addend on %s reloc against `%s'\n"),
7897 1.6 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7898 1.6 christos howto->name,
7899 1.6 christos sym_name);
7900 1.1 christos }
7901 1.7 christos break;
7902 1.7 christos
7903 1.7 christos /* Relocations that need no special processing. */
7904 1.7 christos case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
7905 1.7 christos /* It makes no sense to point a local relocation
7906 1.7 christos at a symbol not in this object. */
7907 1.7 christos if (unresolved_reloc)
7908 1.7 christos {
7909 1.7 christos (*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol) (info,
7910 1.7 christos h->root.root.string,
7911 1.7 christos input_bfd,
7912 1.7 christos input_section,
7913 1.7 christos rel->r_offset,
7914 1.7 christos TRUE);
7915 1.7 christos goto copy_reloc;
7916 1.1 christos }
7917 1.1 christos if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && bfd_link_pic (info))
7918 1.1 christos {
7919 1.1 christos /* @local on an ifunc does not really make sense since
7920 1.1 christos the ifunc resolver can take you anywhere. More
7921 1.1 christos seriously, calls to ifuncs must go through a plt call
7922 1.5 christos stub, and for pic the plt call stubs uses r30 to
7923 1.5 christos access the PLT. The problem is that a call that is
7924 1.1 christos local won't have the +32k reloc addend trick marking
7925 1.1 christos -fPIC code, so the linker won't know whether r30 is
7926 1.1 christos _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or pointing into a .got2 section. */
7927 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
7928 1.1 christos info->callbacks->einfo (_("%X%H: @local call to ifunc %s\n"),
7929 1.1 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7930 1.1 christos h->root.root.string);
7931 1.1 christos }
7932 1.1 christos break;
7933 1.1 christos
7934 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
7935 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
7936 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
7937 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
7938 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
7939 1.1 christos addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7940 1.1 christos break;
7941 1.7 christos
7942 1.1 christos /* Relocations that may need to be propagated if this is a shared
7943 1.1 christos object. */
7944 1.7 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16:
7945 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
7946 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
7947 1.5 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
7948 1.5 christos if (h != NULL
7949 1.1 christos && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
7950 1.8 christos && h->dynindx == -1)
7951 1.8 christos {
7952 1.1 christos /* Make this relocation against an undefined weak symbol
7953 1.1 christos resolve to zero. This is really just a tweak, since
7954 1.1 christos code using weak externs ought to check that they are
7955 1.5 christos defined before using them. */
7956 1.5 christos bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset;
7957 1.1 christos unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
7958 1.1 christos insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (insn, 2);
7959 1.1 christos if (insn != 0)
7960 1.5 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
7961 1.5 christos break;
7962 1.1 christos }
7963 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
7964 1.1 christos addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
7965 1.1 christos /* The TPREL16 relocs shouldn't really be used in shared
7966 1.1 christos libs or with non-local symbols as that will result in
7967 1.1 christos DT_TEXTREL being set, but support them anyway. */
7968 1.1 christos goto dodyn;
7969 1.1 christos
7970 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL32:
7971 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
7972 1.1 christos addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
7973 1.6 christos goto dodyn;
7974 1.1 christos
7975 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
7976 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
7977 1.1 christos addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7978 1.1 christos goto dodyn;
7979 1.1 christos
7980 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
7981 1.1 christos relocation = 1;
7982 1.1 christos addend = 0;
7983 1.1 christos goto dodyn;
7984 1.1 christos
7985 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16:
7986 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
7987 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
7988 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
7989 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
7990 1.1 christos break;
7991 1.1 christos
7992 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL32:
7993 1.1 christos if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
7994 1.1 christos break;
7995 1.1 christos /* fall through */
7996 1.1 christos
7997 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR32:
7998 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16:
7999 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
8000 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
8001 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
8002 1.1 christos case R_PPC_UADDR32:
8003 1.1 christos case R_PPC_UADDR16:
8004 1.1 christos goto dodyn;
8005 1.1 christos
8006 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
8007 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
8008 1.6 christos case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
8009 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL24:
8010 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14:
8011 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
8012 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
8013 1.1 christos /* If these relocations are not to a named symbol, they can be
8014 1.1 christos handled right here, no need to bother the dynamic linker. */
8015 1.1 christos if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
8016 1.1 christos || h == htab->elf.hgot)
8017 1.8 christos break;
8018 1.8 christos /* fall through */
8019 1.9 christos
8020 1.8 christos case R_PPC_ADDR24:
8021 1.8 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14:
8022 1.8 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
8023 1.9 christos case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
8024 1.1 christos if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
8025 1.1 christos break;
8026 1.1 christos /* fall through */
8027 1.1 christos
8028 1.7 christos dodyn:
8029 1.7 christos if ((input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
8030 1.1 christos || is_vxworks_tls)
8031 1.1 christos break;
8032 1.1 christos
8033 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info)
8034 1.1 christos ? ((h == NULL
8035 1.1 christos || h->dyn_relocs != NULL)
8036 1.1 christos && ((h != NULL && pc_dynrelocs (h))
8037 1.1 christos || must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)))
8038 1.1 christos : (h != NULL
8039 1.1 christos && h->dyn_relocs != NULL))
8040 1.1 christos {
8041 1.1 christos int skip;
8042 1.1 christos bfd_byte *loc;
8043 1.1 christos asection *sreloc;
8044 1.1 christos long indx = 0;
8045 1.1 christos
8046 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
8047 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_relocate_section needs to "
8048 1.1 christos "create relocation for %s\n",
8049 1.1 christos (h && h->root.root.string
8050 1.9 christos ? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
8051 1.9 christos #endif
8052 1.9 christos
8053 1.9 christos /* When generating a shared object, these relocations
8054 1.9 christos are copied into the output file to be resolved at run
8055 1.9 christos time. */
8056 1.9 christos skip = 0;
8057 1.9 christos outrel.r_offset = _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info,
8058 1.1 christos input_section,
8059 1.1 christos rel->r_offset);
8060 1.8 christos if (outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -1
8061 1.1 christos || outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -2)
8062 1.7 christos skip = (int) outrel.r_offset;
8063 1.7 christos outrel.r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
8064 1.1 christos + input_section->output_offset);
8065 1.7 christos
8066 1.1 christos /* Optimize unaligned reloc use. */
8067 1.1 christos if ((r_type == R_PPC_ADDR32 && (outrel.r_offset & 3) != 0)
8068 1.1 christos || (r_type == R_PPC_UADDR32 && (outrel.r_offset & 3) == 0))
8069 1.1 christos r_type ^= R_PPC_ADDR32 ^ R_PPC_UADDR32;
8070 1.1 christos if ((r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16 && (outrel.r_offset & 1) != 0)
8071 1.1 christos || (r_type == R_PPC_UADDR16 && (outrel.r_offset & 1) == 0))
8072 1.1 christos r_type ^= R_PPC_ADDR16 ^ R_PPC_UADDR16;
8073 1.1 christos
8074 1.1 christos if (skip)
8075 1.1 christos memset (&outrel, 0, sizeof outrel);
8076 1.1 christos else if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
8077 1.1 christos {
8078 1.1 christos indx = h->dynindx;
8079 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (indx != -1);
8080 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8081 1.1 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
8082 1.1 christos outrel.r_addend = rel->r_addend;
8083 1.1 christos }
8084 1.1 christos else
8085 1.1 christos {
8086 1.1 christos outrel.r_addend = relocation + rel->r_addend;
8087 1.1 christos
8088 1.1 christos if (r_type != R_PPC_ADDR32)
8089 1.7 christos {
8090 1.7 christos if (ifunc != NULL)
8091 1.1 christos {
8092 1.1 christos /* If we get here when building a static
8093 1.1 christos executable, then the libc startup function
8094 1.1 christos responsible for applying indirect function
8095 1.1 christos relocations is going to complain about
8096 1.1 christos the reloc type.
8097 1.1 christos If we get here when building a dynamic
8098 1.1 christos executable, it will be because we have
8099 1.1 christos a text relocation. The dynamic loader
8100 1.1 christos will set the text segment writable and
8101 1.1 christos non-executable to apply text relocations.
8102 1.1 christos So we'll segfault when trying to run the
8103 1.1 christos indirection function to resolve the reloc. */
8104 1.1 christos info->callbacks->einfo
8105 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
8106 1.1 christos (_("%H: relocation %s for indirect "
8107 1.1 christos "function %s unsupported\n"),
8108 1.1 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8109 1.1 christos howto->name,
8110 1.1 christos sym_name);
8111 1.1 christos ret = FALSE;
8112 1.1 christos }
8113 1.1 christos else if (r_symndx == STN_UNDEF || bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
8114 1.1 christos ;
8115 1.9 christos else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
8116 1.9 christos {
8117 1.9 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8118 1.9 christos ret = FALSE;
8119 1.9 christos }
8120 1.9 christos else
8121 1.1 christos {
8122 1.1 christos asection *osec;
8123 1.9 christos
8124 1.9 christos /* We are turning this relocation into one
8125 1.9 christos against a section symbol. It would be
8126 1.9 christos proper to subtract the symbol's value,
8127 1.9 christos osec->vma, from the emitted reloc addend,
8128 1.9 christos but ld.so expects buggy relocs.
8129 1.1 christos FIXME: Why not always use a zero index? */
8130 1.9 christos osec = sec->output_section;
8131 1.9 christos if ((osec->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
8132 1.9 christos {
8133 1.9 christos osec = htab->elf.tls_sec;
8134 1.9 christos indx = 0;
8135 1.9 christos }
8136 1.1 christos else
8137 1.1 christos {
8138 1.1 christos indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
8139 1.1 christos if (indx == 0)
8140 1.1 christos {
8141 1.1 christos osec = htab->elf.text_index_section;
8142 1.1 christos indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
8143 1.1 christos }
8144 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (indx != 0);
8145 1.1 christos }
8146 1.7 christos
8147 1.7 christos /* ld.so doesn't expect buggy TLS relocs.
8148 1.7 christos Don't leave the symbol value in the
8149 1.7 christos addend for them. */
8150 1.7 christos if (IS_PPC_TLS_RELOC (r_type))
8151 1.7 christos outrel.r_addend -= osec->vma;
8152 1.7 christos }
8153 1.7 christos
8154 1.7 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
8155 1.7 christos }
8156 1.7 christos else if (ifunc != NULL)
8157 1.7 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
8158 1.1 christos else
8159 1.1 christos outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
8160 1.1 christos }
8161 1.1 christos
8162 1.1 christos sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
8163 1.6 christos if (ifunc)
8164 1.1 christos {
8165 1.7 christos sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
8166 1.7 christos if (indx == 0)
8167 1.7 christos htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
8168 1.1 christos else if (is_static_defined (h))
8169 1.1 christos htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
8170 1.1 christos }
8171 1.1 christos if (sreloc == NULL)
8172 1.1 christos return FALSE;
8173 1.1 christos
8174 1.1 christos loc = sreloc->contents;
8175 1.1 christos loc += sreloc->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8176 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
8177 1.1 christos
8178 1.1 christos if (skip == -1)
8179 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
8180 1.1 christos
8181 1.1 christos /* This reloc will be computed at runtime. Clear the memory
8182 1.1 christos so that it contains a predictable value for prelink. */
8183 1.1 christos if (!skip)
8184 1.1 christos {
8185 1.6 christos relocation = howto->pc_relative ? outrel.r_offset : 0;
8186 1.1 christos addend = 0;
8187 1.1 christos break;
8188 1.1 christos }
8189 1.1 christos }
8190 1.1 christos break;
8191 1.1 christos
8192 1.1 christos case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
8193 1.1 christos case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
8194 1.1 christos if (h != NULL)
8195 1.7 christos {
8196 1.7 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
8197 1.1 christos bfd_vma got2_addend = 0;
8198 1.1 christos
8199 1.7 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
8200 1.1 christos {
8201 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8202 1.1 christos got2_addend = addend;
8203 1.3 christos addend = 0;
8204 1.3 christos }
8205 1.3 christos ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2, got2_addend);
8206 1.3 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
8207 1.3 christos relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
8208 1.6 christos + htab->glink->output_offset
8209 1.3 christos + ent->glink_offset);
8210 1.3 christos else
8211 1.3 christos relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
8212 1.3 christos + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
8213 1.3 christos + ent->plt.offset);
8214 1.7 christos }
8215 1.7 christos /* Fall through. */
8216 1.7 christos
8217 1.3 christos case R_PPC_RELAX:
8218 1.3 christos {
8219 1.3 christos const int *stub;
8220 1.3 christos size_t size;
8221 1.3 christos size_t insn_offset = rel->r_offset;
8222 1.3 christos unsigned int insn;
8223 1.3 christos
8224 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8225 1.1 christos {
8226 1.1 christos relocation -= (input_section->output_section->vma
8227 1.6 christos + input_section->output_offset
8228 1.3 christos + rel->r_offset - 4);
8229 1.1 christos stub = shared_stub_entry;
8230 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[0], contents + insn_offset - 12);
8231 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[1], contents + insn_offset - 8);
8232 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[2], contents + insn_offset - 4);
8233 1.7 christos stub += 3;
8234 1.3 christos size = ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry) - 3;
8235 1.3 christos }
8236 1.3 christos else
8237 1.3 christos {
8238 1.7 christos stub = stub_entry;
8239 1.3 christos size = ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
8240 1.3 christos }
8241 1.3 christos
8242 1.3 christos relocation += addend;
8243 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
8244 1.3 christos relocation = 0;
8245 1.3 christos
8246 1.7 christos /* First insn is HA, second is LO. */
8247 1.3 christos insn = *stub++;
8248 1.3 christos insn |= ((relocation + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
8249 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8250 1.1 christos insn_offset += 4;
8251 1.1 christos
8252 1.1 christos insn = *stub++;
8253 1.1 christos insn |= relocation & 0xffff;
8254 1.6 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8255 1.6 christos insn_offset += 4;
8256 1.6 christos size -= 2;
8257 1.6 christos
8258 1.6 christos while (size != 0)
8259 1.6 christos {
8260 1.6 christos insn = *stub++;
8261 1.1 christos --size;
8262 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8263 1.1 christos insn_offset += 4;
8264 1.1 christos }
8265 1.1 christos
8266 1.1 christos /* Rewrite the reloc and convert one of the trailing nop
8267 1.1 christos relocs to describe this relocation. */
8268 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_NONE);
8269 1.1 christos /* The relocs are at the bottom 2 bytes */
8270 1.1 christos wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset + d_offset;
8271 1.1 christos wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
8272 1.1 christos wrel->r_addend = rel->r_addend;
8273 1.1 christos memmove (wrel + 1, wrel, (relend - wrel - 1) * sizeof (*wrel));
8274 1.1 christos wrel++, rel++;
8275 1.1 christos wrel->r_offset += 4;
8276 1.1 christos wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
8277 1.1 christos }
8278 1.1 christos continue;
8279 1.1 christos
8280 1.1 christos /* Indirect .sdata relocation. */
8281 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
8282 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[0].section != NULL);
8283 1.1 christos if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[0].sym))
8284 1.1 christos {
8285 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8286 1.1 christos break;
8287 1.1 christos }
8288 1.1 christos relocation
8289 1.1 christos = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[0],
8290 1.1 christos h, relocation, rel);
8291 1.1 christos addend = 0;
8292 1.1 christos break;
8293 1.1 christos
8294 1.1 christos /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation. */
8295 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
8296 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[1].section != NULL);
8297 1.1 christos if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[1].sym))
8298 1.1 christos {
8299 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8300 1.1 christos break;
8301 1.1 christos }
8302 1.9 christos relocation
8303 1.9 christos = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[1],
8304 1.1 christos h, relocation, rel);
8305 1.1 christos addend = 0;
8306 1.1 christos break;
8307 1.1 christos
8308 1.1 christos /* Handle the TOC16 reloc. We want to use the offset within the .got
8309 1.1 christos section, not the actual VMA. This is appropriate when generating
8310 1.1 christos an embedded ELF object, for which the .got section acts like the
8311 1.6 christos AIX .toc section. */
8312 1.6 christos case R_PPC_TOC16: /* phony GOT16 relocations */
8313 1.6 christos if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8314 1.6 christos {
8315 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8316 1.7 christos break;
8317 1.1 christos }
8318 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (strcmp (bfd_section_name (sec), ".got") == 0
8319 1.1 christos || strcmp (bfd_section_name (sec), ".cgot") == 0);
8320 1.1 christos
8321 1.1 christos addend -= sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset + 0x8000;
8322 1.1 christos break;
8323 1.1 christos
8324 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
8325 1.1 christos if (h != NULL && ifunc == NULL)
8326 1.1 christos {
8327 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
8328 1.1 christos
8329 1.1 christos ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2,
8330 1.1 christos bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
8331 1.1 christos if (ent == NULL
8332 1.7 christos || htab->elf.splt == NULL)
8333 1.7 christos {
8334 1.1 christos /* We didn't make a PLT entry for this symbol. This
8335 1.1 christos happens when statically linking PIC code, or when
8336 1.1 christos using -Bsymbolic. */
8337 1.1 christos }
8338 1.1 christos else
8339 1.1 christos {
8340 1.1 christos /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the
8341 1.1 christos procedure linkage table. */
8342 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8343 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
8344 1.8 christos relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
8345 1.8 christos + htab->glink->output_offset
8346 1.8 christos + ent->glink_offset);
8347 1.8 christos else
8348 1.8 christos relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
8349 1.8 christos + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
8350 1.8 christos + ent->plt.offset);
8351 1.8 christos }
8352 1.8 christos }
8353 1.8 christos
8354 1.8 christos /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special. If non-zero, the
8355 1.8 christos addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2.
8356 1.8 christos Don't apply it to the relocation field. */
8357 1.8 christos addend = 0;
8358 1.8 christos break;
8359 1.8 christos
8360 1.8 christos case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
8361 1.8 christos case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
8362 1.8 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
8363 1.8 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
8364 1.8 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8365 1.8 christos plt_list = NULL;
8366 1.8 christos if (h != NULL)
8367 1.8 christos plt_list = &h->plt.plist;
8368 1.8 christos else if (ifunc != NULL)
8369 1.8 christos plt_list = ifunc;
8370 1.8 christos else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
8371 1.8 christos {
8372 1.8 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt;
8373 1.8 christos local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
8374 1.8 christos + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
8375 1.8 christos plt_list = local_plt + r_symndx;
8376 1.8 christos }
8377 1.8 christos unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8378 1.8 christos if (plt_list != NULL)
8379 1.8 christos {
8380 1.8 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
8381 1.8 christos
8382 1.8 christos ent = find_plt_ent (plt_list, got2,
8383 1.8 christos bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
8384 1.8 christos if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
8385 1.8 christos {
8386 1.8 christos asection *plt;
8387 1.8 christos
8388 1.8 christos unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8389 1.8 christos plt = htab->elf.splt;
8390 1.8 christos if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
8391 1.8 christos || h == NULL
8392 1.8 christos || h->dynindx == -1)
8393 1.8 christos {
8394 1.8 christos if (ifunc != NULL)
8395 1.8 christos plt = htab->elf.iplt;
8396 1.8 christos else
8397 1.8 christos plt = htab->pltlocal;
8398 1.8 christos }
8399 1.8 christos relocation = (plt->output_section->vma
8400 1.8 christos + plt->output_offset
8401 1.8 christos + ent->plt.offset);
8402 1.8 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8403 1.1 christos {
8404 1.1 christos bfd_vma got = 0;
8405 1.1 christos
8406 1.1 christos if (ent->addend >= 32768)
8407 1.1 christos got = (ent->addend
8408 1.1 christos + ent->sec->output_section->vma
8409 1.1 christos + ent->sec->output_offset);
8410 1.1 christos else
8411 1.1 christos got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
8412 1.1 christos relocation -= got;
8413 1.1 christos }
8414 1.1 christos }
8415 1.1 christos }
8416 1.1 christos addend = 0;
8417 1.1 christos break;
8418 1.9 christos
8419 1.3 christos /* Relocate against _SDA_BASE_. */
8420 1.3 christos case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
8421 1.1 christos {
8422 1.8 christos const char *name;
8423 1.7 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8424 1.8 christos
8425 1.8 christos if (sec == NULL
8426 1.1 christos || sec->output_section == NULL
8427 1.1 christos || !is_static_defined (sda))
8428 1.1 christos {
8429 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8430 1.1 christos break;
8431 1.1 christos }
8432 1.1 christos addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8433 1.1 christos
8434 1.1 christos name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8435 1.1 christos if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8436 1.1 christos || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0))
8437 1.1 christos {
8438 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler
8439 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
8440 1.1 christos (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8441 1.1 christos "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8442 1.1 christos input_bfd,
8443 1.1 christos sym_name,
8444 1.1 christos howto->name,
8445 1.1 christos name);
8446 1.1 christos }
8447 1.1 christos }
8448 1.1 christos break;
8449 1.9 christos
8450 1.3 christos /* Relocate against _SDA2_BASE_. */
8451 1.3 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
8452 1.1 christos {
8453 1.8 christos const char *name;
8454 1.7 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8455 1.8 christos
8456 1.8 christos if (sec == NULL
8457 1.1 christos || sec->output_section == NULL
8458 1.1 christos || !is_static_defined (sda))
8459 1.1 christos {
8460 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8461 1.1 christos break;
8462 1.1 christos }
8463 1.1 christos addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8464 1.1 christos
8465 1.1 christos name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8466 1.3 christos if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8467 1.7 christos || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0))
8468 1.7 christos {
8469 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
8470 1.6 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
8471 1.1 christos (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8472 1.1 christos "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8473 1.3 christos input_bfd,
8474 1.7 christos sym_name,
8475 1.7 christos howto->name,
8476 1.7 christos name);
8477 1.6 christos }
8478 1.1 christos }
8479 1.1 christos break;
8480 1.3 christos
8481 1.7 christos case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
8482 1.7 christos relocation = relocation + addend;
8483 1.7 christos ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8484 1.6 christos contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8485 1.1 christos split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8486 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
8487 1.3 christos
8488 1.7 christos case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
8489 1.7 christos relocation = relocation + addend;
8490 1.7 christos ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8491 1.6 christos contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8492 1.1 christos split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8493 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
8494 1.3 christos
8495 1.7 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
8496 1.7 christos relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
8497 1.7 christos ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8498 1.6 christos contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8499 1.1 christos split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8500 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
8501 1.3 christos
8502 1.7 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
8503 1.7 christos relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
8504 1.7 christos ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8505 1.6 christos contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8506 1.1 christos split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8507 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
8508 1.1 christos
8509 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
8510 1.1 christos relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
8511 1.1 christos ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8512 1.1 christos contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8513 1.1 christos split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8514 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
8515 1.3 christos
8516 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
8517 1.1 christos relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
8518 1.1 christos ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8519 1.1 christos contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8520 1.1 christos split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8521 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
8522 1.1 christos
8523 1.1 christos /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_, _SDA2_BASE_, or 0. */
8524 1.9 christos case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
8525 1.3 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
8526 1.3 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
8527 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
8528 1.1 christos {
8529 1.1 christos const char *name;
8530 1.1 christos int reg;
8531 1.3 christos unsigned int insn;
8532 1.3 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
8533 1.1 christos
8534 1.1 christos if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8535 1.1 christos {
8536 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8537 1.1 christos break;
8538 1.1 christos }
8539 1.1 christos
8540 1.1 christos name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8541 1.1 christos if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8542 1.1 christos || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
8543 1.1 christos {
8544 1.8 christos reg = 13;
8545 1.7 christos sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8546 1.8 christos }
8547 1.8 christos else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8548 1.1 christos || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
8549 1.1 christos {
8550 1.1 christos reg = 2;
8551 1.1 christos sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8552 1.1 christos }
8553 1.1 christos else if (strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sdata0") == 0
8554 1.1 christos || strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0") == 0)
8555 1.6 christos {
8556 1.1 christos reg = 0;
8557 1.1 christos }
8558 1.1 christos else
8559 1.1 christos {
8560 1.1 christos _bfd_error_handler
8561 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
8562 1.1 christos (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8563 1.1 christos "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8564 1.1 christos input_bfd,
8565 1.1 christos sym_name,
8566 1.1 christos howto->name,
8567 1.1 christos name);
8568 1.9 christos
8569 1.9 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8570 1.9 christos ret = FALSE;
8571 1.9 christos goto copy_reloc;
8572 1.9 christos }
8573 1.9 christos
8574 1.9 christos if (sda != NULL)
8575 1.9 christos {
8576 1.9 christos if (!is_static_defined (sda))
8577 1.9 christos {
8578 1.9 christos unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8579 1.9 christos break;
8580 1.9 christos }
8581 1.7 christos addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8582 1.1 christos }
8583 1.1 christos
8584 1.1 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA)
8585 1.1 christos break;
8586 1.3 christos
8587 1.3 christos /* The PowerPC Embedded Application Binary Interface
8588 1.3 christos version 1.0 insanely chose to specify R_PPC_EMB_SDA21
8589 1.3 christos operating on a 24-bit field at r_offset. GNU as and
8590 1.3 christos GNU ld have always assumed R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 operates on
8591 1.3 christos a 32-bit bit insn at r_offset. Cope with object file
8592 1.3 christos producers that possibly comply with the EABI in
8593 1.3 christos generating an odd r_offset for big-endian objects. */
8594 1.3 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_SDA21)
8595 1.3 christos rel->r_offset &= ~1;
8596 1.3 christos
8597 1.3 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
8598 1.3 christos if (reg == 0
8599 1.3 christos && (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
8600 1.3 christos || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO))
8601 1.7 christos {
8602 1.3 christos relocation = relocation + addend;
8603 1.3 christos addend = 0;
8604 1.3 christos
8605 1.3 christos /* Force e_li insn, keeping RT from original insn. */
8606 1.6 christos insn &= 0x1f << 21;
8607 1.1 christos insn |= 28u << 26;
8608 1.9 christos
8609 1.9 christos /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31. */
8610 1.7 christos /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20. */
8611 1.1 christos insn |= (relocation & 0xf0000) >> 5;
8612 1.1 christos /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15. */
8613 1.1 christos insn |= (relocation & 0xf800) << 5;
8614 1.1 christos /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31. */
8615 1.1 christos insn |= relocation & 0x7ff;
8616 1.1 christos
8617 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
8618 1.1 christos
8619 1.1 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
8620 1.1 christos && ((relocation + 0x80000) & 0xffffffff) > 0x100000)
8621 1.1 christos goto overflow;
8622 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
8623 1.1 christos }
8624 1.1 christos /* Fill in register field. */
8625 1.1 christos insn = (insn & ~RA_REGISTER_MASK) | (reg << RA_REGISTER_SHIFT);
8626 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
8627 1.1 christos }
8628 1.1 christos break;
8629 1.1 christos
8630 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
8631 1.9 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
8632 1.3 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
8633 1.3 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
8634 1.7 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
8635 1.3 christos case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
8636 1.3 christos {
8637 1.7 christos bfd_vma value;
8638 1.1 christos const char *name;
8639 1.1 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
8640 1.7 christos
8641 1.7 christos if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8642 1.8 christos {
8643 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8644 1.1 christos break;
8645 1.1 christos }
8646 1.1 christos
8647 1.1 christos name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8648 1.1 christos if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8649 1.1 christos || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
8650 1.1 christos sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8651 1.6 christos else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8652 1.1 christos || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
8653 1.1 christos sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8654 1.7 christos else
8655 1.1 christos {
8656 1.7 christos _bfd_error_handler
8657 1.7 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
8658 1.1 christos (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8659 1.7 christos "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8660 1.3 christos input_bfd,
8661 1.3 christos sym_name,
8662 1.7 christos howto->name,
8663 1.7 christos name);
8664 1.7 christos
8665 1.7 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8666 1.3 christos ret = FALSE;
8667 1.7 christos goto copy_reloc;
8668 1.7 christos }
8669 1.7 christos
8670 1.7 christos if (sda == NULL || !is_static_defined (sda))
8671 1.3 christos {
8672 1.3 christos unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8673 1.3 christos break;
8674 1.7 christos }
8675 1.7 christos value = relocation + addend - SYM_VAL (sda);
8676 1.7 christos
8677 1.7 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A)
8678 1.3 christos ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8679 1.3 christos contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8680 1.3 christos split16a_type,
8681 1.3 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8682 1.7 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D)
8683 1.7 christos ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8684 1.7 christos contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8685 1.7 christos split16d_type,
8686 1.3 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8687 1.3 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A)
8688 1.3 christos {
8689 1.3 christos value = value >> 16;
8690 1.7 christos ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8691 1.7 christos contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8692 1.7 christos split16a_type,
8693 1.7 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8694 1.3 christos }
8695 1.3 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D)
8696 1.3 christos {
8697 1.3 christos value = value >> 16;
8698 1.7 christos ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8699 1.7 christos contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8700 1.7 christos split16d_type,
8701 1.7 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8702 1.1 christos }
8703 1.1 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A)
8704 1.6 christos {
8705 1.1 christos value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
8706 1.8 christos ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8707 1.8 christos contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8708 1.9 christos split16a_type,
8709 1.8 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8710 1.1 christos }
8711 1.1 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D)
8712 1.1 christos {
8713 1.1 christos value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
8714 1.1 christos ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8715 1.1 christos contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8716 1.1 christos split16d_type,
8717 1.1 christos htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8718 1.1 christos }
8719 1.1 christos }
8720 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
8721 1.1 christos
8722 1.1 christos case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
8723 1.1 christos ppc_elf_vle_split20 (output_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset, relocation);
8724 1.1 christos goto copy_reloc;
8725 1.1 christos
8726 1.1 christos /* Relocate against the beginning of the section. */
8727 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
8728 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
8729 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
8730 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
8731 1.1 christos if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8732 1.1 christos {
8733 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8734 1.1 christos break;
8735 1.1 christos }
8736 1.1 christos addend -= sec->output_section->vma;
8737 1.1 christos break;
8738 1.1 christos
8739 1.1 christos /* Negative relocations. */
8740 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
8741 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
8742 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
8743 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
8744 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
8745 1.8 christos addend -= 2 * relocation;
8746 1.8 christos break;
8747 1.8 christos
8748 1.1 christos case R_PPC_COPY:
8749 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
8750 1.1 christos case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
8751 1.6 christos case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
8752 1.1 christos case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
8753 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLT32:
8754 1.8 christos case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
8755 1.8 christos case R_PPC_ADDR30:
8756 1.8 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
8757 1.8 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
8758 1.8 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
8759 1.9 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
8760 1.9 christos case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
8761 1.9 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
8762 1.9 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
8763 1.9 christos input_bfd, howto->name);
8764 1.9 christos
8765 1.9 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8766 1.9 christos ret = FALSE;
8767 1.9 christos goto copy_reloc;
8768 1.9 christos }
8769 1.9 christos
8770 1.9 christos switch (r_type)
8771 1.9 christos {
8772 1.9 christos default:
8773 1.9 christos break;
8774 1.9 christos
8775 1.9 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
8776 1.9 christos if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
8777 1.9 christos {
8778 1.9 christos bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
8779 1.9 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
8780 1.9 christos }
8781 1.9 christos break;
8782 1.9 christos
8783 1.9 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
8784 1.8 christos if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
8785 1.8 christos {
8786 1.8 christos bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
8787 1.8 christos unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
8788 1.8 christos insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
8789 1.8 christos insn |= 2 << 16;
8790 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
8791 1.8 christos }
8792 1.8 christos break;
8793 1.8 christos }
8794 1.8 christos
8795 1.8 christos switch (r_type)
8796 1.8 christos {
8797 1.8 christos default:
8798 1.8 christos break;
8799 1.8 christos
8800 1.8 christos case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
8801 1.8 christos if (unresolved_reloc)
8802 1.8 christos {
8803 1.8 christos bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset;
8804 1.8 christos unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
8805 1.8 christos insn &= 1;
8806 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | insn, p);
8807 1.8 christos unresolved_reloc = save_unresolved_reloc;
8808 1.8 christos r_type = R_PPC_REL24;
8809 1.8 christos howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
8810 1.8 christos }
8811 1.8 christos else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
8812 1.8 christos info->callbacks->einfo
8813 1.8 christos (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
8814 1.8 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8815 1.8 christos howto->name);
8816 1.8 christos break;
8817 1.8 christos
8818 1.8 christos case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
8819 1.8 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8820 1.8 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
8821 1.1 christos if (unresolved_reloc)
8822 1.1 christos {
8823 1.1 christos bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
8824 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
8825 1.1 christos unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8826 1.1 christos r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
8827 1.1 christos howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
8828 1.1 christos }
8829 1.6 christos else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
8830 1.1 christos info->callbacks->einfo
8831 1.1 christos (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
8832 1.1 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8833 1.1 christos howto->name);
8834 1.1 christos break;
8835 1.1 christos }
8836 1.1 christos
8837 1.1 christos /* Do any further special processing. */
8838 1.1 christos switch (r_type)
8839 1.1 christos {
8840 1.1 christos default:
8841 1.7 christos break;
8842 1.1 christos
8843 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
8844 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
8845 1.1 christos case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
8846 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
8847 1.1 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
8848 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
8849 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
8850 1.1 christos case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
8851 1.1 christos /* It's just possible that this symbol is a weak symbol
8852 1.1 christos that's not actually defined anywhere. In that case,
8853 1.1 christos 'sec' would be NULL, and we should leave the symbol
8854 1.1 christos alone (it will be set to zero elsewhere in the link). */
8855 1.1 christos if (sec == NULL)
8856 1.1 christos break;
8857 1.1 christos /* Fall through. */
8858 1.1 christos
8859 1.1 christos case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8860 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
8861 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
8862 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
8863 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
8864 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
8865 1.1 christos /* Add 0x10000 if sign bit in 0:15 is set.
8866 1.1 christos Bits 0:15 are not used. */
8867 1.1 christos addend += 0x8000;
8868 1.1 christos break;
8869 1.1 christos
8870 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16:
8871 1.1 christos case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
8872 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16:
8873 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
8874 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
8875 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
8876 1.1 christos case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
8877 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
8878 1.1 christos case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
8879 1.7 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16:
8880 1.6 christos case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
8881 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
8882 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
8883 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
8884 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
8885 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
8886 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
8887 1.1 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
8888 1.6 christos case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
8889 1.6 christos {
8890 1.6 christos /* The 32-bit ABI lacks proper relocations to deal with
8891 1.1 christos certain 64-bit instructions. Prevent damage to bits
8892 1.1 christos that make up part of the insn opcode. */
8893 1.6 christos unsigned int insn, mask, lobit;
8894 1.1 christos
8895 1.7 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
8896 1.7 christos contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
8897 1.1 christos mask = 0;
8898 1.1 christos if (is_insn_ds_form (insn))
8899 1.1 christos mask = 3;
8900 1.1 christos else if (is_insn_dq_form (insn))
8901 1.1 christos mask = 15;
8902 1.1 christos else
8903 1.1 christos break;
8904 1.1 christos relocation += addend;
8905 1.1 christos addend = insn & mask;
8906 1.1 christos lobit = mask & relocation;
8907 1.1 christos if (lobit != 0)
8908 1.1 christos {
8909 1.1 christos relocation ^= lobit;
8910 1.1 christos info->callbacks->einfo
8911 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
8912 1.1 christos (_("%H: error: %s against `%s' not a multiple of %u\n"),
8913 1.1 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8914 1.1 christos howto->name, sym_name, mask + 1);
8915 1.1 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8916 1.1 christos ret = FALSE;
8917 1.1 christos }
8918 1.1 christos }
8919 1.1 christos break;
8920 1.1 christos }
8921 1.1 christos
8922 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
8923 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, "\ttype = %s (%d), name = %s, symbol index = %ld, "
8924 1.7 christos "offset = %ld, addend = %ld\n",
8925 1.7 christos howto->name,
8926 1.1 christos (int) r_type,
8927 1.1 christos sym_name,
8928 1.1 christos r_symndx,
8929 1.1 christos (long) rel->r_offset,
8930 1.1 christos (long) addend);
8931 1.1 christos #endif
8932 1.3 christos
8933 1.3 christos if (unresolved_reloc
8934 1.3 christos && !((input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0
8935 1.3 christos && h->def_dynamic)
8936 1.3 christos && _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section,
8937 1.3 christos rel->r_offset) != (bfd_vma) -1)
8938 1.3 christos {
8939 1.3 christos info->callbacks->einfo
8940 1.3 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
8941 1.3 christos (_("%H: unresolvable %s relocation against symbol `%s'\n"),
8942 1.3 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8943 1.3 christos howto->name,
8944 1.3 christos sym_name);
8945 1.3 christos ret = FALSE;
8946 1.9 christos }
8947 1.3 christos
8948 1.9 christos /* 16-bit fields in insns mostly have signed values, but a
8949 1.9 christos few insns have 16-bit unsigned values. Really, we should
8950 1.9 christos have different reloc types. */
8951 1.3 christos if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain_overflow_dont
8952 1.3 christos && howto->dst_mask == 0xffff
8953 1.3 christos && (input_section->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
8954 1.3 christos {
8955 1.3 christos enum complain_overflow complain = complain_overflow_signed;
8956 1.3 christos
8957 1.3 christos if ((elf_section_flags (input_section) & SHF_PPC_VLE) == 0)
8958 1.3 christos {
8959 1.3 christos unsigned int insn;
8960 1.3 christos
8961 1.6 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
8962 1.6 christos if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 10u << 26 /* cmpli */)
8963 1.6 christos complain = complain_overflow_bitfield;
8964 1.6 christos else if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi */
8965 1.6 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori */
8966 1.6 christos || (insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori */)
8967 1.6 christos complain = complain_overflow_unsigned;
8968 1.6 christos }
8969 1.6 christos if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain)
8970 1.6 christos {
8971 1.6 christos alt_howto = *howto;
8972 1.6 christos alt_howto.complain_on_overflow = complain;
8973 1.6 christos howto = &alt_howto;
8974 1.6 christos }
8975 1.6 christos }
8976 1.6 christos
8977 1.6 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
8978 1.6 christos {
8979 1.6 christos /* Split field reloc isn't handled by _bfd_final_link_relocate. */
8980 1.6 christos if (rel->r_offset + 4 > input_section->size)
8981 1.6 christos r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
8982 1.6 christos else
8983 1.6 christos {
8984 1.6 christos unsigned int insn;
8985 1.1 christos
8986 1.1 christos relocation += addend;
8987 1.1 christos relocation -= (rel->r_offset
8988 1.1 christos + input_section->output_offset
8989 1.1 christos + input_section->output_section->vma);
8990 1.3 christos relocation >>= 16;
8991 1.5 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
8992 1.5 christos insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
8993 1.5 christos insn |= (relocation & 0xffc1) | ((relocation & 0x3e) << 15);
8994 1.5 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
8995 1.5 christos r = bfd_reloc_ok;
8996 1.5 christos }
8997 1.5 christos }
8998 1.6 christos else
8999 1.6 christos r = _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section, contents,
9000 1.6 christos rel->r_offset, relocation, addend);
9001 1.1 christos
9002 1.1 christos if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
9003 1.1 christos {
9004 1.1 christos if (r == bfd_reloc_overflow)
9005 1.7 christos {
9006 1.7 christos overflow:
9007 1.1 christos /* On code like "if (foo) foo();" don't report overflow
9008 1.1 christos on a branch to zero when foo is undefined. */
9009 1.1 christos if (!warned
9010 1.1 christos && !(h != NULL
9011 1.1 christos && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
9012 1.6 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
9013 1.6 christos && is_branch_reloc (r_type)))
9014 1.6 christos info->callbacks->reloc_overflow
9015 1.6 christos (info, (h ? &h->root : NULL), sym_name, howto->name,
9016 1.6 christos rel->r_addend, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
9017 1.6 christos }
9018 1.6 christos else
9019 1.6 christos {
9020 1.6 christos info->callbacks->einfo
9021 1.6 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
9022 1.6 christos (_("%H: %s reloc against `%s': error %d\n"),
9023 1.6 christos input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
9024 1.6 christos howto->name, sym_name, (int) r);
9025 1.6 christos ret = FALSE;
9026 1.6 christos }
9027 1.6 christos }
9028 1.6 christos copy_reloc:
9029 1.6 christos if (wrel != rel)
9030 1.6 christos *wrel = *rel;
9031 1.6 christos }
9032 1.6 christos
9033 1.6 christos if (wrel != rel)
9034 1.6 christos {
9035 1.6 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
9036 1.6 christos size_t deleted = rel - wrel;
9037 1.1 christos
9038 1.1 christos rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section->output_section);
9039 1.1 christos rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
9040 1.1 christos if (rel_hdr->sh_size == 0)
9041 1.1 christos {
9042 1.1 christos /* It is too late to remove an empty reloc section. Leave
9043 1.3 christos one NONE reloc.
9044 1.3 christos ??? What is wrong with an empty section??? */
9045 1.3 christos rel_hdr->sh_size = rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
9046 1.3 christos deleted -= 1;
9047 1.3 christos wrel++;
9048 1.3 christos }
9049 1.3 christos relend = wrel;
9050 1.3 christos rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section);
9051 1.3 christos rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
9052 1.3 christos input_section->reloc_count -= deleted;
9053 1.3 christos }
9054 1.3 christos
9055 1.6 christos #ifdef DEBUG
9056 1.3 christos fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9057 1.3 christos #endif
9058 1.3 christos
9059 1.3 christos if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
9060 1.3 christos && input_section->size != input_section->rawsize
9061 1.3 christos && (strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
9062 1.3 christos || strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0))
9063 1.3 christos {
9064 1.3 christos /* Branch around the trampolines. */
9065 1.3 christos unsigned int insn = B + input_section->size - input_section->rawsize;
9066 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + input_section->rawsize);
9067 1.3 christos }
9068 1.3 christos
9069 1.3 christos if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
9070 1.3 christos && input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
9071 1.3 christos && (!bfd_link_relocatable (info)
9072 1.3 christos || (input_section->output_section->alignment_power
9073 1.3 christos >= htab->params->pagesize_p2)))
9074 1.3 christos {
9075 1.3 christos bfd_vma start_addr, end_addr, addr;
9076 1.3 christos bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
9077 1.3 christos
9078 1.3 christos if (relax_info->workaround_size != 0)
9079 1.3 christos {
9080 1.3 christos bfd_byte *p;
9081 1.3 christos unsigned int n;
9082 1.3 christos bfd_byte fill[4];
9083 1.3 christos
9084 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, BA, fill);
9085 1.3 christos p = contents + input_section->size - relax_info->workaround_size;
9086 1.3 christos n = relax_info->workaround_size >> 2;
9087 1.3 christos while (n--)
9088 1.3 christos {
9089 1.3 christos memcpy (p, fill, 4);
9090 1.3 christos p += 4;
9091 1.3 christos }
9092 1.3 christos }
9093 1.3 christos
9094 1.3 christos /* The idea is: Replace the last instruction on a page with a
9095 1.3 christos branch to a patch area. Put the insn there followed by a
9096 1.3 christos branch back to the next page. Complicated a little by
9097 1.3 christos needing to handle moved conditional branches, and by not
9098 1.3 christos wanting to touch data-in-text. */
9099 1.3 christos
9100 1.3 christos start_addr = (input_section->output_section->vma
9101 1.3 christos + input_section->output_offset);
9102 1.3 christos end_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
9103 1.3 christos - relax_info->workaround_size);
9104 1.3 christos for (addr = ((start_addr & -pagesize) + pagesize - 4);
9105 1.3 christos addr < end_addr;
9106 1.3 christos addr += pagesize)
9107 1.3 christos {
9108 1.3 christos bfd_vma offset = addr - start_addr;
9109 1.3 christos Elf_Internal_Rela *lo, *hi;
9110 1.3 christos bfd_boolean is_data;
9111 1.3 christos bfd_vma patch_off, patch_addr;
9112 1.3 christos unsigned int insn;
9113 1.3 christos
9114 1.3 christos /* Do we have a data reloc at this offset? If so, leave
9115 1.3 christos the word alone. */
9116 1.3 christos is_data = FALSE;
9117 1.3 christos lo = relocs;
9118 1.3 christos hi = relend;
9119 1.3 christos rel = NULL;
9120 1.3 christos while (lo < hi)
9121 1.3 christos {
9122 1.3 christos rel = lo + (hi - lo) / 2;
9123 1.3 christos if (rel->r_offset < offset)
9124 1.3 christos lo = rel + 1;
9125 1.3 christos else if (rel->r_offset > offset + 3)
9126 1.3 christos hi = rel;
9127 1.3 christos else
9128 1.3 christos {
9129 1.3 christos switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
9130 1.3 christos {
9131 1.3 christos case R_PPC_ADDR32:
9132 1.3 christos case R_PPC_UADDR32:
9133 1.3 christos case R_PPC_REL32:
9134 1.3 christos case R_PPC_ADDR30:
9135 1.3 christos is_data = TRUE;
9136 1.3 christos break;
9137 1.3 christos default:
9138 1.3 christos break;
9139 1.3 christos }
9140 1.3 christos break;
9141 1.3 christos }
9142 1.3 christos }
9143 1.3 christos if (is_data)
9144 1.3 christos continue;
9145 1.3 christos
9146 1.3 christos /* Some instructions can be left alone too. Unconditional
9147 1.3 christos branches, except for bcctr with BO=0x14 (bctr, bctrl),
9148 1.3 christos avoid the icache failure.
9149 1.3 christos
9150 1.3 christos The problem occurs due to prefetch across a page boundary
9151 1.3 christos where stale instructions can be fetched from the next
9152 1.3 christos page, and the mechanism for flushing these bad
9153 1.3 christos instructions fails under certain circumstances. The
9154 1.3 christos unconditional branches:
9155 1.3 christos 1) Branch: b, bl, ba, bla,
9156 1.3 christos 2) Branch Conditional: bc, bca, bcl, bcla,
9157 1.3 christos 3) Branch Conditional to Link Register: bclr, bclrl,
9158 1.3 christos where (2) and (3) have BO=0x14 making them unconditional,
9159 1.3 christos prevent the bad prefetch because the prefetch itself is
9160 1.3 christos affected by these instructions. This happens even if the
9161 1.3 christos instruction is not executed.
9162 1.3 christos
9163 1.3 christos A bctr example:
9164 1.3 christos .
9165 1.6 christos . lis 9,new_page@ha
9166 1.6 christos . addi 9,9,new_page@l
9167 1.6 christos . mtctr 9
9168 1.6 christos . bctr
9169 1.3 christos . nop
9170 1.6 christos . nop
9171 1.6 christos . new_page:
9172 1.3 christos .
9173 1.3 christos The bctr is not predicted taken due to ctr not being
9174 1.9 christos ready, so prefetch continues on past the bctr into the
9175 1.9 christos new page which might have stale instructions. If they
9176 1.8 christos fail to be flushed, then they will be executed after the
9177 1.9 christos bctr executes. Either of the following modifications
9178 1.3 christos prevent the bad prefetch from happening in the first
9179 1.8 christos place:
9180 1.3 christos .
9181 1.3 christos . lis 9,new_page@ha lis 9,new_page@ha
9182 1.3 christos . addi 9,9,new_page@l addi 9,9,new_page@l
9183 1.3 christos . mtctr 9 mtctr 9
9184 1.3 christos . bctr bctr
9185 1.3 christos . nop b somewhere_else
9186 1.3 christos . b somewhere_else nop
9187 1.3 christos . new_page: new_page:
9188 1.3 christos . */
9189 1.3 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset);
9190 1.3 christos if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (18u << 26) /* b,bl,ba,bla */
9191 1.3 christos || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc,bcl,bca,bcla*/
9192 1.5 christos && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)) /* with BO=0x14 */
9193 1.5 christos || ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (19u << 26)
9194 1.3 christos && (insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == (16u << 1) /* bclr,bclrl */
9195 1.3 christos && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)))/* with BO=0x14 */
9196 1.3 christos continue;
9197 1.3 christos
9198 1.3 christos patch_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
9199 1.3 christos - relax_info->workaround_size);
9200 1.3 christos patch_addr = (patch_addr + 15) & -16;
9201 1.3 christos patch_off = patch_addr - start_addr;
9202 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B + patch_off - offset, contents + offset);
9203 1.3 christos
9204 1.3 christos if (rel != NULL
9205 1.3 christos && rel->r_offset >= offset
9206 1.5 christos && rel->r_offset < offset + 4)
9207 1.5 christos {
9208 1.5 christos asection *sreloc;
9209 1.5 christos
9210 1.5 christos /* If the insn we are patching had a reloc, adjust the
9211 1.5 christos reloc r_offset so that the reloc applies to the moved
9212 1.5 christos location. This matters for -r and --emit-relocs. */
9213 1.5 christos if (rel + 1 != relend)
9214 1.5 christos {
9215 1.5 christos Elf_Internal_Rela tmp = *rel;
9216 1.5 christos
9217 1.5 christos /* Keep the relocs sorted by r_offset. */
9218 1.5 christos memmove (rel, rel + 1, (relend - (rel + 1)) * sizeof (*rel));
9219 1.5 christos relend[-1] = tmp;
9220 1.5 christos }
9221 1.5 christos relend[-1].r_offset += patch_off - offset;
9222 1.5 christos
9223 1.5 christos /* Adjust REL16 addends too. */
9224 1.5 christos switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info))
9225 1.5 christos {
9226 1.5 christos case R_PPC_REL16:
9227 1.5 christos case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
9228 1.5 christos case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
9229 1.5 christos case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
9230 1.5 christos relend[-1].r_addend += patch_off - offset;
9231 1.5 christos break;
9232 1.5 christos default:
9233 1.5 christos break;
9234 1.5 christos }
9235 1.5 christos
9236 1.5 christos /* If we are building a PIE or shared library with
9237 1.5 christos non-PIC objects, perhaps we had a dynamic reloc too?
9238 1.5 christos If so, the dynamic reloc must move with the insn. */
9239 1.5 christos sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
9240 1.5 christos if (sreloc != NULL)
9241 1.5 christos {
9242 1.5 christos Elf32_External_Rela *slo, *shi, *srelend;
9243 1.5 christos bfd_vma soffset;
9244 1.5 christos
9245 1.5 christos slo = (Elf32_External_Rela *) sreloc->contents;
9246 1.5 christos shi = srelend = slo + sreloc->reloc_count;
9247 1.5 christos soffset = (offset + input_section->output_section->vma
9248 1.5 christos + input_section->output_offset);
9249 1.5 christos while (slo < shi)
9250 1.5 christos {
9251 1.5 christos Elf32_External_Rela *srel = slo + (shi - slo) / 2;
9252 1.5 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, (bfd_byte *) srel,
9253 1.5 christos &outrel);
9254 1.5 christos if (outrel.r_offset < soffset)
9255 1.5 christos slo = srel + 1;
9256 1.5 christos else if (outrel.r_offset > soffset + 3)
9257 1.3 christos shi = srel;
9258 1.3 christos else
9259 1.3 christos {
9260 1.3 christos if (srel + 1 != srelend)
9261 1.9 christos {
9262 1.3 christos memmove (srel, srel + 1,
9263 1.3 christos (srelend - (srel + 1)) * sizeof (*srel));
9264 1.3 christos srel = srelend - 1;
9265 1.3 christos }
9266 1.3 christos outrel.r_offset += patch_off - offset;
9267 1.6 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel,
9268 1.3 christos (bfd_byte *) srel);
9269 1.6 christos break;
9270 1.3 christos }
9271 1.3 christos }
9272 1.3 christos }
9273 1.3 christos }
9274 1.3 christos else
9275 1.3 christos rel = NULL;
9276 1.3 christos
9277 1.3 christos if ((insn & (0x3fu << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc */
9278 1.3 christos && (insn & 2) == 0 /* relative */)
9279 1.3 christos {
9280 1.3 christos bfd_vma delta = ((insn & 0xfffc) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
9281 1.3 christos
9282 1.3 christos delta += offset - patch_off;
9283 1.3 christos if (bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
9284 1.3 christos delta = 0;
9285 1.3 christos if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
9286 1.3 christos {
9287 1.3 christos enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
9288 1.3 christos
9289 1.3 christos r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info);
9290 1.3 christos if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN)
9291 1.3 christos insn |= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9292 1.3 christos else if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
9293 1.3 christos insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9294 1.3 christos else
9295 1.3 christos BFD_ASSERT (r_type == R_PPC_REL14);
9296 1.3 christos
9297 1.3 christos if ((r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
9298 1.3 christos || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
9299 1.3 christos && delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000
9300 1.3 christos && (bfd_signed_vma) delta < 0)
9301 1.3 christos insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9302 1.3 christos }
9303 1.3 christos if (delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
9304 1.3 christos {
9305 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9306 1.3 christos (insn & ~0xfffc) | (delta & 0xfffc),
9307 1.3 christos contents + patch_off);
9308 1.3 christos patch_off += 4;
9309 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9310 1.3 christos B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9311 1.3 christos contents + patch_off);
9312 1.3 christos patch_off += 4;
9313 1.3 christos }
9314 1.3 christos else
9315 1.3 christos {
9316 1.3 christos if (rel != NULL)
9317 1.3 christos {
9318 1.3 christos unsigned int r_sym = ELF32_R_SYM (relend[-1].r_info);
9319 1.3 christos
9320 1.3 christos relend[-1].r_offset += 8;
9321 1.3 christos relend[-1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_sym, R_PPC_REL24);
9322 1.3 christos }
9323 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9324 1.3 christos (insn & ~0xfffc) | 8,
9325 1.3 christos contents + patch_off);
9326 1.3 christos patch_off += 4;
9327 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9328 1.3 christos B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9329 1.3 christos contents + patch_off);
9330 1.3 christos patch_off += 4;
9331 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9332 1.3 christos B | ((delta - 8) & 0x3fffffc),
9333 1.3 christos contents + patch_off);
9334 1.3 christos patch_off += 4;
9335 1.1 christos }
9336 1.1 christos }
9337 1.1 christos else
9338 1.8 christos {
9339 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + patch_off);
9340 1.1 christos patch_off += 4;
9341 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9342 1.1 christos B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9343 1.8 christos contents + patch_off);
9344 1.8 christos patch_off += 4;
9345 1.1 christos }
9346 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (patch_off <= input_section->size);
9347 1.1 christos relax_info->workaround_size = input_section->size - patch_off;
9348 1.1 christos }
9349 1.1 christos }
9350 1.1 christos
9351 1.1 christos return ret;
9352 1.1 christos }
9353 1.1 christos
9354 1.1 christos /* Write out the PLT relocs and entries for H. */
9356 1.1 christos
9357 1.8 christos static bfd_boolean
9358 1.8 christos write_global_sym_plt (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
9359 1.1 christos {
9360 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
9361 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9362 1.1 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
9363 1.1 christos bfd_boolean doneone;
9364 1.1 christos
9365 1.1 christos doneone = FALSE;
9366 1.1 christos for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9367 1.1 christos if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9368 1.1 christos {
9369 1.1 christos if (!doneone)
9370 1.1 christos {
9371 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9372 1.1 christos bfd_byte *loc;
9373 1.1 christos bfd_vma reloc_index;
9374 1.1 christos asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
9375 1.1 christos asection *relplt = htab->elf.srelplt;
9376 1.1 christos
9377 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
9378 1.1 christos || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9379 1.1 christos || h->dynindx == -1)
9380 1.1 christos reloc_index = ent->plt.offset / 4;
9381 1.1 christos else
9382 1.1 christos {
9383 1.1 christos reloc_index = ((ent->plt.offset - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
9384 1.1 christos / htab->plt_slot_size);
9385 1.1 christos if (reloc_index > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES
9386 1.6 christos && htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
9387 1.1 christos reloc_index -= (reloc_index - PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES) / 2;
9388 1.1 christos }
9389 1.1 christos
9390 1.6 christos /* This symbol has an entry in the procedure linkage table.
9391 1.1 christos Set it up. */
9392 1.8 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS
9393 1.1 christos && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9394 1.8 christos && h->dynindx != -1)
9395 1.8 christos {
9396 1.1 christos bfd_vma got_offset;
9397 1.8 christos const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
9398 1.1 christos
9399 1.1 christos /* The first three entries in .got.plt are reserved. */
9400 1.1 christos got_offset = (reloc_index + 3) * 4;
9401 1.1 christos
9402 1.1 christos /* Use the right PLT. */
9403 1.8 christos plt_entry = bfd_link_pic (info) ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
9404 1.1 christos : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry;
9405 1.8 christos
9406 1.8 christos /* Fill in the .plt on VxWorks. */
9407 1.1 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9408 1.8 christos {
9409 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9410 1.1 christos plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_offset),
9411 1.8 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
9412 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9413 1.8 christos plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_offset),
9414 1.8 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
9415 1.1 christos }
9416 1.1 christos else
9417 1.1 christos {
9418 1.1 christos bfd_vma got_loc = got_offset + SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
9419 1.1 christos
9420 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9421 1.1 christos plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_loc),
9422 1.8 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
9423 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9424 1.8 christos plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_loc),
9425 1.1 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
9426 1.1 christos }
9427 1.1 christos
9428 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[2],
9429 1.1 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 8);
9430 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[3],
9431 1.8 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 12);
9432 1.1 christos
9433 1.1 christos /* This instruction is an immediate load. The value loaded is
9434 1.8 christos the byte offset of the R_PPC_JMP_SLOT relocation from the
9435 1.8 christos start of the .rela.plt section. The value is stored in the
9436 1.8 christos low-order 16 bits of the load instruction. */
9437 1.8 christos /* NOTE: It appears that this is now an index rather than a
9438 1.8 christos prescaled offset. */
9439 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9440 1.1 christos plt_entry[4] | reloc_index,
9441 1.1 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 16);
9442 1.1 christos /* This instruction is a PC-relative branch whose target is
9443 1.8 christos the start of the PLT section. The address of this branch
9444 1.8 christos instruction is 20 bytes beyond the start of this PLT entry.
9445 1.8 christos The address is encoded in bits 6-29, inclusive. The value
9446 1.7 christos stored is right-shifted by two bits, permitting a 26-bit
9447 1.1 christos offset. */
9448 1.6 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9449 1.1 christos (plt_entry[5]
9450 1.1 christos | (-(ent->plt.offset + 20) & 0x03fffffc)),
9451 1.1 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 20);
9452 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[6],
9453 1.1 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 24);
9454 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[7],
9455 1.1 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 28);
9456 1.1 christos
9457 1.8 christos /* Fill in the GOT entry corresponding to this PLT slot with
9458 1.8 christos the address immediately after the "bctr" instruction
9459 1.1 christos in this PLT entry. */
9460 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, (plt->output_section->vma
9461 1.1 christos + plt->output_offset
9462 1.1 christos + ent->plt.offset + 16),
9463 1.8 christos htab->elf.sgotplt->contents + got_offset);
9464 1.1 christos
9465 1.1 christos if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
9466 1.1 christos {
9467 1.8 christos /* Fill in a couple of entries in .rela.plt.unloaded. */
9468 1.8 christos loc = htab->srelplt2->contents
9469 1.1 christos + ((VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS + reloc_index
9470 1.1 christos * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS)
9471 1.1 christos * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9472 1.1 christos
9473 1.8 christos /* Provide the @ha relocation for the first instruction. */
9474 1.1 christos rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9475 1.1 christos + plt->output_offset
9476 1.1 christos + ent->plt.offset + 2);
9477 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
9478 1.7 christos R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
9479 1.7 christos rela.r_addend = got_offset;
9480 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9481 1.1 christos loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9482 1.1 christos
9483 1.1 christos /* Provide the @l relocation for the second instruction. */
9484 1.8 christos rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9485 1.1 christos + plt->output_offset
9486 1.1 christos + ent->plt.offset + 6);
9487 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
9488 1.1 christos R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
9489 1.1 christos rela.r_addend = got_offset;
9490 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9491 1.1 christos loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9492 1.7 christos
9493 1.7 christos /* Provide a relocation for the GOT entry corresponding to this
9494 1.1 christos PLT slot. Point it at the middle of the .plt entry. */
9495 1.8 christos rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
9496 1.1 christos + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
9497 1.1 christos + got_offset);
9498 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx,
9499 1.8 christos R_PPC_ADDR32);
9500 1.1 christos rela.r_addend = ent->plt.offset + 16;
9501 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9502 1.8 christos }
9503 1.8 christos
9504 1.8 christos /* VxWorks uses non-standard semantics for R_PPC_JMP_SLOT.
9505 1.8 christos In particular, the offset for the relocation is not the
9506 1.8 christos address of the PLT entry for this function, as specified
9507 1.8 christos by the ABI. Instead, the offset is set to the address of
9508 1.8 christos the GOT slot for this function. See EABI 4.4.4.1. */
9509 1.8 christos rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
9510 1.8 christos + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
9511 1.8 christos + got_offset);
9512 1.8 christos rela.r_addend = 0;
9513 1.8 christos }
9514 1.8 christos else
9515 1.8 christos {
9516 1.8 christos rela.r_addend = 0;
9517 1.8 christos if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9518 1.1 christos || h->dynindx == -1)
9519 1.8 christos {
9520 1.1 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9521 1.8 christos {
9522 1.8 christos plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9523 1.1 christos relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
9524 1.1 christos }
9525 1.1 christos else
9526 1.8 christos {
9527 1.8 christos plt = htab->pltlocal;
9528 1.8 christos relplt = bfd_link_pic (info) ? htab->relpltlocal : NULL;
9529 1.8 christos }
9530 1.8 christos if (h->def_regular
9531 1.8 christos && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
9532 1.8 christos || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
9533 1.8 christos rela.r_addend = SYM_VAL (h);
9534 1.8 christos }
9535 1.8 christos
9536 1.8 christos if (relplt == NULL)
9537 1.8 christos {
9538 1.8 christos loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
9539 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, rela.r_addend, loc);
9540 1.8 christos }
9541 1.8 christos else
9542 1.8 christos {
9543 1.8 christos rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9544 1.8 christos + plt->output_offset
9545 1.1 christos + ent->plt.offset);
9546 1.1 christos
9547 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD
9548 1.8 christos || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9549 1.1 christos || h->dynindx == -1)
9550 1.8 christos {
9551 1.8 christos /* We don't need to fill in the .plt. The ppc dynamic
9552 1.8 christos linker will fill it in. */
9553 1.8 christos }
9554 1.8 christos else
9555 1.8 christos {
9556 1.8 christos bfd_vma val = (htab->glink_pltresolve + ent->plt.offset
9557 1.8 christos + htab->glink->output_section->vma
9558 1.8 christos + htab->glink->output_offset);
9559 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val,
9560 1.8 christos plt->contents + ent->plt.offset);
9561 1.8 christos }
9562 1.8 christos }
9563 1.1 christos }
9564 1.8 christos
9565 1.8 christos if (relplt != NULL)
9566 1.8 christos {
9567 1.8 christos /* Fill in the entry in the .rela.plt section. */
9568 1.8 christos if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9569 1.1 christos || h->dynindx == -1)
9570 1.8 christos {
9571 1.1 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9572 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
9573 1.1 christos else
9574 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
9575 1.1 christos loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
9576 1.1 christos * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9577 1.1 christos htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9578 1.1 christos }
9579 1.1 christos else
9580 1.8 christos {
9581 1.8 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_JMP_SLOT);
9582 1.1 christos loc = relplt->contents + (reloc_index
9583 1.1 christos * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9584 1.1 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && is_static_defined (h))
9585 1.8 christos htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9586 1.8 christos }
9587 1.8 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9588 1.8 christos }
9589 1.1 christos doneone = TRUE;
9590 1.1 christos }
9591 1.8 christos
9592 1.8 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
9593 1.1 christos || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9594 1.6 christos || h->dynindx == -1)
9595 1.1 christos {
9596 1.1 christos unsigned char *p;
9597 1.1 christos asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
9598 1.1 christos
9599 1.1 christos if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9600 1.1 christos || h->dynindx == -1)
9601 1.8 christos {
9602 1.8 christos if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9603 1.8 christos plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9604 1.8 christos else
9605 1.8 christos break;
9606 1.8 christos }
9607 1.8 christos
9608 1.8 christos p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
9609 1.8 christos write_glink_stub (h, ent, plt, p, info);
9610 1.8 christos
9611 1.8 christos if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
9612 1.8 christos /* We only need one non-PIC glink stub. */
9613 1.8 christos break;
9614 1.8 christos }
9615 1.8 christos else
9616 1.8 christos break;
9617 1.8 christos }
9618 1.8 christos return TRUE;
9619 1.8 christos }
9620 1.8 christos
9621 1.8 christos /* Finish up PLT handling. */
9622 1.8 christos
9623 1.8 christos bfd_boolean
9624 1.8 christos ppc_finish_symbols (struct bfd_link_info *info)
9625 1.8 christos {
9626 1.8 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9627 1.8 christos bfd *ibfd;
9628 1.8 christos
9629 1.8 christos if (!htab)
9630 1.8 christos return TRUE;
9631 1.8 christos
9632 1.8 christos elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, write_global_sym_plt, info);
9633 1.8 christos
9634 1.8 christos for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
9635 1.8 christos {
9636 1.8 christos bfd_vma *local_got, *end_local_got;
9637 1.8 christos struct plt_entry **local_plt, **lplt, **end_local_plt;
9638 1.8 christos Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
9639 1.8 christos bfd_size_type locsymcount;
9640 1.8 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms = NULL;
9641 1.8 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
9642 1.8 christos
9643 1.8 christos if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
9644 1.8 christos continue;
9645 1.8 christos
9646 1.8 christos local_got = elf_local_got_offsets (ibfd);
9647 1.8 christos if (!local_got)
9648 1.8 christos continue;
9649 1.9 christos
9650 1.8 christos symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
9651 1.8 christos locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
9652 1.8 christos end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
9653 1.8 christos local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
9654 1.9 christos end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
9655 1.8 christos for (lplt = local_plt; lplt < end_local_plt; ++lplt)
9656 1.8 christos for (ent = *lplt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9657 1.8 christos {
9658 1.8 christos if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9659 1.8 christos {
9660 1.8 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
9661 1.8 christos asection *sym_sec;
9662 1.8 christos asection *plt, *relplt;
9663 1.8 christos bfd_byte *loc;
9664 1.8 christos bfd_vma val;
9665 1.8 christos Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9666 1.8 christos unsigned char *p;
9667 1.8 christos
9668 1.8 christos if (!get_sym_h (NULL, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
9669 1.8 christos lplt - local_plt, ibfd))
9670 1.8 christos {
9671 1.8 christos if (symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9672 1.8 christos free (local_syms);
9673 1.8 christos return FALSE;
9674 1.8 christos }
9675 1.8 christos
9676 1.8 christos val = sym->st_value;
9677 1.8 christos if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
9678 1.8 christos val += sym_sec->output_offset + sym_sec->output_section->vma;
9679 1.8 christos
9680 1.8 christos if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9681 1.8 christos {
9682 1.8 christos htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9683 1.8 christos plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9684 1.8 christos relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
9685 1.8 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
9686 1.8 christos }
9687 1.8 christos else
9688 1.8 christos {
9689 1.8 christos plt = htab->pltlocal;
9690 1.8 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9691 1.8 christos {
9692 1.8 christos relplt = htab->relpltlocal;
9693 1.8 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
9694 1.9 christos }
9695 1.8 christos else
9696 1.8 christos {
9697 1.8 christos loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
9698 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val, loc);
9699 1.8 christos continue;
9700 1.8 christos }
9701 1.8 christos }
9702 1.8 christos
9703 1.8 christos rela.r_offset = (ent->plt.offset
9704 1.8 christos + plt->output_offset
9705 1.8 christos + plt->output_section->vma);
9706 1.8 christos rela.r_addend = val;
9707 1.8 christos loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
9708 1.8 christos * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9709 1.8 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9710 1.8 christos
9711 1.8 christos p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
9712 1.8 christos write_glink_stub (NULL, ent, htab->elf.iplt, p, info);
9713 1.8 christos }
9714 1.8 christos }
9715 1.8 christos
9716 1.8 christos if (local_syms != NULL
9717 1.8 christos && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9718 1.8 christos {
9719 1.8 christos if (!info->keep_memory)
9720 1.8 christos free (local_syms);
9721 1.8 christos else
9722 1.8 christos symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
9723 1.8 christos }
9724 1.8 christos }
9725 1.8 christos return TRUE;
9726 1.8 christos }
9727 1.8 christos
9728 1.8 christos /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling. We set the contents of various
9729 1.8 christos dynamic sections here. */
9730 1.8 christos
9731 1.8 christos static bfd_boolean
9732 1.8 christos ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
9733 1.8 christos struct bfd_link_info *info,
9734 1.8 christos struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
9735 1.8 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
9736 1.8 christos {
9737 1.8 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9738 1.8 christos struct plt_entry *ent;
9739 1.8 christos
9740 1.8 christos #ifdef DEBUG
9741 1.8 christos fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol called for %s",
9742 1.8 christos h->root.root.string);
9743 1.8 christos #endif
9744 1.8 christos
9745 1.8 christos if (!h->def_regular
9746 1.8 christos || (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && !bfd_link_pic (info)))
9747 1.8 christos for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9748 1.8 christos if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9749 1.8 christos {
9750 1.8 christos if (!h->def_regular)
9751 1.8 christos {
9752 1.8 christos /* Mark the symbol as undefined, rather than as
9753 1.8 christos defined in the .plt section. Leave the value if
9754 1.8 christos there were any relocations where pointer equality
9755 1.8 christos matters (this is a clue for the dynamic linker, to
9756 1.8 christos make function pointer comparisons work between an
9757 1.8 christos application and shared library), otherwise set it
9758 1.8 christos to zero. */
9759 1.8 christos sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
9760 1.8 christos if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
9761 1.8 christos sym->st_value = 0;
9762 1.8 christos else if (!h->ref_regular_nonweak)
9763 1.8 christos {
9764 1.8 christos /* This breaks function pointer comparisons, but
9765 1.8 christos that is better than breaking tests for a NULL
9766 1.8 christos function pointer. */
9767 1.8 christos sym->st_value = 0;
9768 1.8 christos }
9769 1.8 christos }
9770 1.8 christos else
9771 1.1 christos {
9772 1.1 christos /* Set the value of ifunc symbols in a non-pie
9773 1.1 christos executable to the glink entry. This is to avoid
9774 1.1 christos text relocations. We can't do this for ifunc in
9775 1.1 christos allocate_dynrelocs, as we do for normal dynamic
9776 1.1 christos function symbols with plt entries, because we need
9777 1.1 christos to keep the original value around for the ifunc
9778 1.1 christos relocation. */
9779 1.1 christos sym->st_shndx
9780 1.1 christos = (_bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
9781 1.1 christos (info->output_bfd, htab->glink->output_section));
9782 1.1 christos sym->st_value = (ent->glink_offset
9783 1.1 christos + htab->glink->output_offset
9784 1.1 christos + htab->glink->output_section->vma);
9785 1.1 christos }
9786 1.1 christos break;
9787 1.1 christos }
9788 1.7 christos
9789 1.7 christos if (h->needs_copy)
9790 1.1 christos {
9791 1.7 christos asection *s;
9792 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9793 1.1 christos bfd_byte *loc;
9794 1.1 christos
9795 1.1 christos /* This symbols needs a copy reloc. Set it up. */
9796 1.1 christos
9797 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
9798 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, ", copy");
9799 1.1 christos #endif
9800 1.1 christos
9801 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
9802 1.1 christos
9803 1.1 christos if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
9804 1.1 christos s = htab->relsbss;
9805 1.1 christos else if (h->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro)
9806 1.1 christos s = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
9807 1.1 christos else
9808 1.1 christos s = htab->elf.srelbss;
9809 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
9810 1.1 christos
9811 1.1 christos rela.r_offset = SYM_VAL (h);
9812 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_COPY);
9813 1.1 christos rela.r_addend = 0;
9814 1.1 christos loc = s->contents + s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9815 1.7 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9816 1.1 christos }
9817 1.1 christos
9818 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
9819 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9820 1.1 christos #endif
9821 1.1 christos
9822 1.1 christos return TRUE;
9823 1.1 christos }
9824 1.1 christos
9825 1.1 christos static enum elf_reloc_type_class
9827 1.1 christos ppc_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info,
9828 1.1 christos const asection *rel_sec,
9829 1.1 christos const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela)
9830 1.1 christos {
9831 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9832 1.1 christos
9833 1.1 christos if (rel_sec == htab->elf.irelplt)
9834 1.1 christos return reloc_class_ifunc;
9835 1.1 christos
9836 1.1 christos switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rela->r_info))
9837 1.1 christos {
9838 1.1 christos case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
9839 1.1 christos return reloc_class_relative;
9840 1.1 christos case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
9841 1.1 christos return reloc_class_plt;
9842 1.1 christos case R_PPC_COPY:
9843 1.1 christos return reloc_class_copy;
9844 1.1 christos default:
9845 1.1 christos return reloc_class_normal;
9846 1.1 christos }
9847 1.1 christos }
9848 1.7 christos
9849 1.1 christos /* Finish up the dynamic sections. */
9851 1.1 christos
9852 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
9853 1.1 christos ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
9854 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info)
9855 1.1 christos {
9856 1.1 christos asection *sdyn;
9857 1.1 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9858 1.1 christos bfd_vma got;
9859 1.7 christos bfd *dynobj;
9860 1.1 christos bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
9861 1.1 christos
9862 1.1 christos #ifdef DEBUG
9863 1.1 christos fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections called\n");
9864 1.1 christos #endif
9865 1.1 christos
9866 1.1 christos htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9867 1.1 christos dynobj = htab->elf.dynobj;
9868 1.1 christos sdyn = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".dynamic");
9869 1.1 christos
9870 1.1 christos got = 0;
9871 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
9872 1.1 christos got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
9873 1.9 christos
9874 1.7 christos if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
9875 1.1 christos {
9876 1.7 christos Elf32_External_Dyn *dyncon, *dynconend;
9877 1.1 christos
9878 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.splt != NULL && sdyn != NULL);
9879 1.1 christos
9880 1.1 christos dyncon = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) sdyn->contents;
9881 1.7 christos dynconend = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) (sdyn->contents + sdyn->size);
9882 1.1 christos for (; dyncon < dynconend; dyncon++)
9883 1.1 christos {
9884 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
9885 1.7 christos asection *s;
9886 1.1 christos
9887 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_in (dynobj, dyncon, &dyn);
9888 1.1 christos
9889 1.1 christos switch (dyn.d_tag)
9890 1.1 christos {
9891 1.1 christos case DT_PLTGOT:
9892 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks)
9893 1.7 christos s = htab->elf.sgotplt;
9894 1.7 christos else
9895 1.7 christos s = htab->elf.splt;
9896 1.7 christos dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
9897 1.7 christos break;
9898 1.7 christos
9899 1.7 christos case DT_PLTRELSZ:
9900 1.7 christos dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->elf.srelplt->size;
9901 1.7 christos break;
9902 1.1 christos
9903 1.1 christos case DT_JMPREL:
9904 1.1 christos s = htab->elf.srelplt;
9905 1.9 christos dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
9906 1.1 christos break;
9907 1.1 christos
9908 1.1 christos case DT_PPC_GOT:
9909 1.1 christos dyn.d_un.d_ptr = got;
9910 1.1 christos break;
9911 1.1 christos
9912 1.1 christos case DT_TEXTREL:
9913 1.1 christos if (htab->local_ifunc_resolver)
9914 1.1 christos info->callbacks->einfo
9915 1.7 christos (_("%X%P: text relocations and GNU indirect "
9916 1.7 christos "functions will result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
9917 1.1 christos else if (htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver)
9918 1.7 christos info->callbacks->einfo
9919 1.7 christos (_("%P: warning: text relocations and GNU indirect "
9920 1.1 christos "functions may result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
9921 1.1 christos continue;
9922 1.1 christos
9923 1.1 christos default:
9924 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
9925 1.1 christos && elf_vxworks_finish_dynamic_entry (output_bfd, &dyn))
9926 1.1 christos break;
9927 1.1 christos continue;
9928 1.1 christos }
9929 1.1 christos
9930 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
9931 1.1 christos }
9932 1.1 christos }
9933 1.1 christos
9934 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
9935 1.1 christos && htab->elf.sgot->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
9936 1.1 christos {
9937 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgot
9938 1.1 christos || htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgotplt)
9939 1.1 christos {
9940 1.1 christos unsigned char *p = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->contents;
9941 1.1 christos
9942 1.1 christos p += htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
9943 1.1 christos if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
9944 1.7 christos {
9945 1.8 christos /* Add a blrl instruction at _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_-4
9946 1.8 christos so that a function can easily find the address of
9947 1.8 christos _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
9948 1.8 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value - 4
9949 1.1 christos < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
9950 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0x4e800021, p - 4);
9951 1.1 christos }
9952 1.1 christos
9953 1.7 christos if (sdyn != NULL)
9954 1.1 christos {
9955 1.1 christos bfd_vma val = sdyn->output_section->vma + sdyn->output_offset;
9956 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value
9957 1.9 christos < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
9958 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, val, p);
9959 1.7 christos }
9960 1.7 christos }
9961 1.1 christos else
9962 1.7 christos {
9963 1.1 christos /* xgettext:c-format */
9964 1.6 christos _bfd_error_handler (_("%s not defined in linker created %pA"),
9965 1.1 christos htab->elf.hgot->root.root.string,
9966 1.1 christos (htab->elf.sgotplt != NULL
9967 1.1 christos ? htab->elf.sgotplt : htab->elf.sgot));
9968 1.6 christos bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
9969 1.1 christos ret = FALSE;
9970 1.1 christos }
9971 1.1 christos
9972 1.1 christos elf_section_data (htab->elf.sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize = 4;
9973 1.1 christos }
9974 1.1 christos
9975 1.1 christos /* Fill in the first entry in the VxWorks procedure linkage table. */
9976 1.1 christos if (htab->elf.target_os == is_vxworks
9977 1.1 christos && htab->elf.splt != NULL
9978 1.1 christos && htab->elf.splt->size != 0
9979 1.1 christos && htab->elf.splt->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
9980 1.1 christos {
9981 1.1 christos asection *splt = htab->elf.splt;
9982 1.1 christos /* Use the right PLT. */
9983 1.1 christos const bfd_vma *plt_entry = (bfd_link_pic (info)
9984 1.1 christos ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
9985 1.1 christos : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry);
9986 1.1 christos
9987 1.1 christos if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
9988 1.1 christos {
9989 1.6 christos bfd_vma got_value = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
9990 1.1 christos
9991 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_value),
9992 1.1 christos splt->contents + 0);
9993 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_value),
9994 1.1 christos splt->contents + 4);
9995 1.1 christos }
9996 1.1 christos else
9997 1.7 christos {
9998 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0], splt->contents + 0);
9999 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1], splt->contents + 4);
10000 1.1 christos }
10001 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], splt->contents + 8);
10002 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], splt->contents + 12);
10003 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], splt->contents + 16);
10004 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], splt->contents + 20);
10005 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], splt->contents + 24);
10006 1.7 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[7], splt->contents + 28);
10007 1.7 christos
10008 1.1 christos if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
10009 1.1 christos {
10010 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
10011 1.1 christos bfd_byte *loc;
10012 1.1 christos
10013 1.1 christos loc = htab->srelplt2->contents;
10014 1.1 christos
10015 1.1 christos /* Output the @ha relocation for the first instruction. */
10016 1.1 christos rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
10017 1.1 christos + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
10018 1.1 christos + 2);
10019 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
10020 1.1 christos rela.r_addend = 0;
10021 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
10022 1.1 christos loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10023 1.1 christos
10024 1.1 christos /* Output the @l relocation for the second instruction. */
10025 1.1 christos rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
10026 1.1 christos + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
10027 1.1 christos + 6);
10028 1.1 christos rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
10029 1.1 christos rela.r_addend = 0;
10030 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
10031 1.1 christos loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10032 1.1 christos
10033 1.1 christos /* Fix up the remaining relocations. They may have the wrong
10034 1.1 christos symbol index for _G_O_T_ or _P_L_T_ depending on the order
10035 1.1 christos in which symbols were output. */
10036 1.1 christos while (loc < htab->srelplt2->contents + htab->srelplt2->size)
10037 1.1 christos {
10038 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
10039 1.1 christos
10040 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10041 1.1 christos rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
10042 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10043 1.1 christos loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10044 1.1 christos
10045 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10046 1.1 christos rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
10047 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10048 1.1 christos loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10049 1.1 christos
10050 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10051 1.1 christos rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx, R_PPC_ADDR32);
10052 1.1 christos bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10053 1.1 christos loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10054 1.1 christos }
10055 1.1 christos }
10056 1.1 christos }
10057 1.1 christos
10058 1.1 christos if (htab->glink != NULL
10059 1.1 christos && htab->glink->contents != NULL
10060 1.1 christos && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
10061 1.1 christos {
10062 1.1 christos unsigned char *p;
10063 1.1 christos unsigned char *endp;
10064 1.1 christos bfd_vma res0;
10065 1.1 christos
10066 1.1 christos /*
10067 1.1 christos * PIC glink code is the following:
10068 1.1 christos *
10069 1.1 christos * # ith PLT code stub.
10070 1.1 christos * addis 11,30,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@ha
10071 1.1 christos * lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@l(11)
10072 1.1 christos * mtctr 11
10073 1.1 christos * bctr
10074 1.8 christos *
10075 1.1 christos * # A table of branches, one for each plt entry.
10076 1.8 christos * # The idea is that the plt call stub loads ctr and r11 with these
10077 1.8 christos * # addresses, so (r11 - res_0) gives the plt index * 4.
10078 1.1 christos * res_0: b PLTresolve
10079 1.1 christos * res_1: b PLTresolve
10080 1.8 christos * .
10081 1.1 christos * # Some number of entries towards the end can be nops
10082 1.8 christos * res_n_m3: nop
10083 1.1 christos * res_n_m2: nop
10084 1.1 christos * res_n_m1:
10085 1.1 christos *
10086 1.1 christos * PLTresolve:
10087 1.1 christos * addis 11,11,(1f-res_0)@ha
10088 1.1 christos * mflr 0
10089 1.1 christos * bcl 20,31,1f
10090 1.1 christos * 1: addi 11,11,(1b-res_0)@l
10091 1.1 christos * mflr 12
10092 1.1 christos * mtlr 0
10093 1.1 christos * sub 11,11,12 # r11 = index * 4
10094 1.1 christos * addis 12,12,(got+4-1b)@ha
10095 1.1 christos * lwz 0,(got+4-1b)@l(12) # got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
10096 1.8 christos * lwz 12,(got+8-1b)@l(12) # got[2] contains the map address
10097 1.8 christos * mtctr 0
10098 1.1 christos * add 0,11,11
10099 1.1 christos * add 11,0,11 # r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
10100 1.8 christos * bctr
10101 1.8 christos *
10102 1.1 christos * Non-PIC glink code is a little simpler.
10103 1.1 christos *
10104 1.1 christos * # ith PLT code stub.
10105 1.1 christos * lis 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@ha
10106 1.1 christos * lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@l(11)
10107 1.1 christos * mtctr 11
10108 1.1 christos * bctr
10109 1.1 christos *
10110 1.1 christos * The branch table is the same, then comes
10111 1.3 christos *
10112 1.1 christos * PLTresolve:
10113 1.1 christos * lis 12,(got+4)@ha
10114 1.1 christos * addis 11,11,(-res_0)@ha
10115 1.1 christos * lwz 0,(got+4)@l(12) # got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
10116 1.1 christos * addi 11,11,(-res_0)@l # r11 = index * 4
10117 1.1 christos * mtctr 0
10118 1.1 christos * add 0,11,11
10119 1.1 christos * lwz 12,(got+8)@l(12) # got[2] contains the map address
10120 1.1 christos * add 11,0,11 # r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
10121 1.1 christos * bctr
10122 1.1 christos */
10123 1.1 christos
10124 1.1 christos /* Build the branch table, one for each plt entry (less one),
10125 1.1 christos and perhaps some padding. */
10126 1.3 christos p = htab->glink->contents;
10127 1.3 christos p += htab->glink_pltresolve;
10128 1.3 christos endp = htab->glink->contents;
10129 1.3 christos endp += htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
10130 1.3 christos while (p < endp - (htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 0 : 8 * 4))
10131 1.3 christos {
10132 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B + endp - p, p);
10133 1.3 christos p += 4;
10134 1.3 christos }
10135 1.3 christos while (p < endp)
10136 1.3 christos {
10137 1.3 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
10138 1.3 christos p += 4;
10139 1.3 christos }
10140 1.3 christos
10141 1.3 christos res0 = (htab->glink_pltresolve
10142 1.3 christos + htab->glink->output_section->vma
10143 1.3 christos + htab->glink->output_offset);
10144 1.3 christos
10145 1.3 christos if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround)
10146 1.3 christos {
10147 1.3 christos /* Ensure that a call stub at the end of a page doesn't
10148 1.3 christos result in prefetch over the end of the page into the
10149 1.3 christos glink branch table. */
10150 1.3 christos bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
10151 1.3 christos bfd_vma page_addr;
10152 1.3 christos bfd_vma glink_start = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
10153 1.3 christos + htab->glink->output_offset);
10154 1.3 christos
10155 1.3 christos for (page_addr = res0 & -pagesize;
10156 1.3 christos page_addr > glink_start;
10157 1.3 christos page_addr -= pagesize)
10158 1.3 christos {
10159 1.1 christos /* We have a plt call stub that may need fixing. */
10160 1.8 christos bfd_byte *loc;
10161 1.6 christos unsigned int insn;
10162 1.1 christos
10163 1.1 christos loc = htab->glink->contents + page_addr - 4 - glink_start;
10164 1.1 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
10165 1.1 christos if (insn == BCTR)
10166 1.1 christos {
10167 1.1 christos /* By alignment, we know that there must be at least
10168 1.1 christos one other call stub before this one. */
10169 1.8 christos insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc - 16);
10170 1.8 christos if (insn == BCTR)
10171 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-16 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
10172 1.8 christos else
10173 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-20 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
10174 1.8 christos }
10175 1.8 christos }
10176 1.8 christos }
10177 1.8 christos
10178 1.8 christos /* Last comes the PLTresolve stub. */
10179 1.8 christos endp = p + GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
10180 1.8 christos if (bfd_link_pic (info))
10181 1.8 christos {
10182 1.8 christos bfd_vma bcl;
10183 1.8 christos
10184 1.8 christos bcl = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 3*4
10185 1.1 christos + htab->glink->output_section->vma
10186 1.1 christos + htab->glink->output_offset);
10187 1.8 christos
10188 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (bcl - res0), p);
10189 1.8 christos p += 4;
10190 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_0, p);
10191 1.1 christos p += 4;
10192 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCL_20_31, p);
10193 1.1 christos p += 4;
10194 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (bcl - res0), p);
10195 1.8 christos p += 4;
10196 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_12, p);
10197 1.8 christos p += 4;
10198 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTLR_0, p);
10199 1.8 christos p += 4;
10200 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, SUB_11_11_12, p);
10201 1.8 christos p += 4;
10202 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_12_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10203 1.1 christos p += 4;
10204 1.1 christos if (PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl) == PPC_HA (got + 8 - bcl))
10205 1.8 christos {
10206 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10207 1.8 christos p += 4;
10208 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8 - bcl), p);
10209 1.8 christos p += 4;
10210 1.8 christos }
10211 1.8 christos else
10212 1.8 christos {
10213 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10214 1.8 christos p += 4;
10215 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
10216 1.8 christos p += 4;
10217 1.8 christos }
10218 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
10219 1.8 christos p += 4;
10220 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
10221 1.8 christos }
10222 1.1 christos else
10223 1.8 christos {
10224 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4), p);
10225 1.8 christos p += 4;
10226 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (-res0), p);
10227 1.8 christos p += 4;
10228 1.8 christos if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
10229 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
10230 1.8 christos else
10231 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
10232 1.8 christos p += 4;
10233 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (-res0), p);
10234 1.8 christos p += 4;
10235 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
10236 1.8 christos p += 4;
10237 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
10238 1.1 christos p += 4;
10239 1.1 christos if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
10240 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8), p);
10241 1.1 christos else
10242 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
10243 1.1 christos }
10244 1.1 christos p += 4;
10245 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_11_0_11, p);
10246 1.1 christos p += 4;
10247 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
10248 1.1 christos p += 4;
10249 1.1 christos while (p < endp)
10250 1.1 christos {
10251 1.1 christos bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
10252 1.1 christos htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
10253 1.1 christos p += 4;
10254 1.1 christos }
10255 1.1 christos BFD_ASSERT (p == endp);
10256 1.1 christos }
10257 1.1 christos
10258 1.1 christos if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
10259 1.1 christos && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
10260 1.1 christos {
10261 1.1 christos unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
10262 1.1 christos bfd_vma val;
10263 1.1 christos
10264 1.1 christos p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
10265 1.1 christos /* FDE length. */
10266 1.1 christos p += 4;
10267 1.1 christos /* CIE pointer. */
10268 1.3 christos p += 4;
10269 1.1 christos /* Offset to .glink. */
10270 1.3 christos val = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
10271 1.1 christos + htab->glink->output_offset);
10272 1.1 christos val -= (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->vma
10273 1.1 christos + htab->glink_eh_frame->output_offset);
10274 1.1 christos val -= p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
10275 1.8 christos bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
10276 1.3 christos
10277 1.8 christos if (htab->glink_eh_frame->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME
10278 1.1 christos && !_bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame (output_bfd, info,
10279 1.1 christos htab->glink_eh_frame,
10280 1.1 christos htab->glink_eh_frame->contents))
10281 1.1 christos return FALSE;
10282 1.1 christos }
10283 1.1 christos
10284 1.1 christos return ret;
10285 1.1 christos }
10286 1.1 christos
10287 1.1 christos #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM powerpc_elf32_le_vec
10289 1.7 christos #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME "elf32-powerpcle"
10290 1.1 christos #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_vec
10291 1.1 christos #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc"
10292 1.1 christos #define ELF_ARCH bfd_arch_powerpc
10293 1.3 christos #define ELF_TARGET_ID PPC32_ELF_DATA
10294 1.1 christos #define ELF_MACHINE_CODE EM_PPC
10295 1.1 christos #define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE 0x10000
10296 1.1 christos #define ELF_COMMONPAGESIZE 0x1000
10297 1.1 christos #define ELF_RELROPAGESIZE ELF_MAXPAGESIZE
10298 1.1 christos #define elf_info_to_howto ppc_elf_info_to_howto
10299 1.1 christos
10300 1.1 christos #ifdef EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
10301 1.1 christos #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT1 EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
10302 1.1 christos #endif
10303 1.1 christos
10304 1.1 christos #ifdef EM_PPC_OLD
10305 1.1 christos #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT2 EM_PPC_OLD
10306 1.1 christos #endif
10307 1.1 christos
10308 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 1
10309 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_want_dynrelro 1
10310 1.8 christos #define elf_backend_can_gc_sections 1
10311 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_can_refcount 1
10312 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_rela_normal 1
10313 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_caches_rawsize 1
10314 1.1 christos
10315 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_mkobject ppc_elf_mkobject
10316 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_merge_private_bfd_data ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data
10317 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_relax_section ppc_elf_relax_section
10318 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_type_lookup ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup
10319 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_name_lookup ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup
10320 1.8 christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_set_private_flags ppc_elf_set_private_flags
10321 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create
10322 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab
10323 1.1 christos
10324 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_object_p ppc_elf_object_p
10325 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_gc_mark_hook ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook
10326 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_section_from_shdr ppc_elf_section_from_shdr
10327 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_relocate_section ppc_elf_relocate_section
10328 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_create_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections
10329 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_check_relocs ppc_elf_check_relocs
10330 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_relocs_compatible _bfd_elf_relocs_compatible
10331 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_copy_indirect_symbol ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol
10332 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_adjust_dynamic_symbol ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol
10333 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook
10334 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_size_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections
10335 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_hash_symbol ppc_elf_hash_symbol
10336 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_symbol ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol
10337 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections
10338 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_fake_sections ppc_elf_fake_sections
10339 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_additional_program_headers ppc_elf_additional_program_headers
10340 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_modify_segment_map ppc_elf_modify_segment_map
10341 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_grok_prstatus ppc_elf_grok_prstatus
10342 1.3 christos #define elf_backend_grok_psinfo ppc_elf_grok_psinfo
10343 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_write_core_note ppc_elf_write_core_note
10344 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_reloc_type_class ppc_elf_reloc_type_class
10345 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_begin_write_processing ppc_elf_begin_write_processing
10346 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_final_write_processing ppc_elf_final_write_processing
10347 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_write_section ppc_elf_write_section
10348 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr
10349 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_plt_sym_val ppc_elf_plt_sym_val
10350 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_action_discarded ppc_elf_action_discarded
10351 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_init_index_section _bfd_elf_init_1_index_section
10352 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_lookup_section_flags_hook ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags
10353 1.1 christos
10354 1.1 christos #include "elf32-target.h"
10355 1.1 christos
10356 1.1 christos /* FreeBSD Target */
10357 1.1 christos
10358 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
10359 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
10360 1.3 christos
10361 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
10362 1.1 christos #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_fbsd_vec
10363 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
10364 1.1 christos #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-freebsd"
10365 1.1 christos
10366 1.9 christos #undef ELF_OSABI
10367 1.9 christos #define ELF_OSABI ELFOSABI_FREEBSD
10368 1.9 christos
10369 1.1 christos #undef elf32_bed
10370 1.1 christos #define elf32_bed elf32_powerpc_fbsd_bed
10371 1.7 christos
10372 1.1 christos #include "elf32-target.h"
10373 1.1 christos
10374 1.1 christos /* VxWorks Target */
10375 1.1 christos
10376 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
10377 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
10378 1.1 christos
10379 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
10380 1.1 christos #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_vxworks_vec
10381 1.1 christos #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
10382 1.1 christos #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-vxworks"
10383 1.1 christos
10384 1.1 christos #undef ELF_OSABI
10385 1.1 christos
10386 1.1 christos #undef ELF_TARGET_OS
10387 1.1 christos #define ELF_TARGET_OS is_vxworks
10388 1.1 christos
10389 1.1 christos /* VxWorks uses the elf default section flags for .plt. */
10390 1.1 christos static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
10391 1.1 christos ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
10392 1.1 christos {
10393 1.8 christos if (sec->name == NULL)
10394 1.1 christos return NULL;
10395 1.1 christos
10396 1.1 christos if (strcmp (sec->name, ".plt") == 0)
10397 1.1 christos return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
10398 1.1 christos
10399 1.1 christos return ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
10400 1.1 christos }
10401 1.1 christos
10402 1.1 christos /* Like ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create, but overrides
10403 1.1 christos appropriately for VxWorks. */
10404 1.1 christos static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
10405 1.1 christos ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
10406 1.1 christos {
10407 1.7 christos struct bfd_link_hash_table *ret;
10408 1.7 christos
10409 1.1 christos ret = ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (abfd);
10410 1.1 christos if (ret)
10411 1.1 christos {
10412 1.7 christos struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab
10413 1.7 christos = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *)ret;
10414 1.1 christos htab->plt_type = PLT_VXWORKS;
10415 1.1 christos htab->plt_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
10416 1.7 christos htab->plt_slot_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
10417 1.1 christos htab->plt_initial_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE;
10418 1.1 christos }
10419 1.9 christos return ret;
10420 1.9 christos }
10421 1.1 christos
10422 1.9 christos /* Tweak magic VxWorks symbols as they are loaded. */
10423 1.9 christos static bfd_boolean
10424 1.1 christos ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
10425 1.1 christos struct bfd_link_info *info,
10426 1.1 christos Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
10427 1.1 christos const char **namep,
10428 1.1 christos flagword *flagsp,
10429 1.1 christos asection **secp,
10430 1.1 christos bfd_vma *valp)
10431 1.1 christos {
10432 1.1 christos if (!elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp,
10433 1.1 christos valp))
10434 1.1 christos return FALSE;
10435 1.1 christos
10436 1.1 christos return ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp, valp);
10437 1.1 christos }
10438 1.1 christos
10439 1.1 christos static bfd_boolean
10440 1.7 christos ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
10441 1.7 christos {
10442 1.1 christos ppc_final_write_processing (abfd);
10443 1.1 christos return elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (abfd);
10444 1.1 christos }
10445 1.1 christos
10446 1.1 christos /* On VxWorks, we emit relocations against _PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE_, so
10447 1.1 christos define it. */
10448 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_want_plt_sym
10449 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_want_plt_sym 1
10450 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_want_got_plt
10451 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_want_got_plt 1
10452 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_got_symbol_offset
10453 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_got_symbol_offset 0
10454 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_plt_not_loaded
10455 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 0
10456 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_plt_readonly
10457 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_plt_readonly 1
10458 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_got_header_size
10459 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_got_header_size 12
10460 1.1 christos #undef elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt
10461 1.1 christos #define elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt 1
10462 1.1 christos
10463 1.1 christos #undef bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab
10464 1.1 christos
10465 1.1 christos #undef bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create
10466 1.1 christos #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create \
10467 1.1 christos ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create
10468 #undef elf_backend_add_symbol_hook
10469 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook \
10470 ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook
10471 #undef elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook
10472 #define elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook \
10473 elf_vxworks_link_output_symbol_hook
10474 #undef elf_backend_final_write_processing
10475 #define elf_backend_final_write_processing \
10476 ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing
10477 #undef elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr
10478 #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr \
10479 ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr
10480 #undef elf_backend_emit_relocs
10481 #define elf_backend_emit_relocs \
10482 elf_vxworks_emit_relocs
10483
10484 #undef elf32_bed
10485 #define elf32_bed ppc_elf_vxworks_bed
10486
10487 #include "elf32-target.h"
10488